US20110212085A1 - Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof - Google Patents

Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20110212085A1
US20110212085A1 US12/859,440 US85944010A US2011212085A1 US 20110212085 A1 US20110212085 A1 US 20110212085A1 US 85944010 A US85944010 A US 85944010A US 2011212085 A1 US2011212085 A1 US 2011212085A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
protein
antibody
lcat
nucleic acid
cells
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US12/859,440
Inventor
Elizabeth Joseloff
Aiqun Li
Tao He
Steve Ruben
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Celera Corp
Original Assignee
Celera Corp
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Celera Corp filed Critical Celera Corp
Priority to US12/859,440 priority Critical patent/US20110212085A1/en
Publication of US20110212085A1 publication Critical patent/US20110212085A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N33/00Investigating or analysing materials by specific methods not covered by groups G01N1/00 - G01N31/00
    • G01N33/48Biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Haemocytometers
    • G01N33/50Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing
    • G01N33/53Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor
    • G01N33/574Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor for cancer
    • G01N33/57407Specifically defined cancers
    • G01N33/57423Specifically defined cancers of lung
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N2500/00Screening for compounds of potential therapeutic value
    • G01N2500/04Screening involving studying the effect of compounds C directly on molecule A (e.g. C are potential ligands for a receptor A, or potential substrates for an enzyme A)
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y10TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC
    • Y10TTECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER US CLASSIFICATION
    • Y10T436/00Chemistry: analytical and immunological testing
    • Y10T436/14Heterocyclic carbon compound [i.e., O, S, N, Se, Te, as only ring hetero atom]
    • Y10T436/142222Hetero-O [e.g., ascorbic acid, etc.]
    • Y10T436/143333Saccharide [e.g., DNA, etc.]

Definitions

  • This invention relates to the fields of molecular biology and oncology. Specifically, the invention provides a molecular marker and a therapeutic agent for use in the diagnosis and treatment of lung diseases.
  • Lung cancer is the second most prevalent type of cancer for both men and women in the United States and is the most common cause of cancer death in both sexes. Lung cancer can result from a primary tumor originating in the lung or a secondary tumor which has spread from another organ such as the bowel or breast. The five-year survival rate for lung cancer continues to be poor at 8-15% survival indicating a large unmet need with regard to more effective treatments and better diagnosis. The estimated total lung cancer deaths in the U.S. in 2003 are 157,200 and the total estimated new cases in 2003 are 171,900. Primary lung cancer is divided into three main types; small cell lung cancer; non-small cell lung cancer; and mesothelioma.
  • Small cell lung cancer is also called “Oat Cell” lung cancer because the cancer cells are a distinctive oat shape.
  • Mesothelioma is a rare type of cancer which affects the covering of the lung called the pleura. Mesothelioma is often caused by exposure to asbestos.
  • Secondary lung cancer is cancer that has started somewhere else in the body (for example, the breast or bowel) and spread to the lungs. Choice of treatment for secondary lung cancer depends on where the cancer started. In other words, cancer that has spread from the breast should respond to breast cancer treatments and cancer that has spread from the bowel should respond to bowel cancer treatments.
  • the stage of a cancer indicates how far a cancer has spread. Staging is important because treatment is often decided according to the stage of a cancer.
  • the staging is different for non-small cell and for small cell cancers of the lung.
  • Non-small cell cancer can be divided into four stages. Stage I is very localized cancer with no cancer in the lymph nodes. Stage II cancer has spread to the lymph nodes at the top of the affected lung. Stage III cancer has spread near to where the cancer started. This can be to the chest wall, the covering of the lung (pleura), the middle of the chest (mediastinum) or other lymph nodes. Stage IV cancer has spread to another part of the body.
  • small cell lung cancers can spread quite early in development of the disease, small cell lung cancers are divided into only two groups. These are: limited disease, that is cancer that can only be seen in one lung and in nearby lymph nodes; and extensive disease, that is cancer that has spread outside the lung to the chest or to other parts of the body. Further, even if spreading is not apparent on the scans, it is likely that some cancer cells will have broken away and traveled through the bloodstream or lymph system. To be safe, it is therefore preferred to treat small cell lung cancers as if they have spread, whether or not secondary cancer is visible. Because surgery is not typically used to treat small cell cancer, except in very early cases, the staging is not as critical as it is with some other types of cancer. Chemotherapy with or without radiotherapy is often employed. The scans and tests done at first will be used later to see how well a patient is responding to treatment.
  • Procedures used for detecting, diagnosing, monitoring, staging, and prognosticating lung cancer are of critical importance to the outcome of the patient. For example, patients diagnosed with early lung cancer generally have a much greater five-year survival rate as compared to the survival rate for patients diagnosed with distant metastasized lung cancer. New diagnostic methods which are more sensitive and specific for detecting early lung cancer are clearly needed.
  • Lung cancer patients are closely monitored following initial therapy and during adjuvant therapy to determine response to therapy and to detect persistent or recurrent disease of metastasis.
  • a lung cancer marker which is more sensitive and specific in detecting lung cancer, its recurrence, and progression.
  • Stage determination has potential prognostic value and provides criteria for designing optimal therapy.
  • pathological staging of lung cancer is preferable over clinical staging because the former gives a more accurate prognosis.
  • clinical staging would be preferred were it at least as accurate as pathological staging because it does not depend on an invasive procedure to obtain tissue for pathological evaluation. Staging of lung cancer would be improved by detecting new markers in cells, tissues, or bodily fluids which could differentiate between different stages of invasion.
  • targets expressed differentially in the cancerous cells are either cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, and/or secreted proteins.
  • Antibodies which will specifically recognize and bind to the targets in the cancerous cells potentially provide powerful tools for the diagnosis and treatment of the particular malignancy.
  • the present invention is based on the identification of certain cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, and/or secreted proteins that are differentially expressed in lung disease.
  • a malignant cell often differs from a normal cell by a differential expression of one or more proteins.
  • These differentially expressed proteins, and the fragments thereof, are important markers for the diagnosis of lung disease.
  • the differentially expressed proteins of the present invention and the nucleic acids encoding said proteins and the fragments of said proteins are referred to herein as lung cancer associated target, LCAT proteins or LCAT nucleic acids or LCAT peptides, respectively.
  • the present invention provides peptides and protein differentially expressed in lung diseases (hereinafter LCAT). Based on the site of protein localization, e.g., surface or cytosolic, and protein characterization, e.g. receptor or enzyme, specific uses of these LCATs are provided. Some of the LCATs of the present invention serve as targets for one or more classes of therapeutic agents, while others may be suitable for antibody therapeutics.
  • LCAT peptides and protein differentially expressed in lung diseases
  • the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung disease in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins, or any fragment(s) thereof, in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154; wherein a differential level of said LCAT protein(s) or fragment(s) in said sample relative to the level of said protein(s) or fragment(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • the present invention also provides a method for detecting lung cancer in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT peptide(s) comprising a peptide sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 in a test sample from said subject, wherein a differential level of said LCAT peptide(s) in said sample to the level of said LCAT peptide(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level of said LCAT peptide(s) established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • the present invention further provides a method for detecting lung disease in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid(s), or any fragment(s) thereof, in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT nucleic acid(s) encode a LCAT protein sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154; wherein a differential level of said LCAT nucleic acids or fragment(s) in said sample relative to the level of said protein(s) or fragment(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • the invention also provides methods for detecting the LCAT peptides, gene or mRNA in a test sample for use in diagnosing the presence, absence or progression of a disease.
  • the test sample includes but is not limited to a biological sample such as tissue, blood, serum or biological fluid.
  • the present invention further provides a purified antibody that binds specifically to a protein molecule, or any fragment thereof, selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • the present invention further provides a composition comprising an antibody that binds to a protein selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, and an acceptable carrier.
  • the present invention further provides a method for treating lung disease, comprising administering to a patient in need of said treatment a therapeutically effective amount of one or more antibody(ies) of this invention.
  • the present invention further provides a method for treating lung disease comprising (i) identifying a subject having lung disease and (ii) administering to a said patient a therapeutically effective amount of one or more antibody(ies) of this invention.
  • the present invention further provides a method to screen for agents that modulate LCAT protein activity, comprising the steps of (i) contacting a test agent with a LCAT protein and (ii) assaying for LCAT protein activity, wherein a change in said activity in the presence of said agent relative to LCAT protein activity in the absence of said agent indicates said agent modulates said LCAT protein activity.
  • the present invention further provides a method to screen for agents that bind to LCAT protein, comprising the steps of (i) contacting a test agent with a LCAT protein and (ii) measuring the level of binding of agent to said LCAT protein.
  • the invention also provides diagnostic methods for human disease, in particular for lung diseases, its metastatic stage, and therapeutic potential.
  • the invention also provides a method for monitoring the disease progression and the treatment progress.
  • the invention further provide a method of diagnosis by an array, wherein the array is immobilized with two or more LCAT proteins, peptides or nucleic acid molecules.
  • the proteins, peptides or nucleic acid molecules include but are not limited to the SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • the invention also provides monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies and composition thereof reactive with antigenic portion of LCAT protein, peptides or fragments thereof in a form for use in lung diseases diagnosis.
  • the invention further provides an immunogenic antibody for treating lung diseases disease or diseases associated with lung diseases.
  • the present invention provides a method for screening agents that modulate LCAT activity, comprising the steps of (a) contacting a sample comprising LCAT with an agent; and (b) assaying for LCAT activity, wherein a change in said LCAT activity in the presence of said agent relative to LCAT activity in the absence of said compound indicates said agent modulates LCAT.
  • the agents include but are not limited to protein, peptide, antibody, nucleic acid such as antisense RNA, RNAi fragments, small molecules.
  • the present invention further provides a method for treating lung diseases, comprising: administering to a patient with one or more agents in a therapeutically effective amount to treat lung diseases.
  • the present invention provides a method for treating lung diseases, comprising: identifying a subject having lung diseases; and administering to a patient to one or more antibodies in a therapeutically effective amount to treat lung diseases.
  • CL001617CDR contains the following three text (ASCII) files:
  • File SEQLIST — 1617 txt provides the Sequence Listing.
  • the Sequence Listing provides the protein sequences (SEQ ID NOS:1-1154); transcript sequences (SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120) and peptide sequences (SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525) as shown in Table 2.
  • File SEQLIST — 1617.txt is 9,126 KB in size.
  • File TABLE1 — 1617.txt provides Table 1.
  • File TABLE2 — 1617.txt provides Table 2.
  • File TABLE2 — 1617 is 9 KB in size.
  • File TABLE3 — 1617.txt provides Table 2.
  • File TABLE3 — 1617 is 4 KB in size.
  • Table 1 discloses the peptides which correspond to the protein, the lung cancer cell lines and lung tumor tissues (“source”), the expression information, the ratio compare to the control sample. The expression is based on measuring the level of the peptides. Numerical representation of overexpression is indicated by more than two, whereas numerical representation of underexpression is indicated by less than 0.5. Over expressed singleton indicates that the peptide peak in diseased sample was detected and there was no peak detected in control samples. Under expressed singleton indicates that the peptide peak was detected in the control sample and there was no peak in the diseased sample.
  • Table 2 discloses the LCAT proteins, transcripts, and peptides sequences that correlated to the Table 1.
  • the transcript/protein information includes:
  • Table 3 discloses tumor staging information as follows (all tumor staging designations in Table 3 are those which are typically used in the art): Sample ID Number, sample type (labeled “Sample”), cancer type (labeled “Type”), Lymph Nodes (the “N” in the TNM staging system, for Node, which designates the spread of a tumor to the lymph nodes), Distant Metastasis (the “M” in the TNM staging system, for Metastasis, which designates the extent of tumor metastasis), Extent of Invasion (the “T” in the TNM staging system, for Tumor, which designates the size and location of a primary tumor), and AJCC Stage (which is assigned based on a combination of the T, N, and M classifications).
  • M Distant Metastasis
  • the cancer has spread to lymph nodes around the collarbone on either side, or to hilar or mediastinal lymph nodes on the side opposite the cancerous lung, or the cancer has spread to the mediastinum, the heart, the trachea, the esophagus, the backbone, or the carina, or two or more separate tumor nodules are present in the same lobe, or fluid containing cancer cells is present in the space surrounding the lung.
  • nucleic acids, peptides or proteins are preferred.
  • a preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT protein(s) or any fragment(s) thereof is wherein the level of LCAT protein(s) are determined by contacting one or more antibody(ies) that specifically bind to the antigenic regions of the LCAT protein(s).
  • the level of two or more proteins are determined, more preferred wherein the level of four or more proteins are determined and most preferred wherein the level of eight or more proteins are determined.
  • a preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT peptide(s) is wherein the level of LCAT peptides(s) are determined by contacting one or more antibody(ies) that specifically bind to the antigenic regions of the LCAT peptide(s). Further preferred is a method wherein the level of five or more peptides are determined, more preferred wherein the level of ten or more peptides are determined and most preferred wherein the level of fifteen or more peptides are determined.
  • a preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid(s) is wherein the level of said LCAT nucleic acid(s) is determined by contacting one or more probes that specifically hybridize to said nucleic acid(s). Further preferred is a method wherein the level of two or more nucleic acids are determined, more preferred wherein the level of four or more nucleic acids are determined and most preferred wherein the level of eight or more nucleic acids are determined.
  • the methods for detecting lung disease may be used for diagnosing the presence of disease in a patent, monitoring the presence of lung disease in patients undergoing treatment and testing for the reoccurrence of lung disease in patients that were successfully treated for lung disease; preferably wherein the lung disease is lung cancer.
  • the test sample may be, but is not limited to, a biological sample such as tissue, blood, serum or biological fluid.
  • the present invention is based on the discovery of protein(s) and peptide(s) that are differentially expressed in lung diseases cancer samples versus normal lung diseases samples. These proteins and peptide, and the encoding nucleic acid molecules are associated with lung diseases, hereinafter the LCAT protein, peptide or nucleic acids.
  • the discovery of disease specific target proteins is base on discoveries made using proteomics techniques.
  • the method uses on MALDI-TOF TOF LC/MS analyses platform to generate protein expression profiles from lung diseases tissues or cell lines in an effort to discover and identify novel molecules associated with the disease.
  • the present invention provides proteins, peptides, nucleic acids that are differential in lung diseases, as well as antibodies binds to the proteins or peptides.
  • the present invention also provides methods for detection, monitoring, diagnosis, prognosis, preventive and treatment of lung diseases.
  • the present invention provides a detection reagent, markers for lung diseases at various stages, comprises LCAT sequences isolated from human lung diseases tissue, sera, cell lines, blood or biological fluids.
  • the present invention provides a method for treating lung diseases targeting at LCAT.
  • the treatment includes administration of a therapeutically effective amount of composition comprising, but not limit to, an antibody, an immunogenic peptide which induces T cell response, a small molecule, a protein or a nucleic acid molecule.
  • the composition further comprises an agonist or antagonist to LCAT.
  • the present invention may further provide a diagnostic or therapeutic potential for epithelial-cell related cancers, which include but are not limited to pancreas, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian, breast, bladder renal, hepatocellular, pharyngeal and gastric cancers
  • the present invention further provides the target for screening an agent for LCAT, wherein the agent is compounds of small molecules, proteins, peptides, nucleic acids, antibodies or other agonists or antagonists.
  • the present invention provides isolated LCAT peptide and protein molecules that consisting of, consisting essentially of, or comprising the amino acid sequences of the LCAT peptides and proteins disclosed in the Tables 1 and 2, (encoded by the nucleic acid molecule shown in Table 2), as well as all obvious variants of these peptides that are within the art to make and use. Some of these variants are described in detail below.
  • LCAT peptides include, but are not limited to, the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and variants thereof.
  • a LCAT protein includes, but is not limited to, the amino acid sequences of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 and variants thereof. LCAT proteins may be differentially expressed in lung cell line, blood, tissue, serum or body fluids.
  • peptide or protein or fragment thereof, to which the invention pertains are not to be construed as encompassing peptide, protein or fragment that may be disclosed publicly prior to the present invention.
  • the LCAT proteins and peptides of the present invention can be purified to homogeneity or other degrees of purity.
  • the level of purification will be based on the intended use.
  • the critical feature is that the preparation allows for the desired function of the peptide, even if in the presence of considerable amounts of other components (the features of an isolated nucleic acid molecule is discussed below).
  • a “peptide” is defined as amino acid sequences between 5-20 amino acids derived from LCAT proteins such as SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 or variants thereof.
  • the peptide differentially expressed in either lung diseases cell line, blood, tissue, serum or body fluids.
  • peptides include, but are not limited to, the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525, or variants thereof.
  • a “protein” is full-length protein differentially expressed in lung diseases cell line, tissue, blood, serum or body fluids.
  • a protein includes, but is not limited to, the amino acid sequences of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • a peptide is said to be “isolated” or “purified” when it is substantially free of cellular material or free of chemical precursors or other chemicals.
  • the peptides of the present invention can be purified to homogeneity or other degrees of purity. The level of purification will be based on the intended use. The critical feature is that the preparation allows for the desired function of the peptide, even if in the presence of considerable amounts of other components (the features of an isolated nucleic acid molecule are discussed below).
  • substantially free of cellular material includes preparations of the peptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) other proteins (i.e., contaminating protein), less than about 20% other proteins, less than about 10% other proteins, or less than about 5% other proteins.
  • the peptide when it is recombinantly produced, it can also be substantially free of culture medium, i.e., culture medium represents less than about 20% of the volume of the protein preparation.
  • the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of the peptide in which it is separated from chemical precursors or other chemicals that are involved in its synthesis. In one embodiment, the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of the LCAT peptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) chemical precursors or other chemicals, less than about 20% chemical precursors or other chemicals, less than about 10% chemical precursors or other chemicals, or less than about 5% chemical precursors or other chemicals.
  • the isolated LCAT proteins and peptide can be purified from cells that naturally express it, purified from cells that have been altered to express it (recombinant), or synthesized using known protein synthesis methods.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • a nucleic acid molecule encoding the LCAT protein or peptide is cloned into an expression vector, the expression vector introduced into a host cell and the protein expressed in the host cell.
  • the protein or peptide can then be isolated from the cells by an appropriate purification scheme using standard protein purification techniques. Many of these techniques are described in detail below.
  • a LCAT peptide or protein can be attached to heterologous sequences to form chimeric or fusion proteins.
  • Schimeric and fusion proteins comprise a peptide operatively linked to a heterologous protein having an amino acid sequence not substantially homologous to the peptide. “Operatively linked” indicates that the peptide and the heterologous protein are fused in-frame.
  • the heterologous protein can be fused to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the peptide.
  • the fusion protein does not affect the activity of the peptide or protein per se.
  • the fusion protein can include, but is not limited to, fusion proteins, for example beta-galactosidase fusions, yeast two-hybrid GAL fusions, poly-His fusions, MYC-tagged, HI-tagged and Ig fusions.
  • fusion proteins for example beta-galactosidase fusions, yeast two-hybrid GAL fusions, poly-His fusions, MYC-tagged, HI-tagged and Ig fusions.
  • Such fusion proteins, particularly poly-His fusions can facilitate the purification of recombinant LCAT proteins or peptides.
  • expression and/or secretion of a protein can be increased by using a heterologous signal sequence.
  • a chimeric or fusion LCAT protein or peptide can be produced by standard recombinant DNA techniques. For example, DNA fragments coding for the different protein sequences are ligated together in-frame in accordance with conventional techniques.
  • the fusion gene can be synthesized by conventional techniques including automated DNA synthesizers. Alternatively, PCR amplification of gene fragments can be carried out using anchor primers which give rise to complementary overhangs between two consecutive gene fragments which can subsequently be annealed and re-amplified to generate a chimeric gene sequence (see Ausubel et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, 1992).
  • many expression vectors are commercially available that already encode a fusion moiety (e.g., a GST protein).
  • a LCAT-encoding nucleic acid can be cloned into such an expression vector such that the fusion moiety is linked in-frame to the LCAT protein or peptide.
  • the LCAT peptide or the LCAT protein has obvious variants of the amino acid sequence, such as naturally occurring mature forms of the LCAT, allelic/sequence variants of the LCAT, non-naturally occurring recombinantly derived variants of the LCATs, and orthologs and paralogs of the LCAT proteins or peptides.
  • Such variants can readily be generated using art-known techniques in the fields of recombinant nucleic acid technology and protein biochemistry.
  • LCAT and variants exclude any amino acid sequences disclosed prior to the invention.
  • variants can readily be identified/made using molecular techniques and the sequence information disclosed herein. Further, such variants can readily be distinguished from other peptides based on sequence and/or structural homology to the LCAT peptides of the present invention. The degree of homology/identity present will be based primarily on whether the peptide is a functional variant or non-functional variant, the amount of divergence present in the paralog family and the evolutionary distance between the orthologs.
  • the sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in one or both of a first and a second amino acid or nucleic acid sequence for optimal alignment and non-homologous sequences can be disregarded for comparison purposes).
  • at least 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, or 90% or more of the length of a reference sequence is aligned for comparison purposes.
  • the amino acid residues or nucleotides at corresponding amino acid positions or nucleotide positions are then compared.
  • amino acid or nucleic acid “identity” is equivalent to amino acid or nucleic acid “homology”.
  • the percent identity between the two sequences is a function of the number of identical positions shared by the sequences, taking into account the number of gaps, and the length of each gap, which need to be introduced for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
  • the percent identity between two amino acid sequences is determined using the Needleman and Wunsch (J. Mol. Biol. (48):444-453 (1970)) algorithm which has been incorporated into the GAP program in the GCG software package, using either a Blossom 62 matrix or a PAM250 matrix, and a gap weight of 16, 14, 12, 10, 8, 6, or 4 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6.
  • the percent identity between two nucleotide sequences is determined using the GAP program in the GCG software package (Devereux, J., et al., Nucleic Acids Res.
  • the percent identity between two amino acid or nucleotide sequences is determined using the algorithm of E. Myers and W. Miller (CABIOS, 4:11-17 (1989)) which has been incorporated into the ALIGN program (version 2.0), using a PAM120 weight residue table, a gap length penalty of 12 and a gap penalty of 4.
  • the nucleic acid and protein sequences of the present invention can further be used as a “query sequence” to perform a search against sequence databases to, for example, identify other family members or related sequences.
  • search can be performed using the NBLAST and XBLAST programs (version 2.0) of Altschul, et al. (J. Mol. Biol. 215:403-10 (1990)).
  • Gapped BLAST can be utilized as described in Altschul et al. (Nucleic Acids Res. 25(17):3389-3402 (1997)).
  • the default parameters of the respective programs e.g., XBLAST and NBLAST
  • XBLAST and NBLAST can be used.
  • Full-length pre-processed forms, as well as mature processed forms, of proteins that comprise one of the peptides of the present invention can readily be identified as having complete sequence identity to one of the LCAT peptides of the present invention as well as being encoded by the same genetic locus as the LCAT peptide provided herein (See Table 2).
  • Allelic variants of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as being a human protein having a high degree (significant) of sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide as well as being encoded by the same genetic locus as the LCAT peptide provided herein. Genetic locus can readily be determined based on the genomic information provided in Table 2, such as the genomic sequence mapped to the reference human. As used herein, two proteins (or a region of the proteins) have significant homology when the amino acid sequences are typically at least about 70-80%, 80-90%, and more typically at least about 90-95% or more homologous. A significantly homologous amino acid sequence, according to the present invention, will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under stringent conditions as more fully described below.
  • Paralogs of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as having some degree of significant sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide, as being encoded by a gene from humans, and as having similar activity or function.
  • Two proteins will typically be considered paralogs when the amino acid sequences are typically at least about 60% or greater, and more typically at least about 70% or greater homology through a given region or domain.
  • Such paralogs will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under moderate to stringent conditions as more fully described below.
  • Orthologs of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as having some degree of significant sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide as well as being encoded by a gene from another organism.
  • Preferred orthologs will be isolated from mammals, preferably primates, for the development of human therapeutic targets and agents. Such orthologs will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under moderate to stringent conditions, as more fully described below, depending on the degree of relatedness of the two organisms yielding the proteins.
  • Non-naturally occurring variants of the LCAT peptides of the present invention can readily be generated using recombinant techniques.
  • Such variants include, but are not limited to deletions, additions and substitutions in the amino acid sequence of the LCAT peptide.
  • one class of substitutions is conserved amino acid substitution.
  • Such substitutions are those that substitute a given amino acid in a LCAT peptide by another amino acid of like characteristics.
  • conservative substitutions are the replacements, one for another, among the aliphatic amino acids Ala, Val, Leu, and Ile; interchange of the hydroxyl residues Ser and Thr; exchange of the acidic residues Asp and Glu; substitution between the amide residues Asn and Gln; exchange of the basic residues Lys and Arg; and replacements among the aromatic residues Phe and Tyr.
  • Guidance concerning which amino acid changes are likely to be phenotypically silent are found in Bowie et al., Science 247:1306-1310 (1990).
  • Variant LCAT peptides can be fully functional or can lack function in one or more activities, e.g. ability to bind substrate, ability to phosphorylate substrate, ability to mediate signaling, etc. Fully functional variants typically contain only conservative variation or variation in non-critical residues or in non-critical regions.
  • Non-functional variants typically contain one or more non-conservative amino acid substitutions, deletions, insertions, inversions, or truncation or a substitution, insertion, inversion, or deletion in a critical residue or critical region.
  • Amino acids that are essential for function can be identified by methods known in the art, such as site-directed mutagenesis or alanine-scanning mutagenesis (Cunningham et al., Science 244:1081-1085 (1989)). The latter procedure introduces single alanine mutations at every residue in the molecule. The resulting mutant molecules are then tested for biological activity such as LCAT activity or in assays such as an in vitro proliferative activity. Sites that are critical for binding partner/substrate binding can also be determined by structural analysis such as crystallization, nuclear magnetic resonance or photoaffinity labeling (Smith et al., J. Mol. Biol. 224:899-904 (1992); de Vos et al. Science 255:306-312 (1992)).
  • the present invention further provides fragments of the LCATs, in addition to proteins and peptides that comprise and consist of such fragments, particularly those comprising the residues identified in Tables 1 and 2.
  • a fragment comprises at least 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 18, 20 or more contiguous amino acid residues from a LCAT.
  • Such fragments can be chosen based on the ability to retain one or more of the biological activities of the LCAT or could be chosen for the ability to perform a function, e.g. bind a substrate or act as an immunogen.
  • Particularly important fragments are biologically active fragments, peptides that are, for example, about 8 or more amino acids in length.
  • Such fragments will typically comprise a domain or motif of the LCAT, e.g., active site, a transmembrane domain or a substrate-binding domain.
  • possible fragments include, but are not limited to, domain or motif containing fragments, soluble peptide fragments, and fragments containing immunogenic structures. Predicted domains and functional sites are readily identifiable by computer programs well known and readily available to those of skill in the art (e.g., PROSITE analysis).
  • Polypeptides often contain amino acids other than the 20 amino acids commonly referred to as the 20 naturally occurring amino acids. Further, many amino acids, including the terminal amino acids, may be modified by natural processes, such as processing and other post-translational modifications, or by chemical modification techniques well known in the art. Common modifications that occur naturally in LCATs are described in basic texts, detailed monographs, and the research literature, and they are well known to those of skill in the art.
  • Known modifications include, but are not limited to, acetylation, acylation, ADP-ribosylation, amidation, covalent attachment of flavin, covalent attachment of a heme moiety, covalent attachment of a nucleotide or nucleotide derivative, covalent attachment of a lipid or lipid derivative, covalent attachment of phosphotidylinositol, cross-linking, cyclization, disulfide bond formation, demethylation, formation of covalent crosslinks, formation of cystine, formation of pyroglutamate, formylation, gamma carboxylation, glycosylation, GPI anchor formation, hydroxylation, iodination, methylation, myristoylation, oxidation, proteolytic processing, phosphorylation, prenylation, racemization, selenoylation, sulfation, transfer-RNA mediated addition of amino acids to proteins such as arginylation, and ubiquitination.
  • the LCATs of the present invention also encompass derivatives or analogs in which a substituted amino acid residue is not one encoded by the genetic code, in which a substituent group is included, in which the mature LCAT is fused with another compound, such as a compound to increase the half-life of the LCAT (for example, polyethylene glycol), or in which the additional amino acids are fused to the mature LCAT, such as a leader or secretory sequence or a sequence for purification of the mature LCAT or a pro-protein sequence.
  • a substituted amino acid residue is not one encoded by the genetic code, in which a substituent group is included, in which the mature LCAT is fused with another compound, such as a compound to increase the half-life of the LCAT (for example, polyethylene glycol), or in which the additional amino acids are fused to the mature LCAT, such as a leader or secretory sequence or a sequence for purification of the mature LCAT or a pro-protein sequence.
  • the proteins of the present invention can be used in substantial and specific assays related to the functional information provided in the Tables; to raise antibodies or to elicit another immune response; as a reagent (including the labeled reagent) in assays designed to quantitatively determine levels of the protein (or its binding partner or ligand) in biological fluids; and as markers for tissues in which the corresponding protein is preferentially expressed (either constitutively or at a particular stage of tissue differentiation or development or in a disease state).
  • the protein binds or potentially binds to another protein or ligand (such as, for example, in a LCAT-effector protein interaction or LCAT-ligand interaction)
  • the protein can be used to identify the binding partner/ligand so as to develop a system to identify inhibitors of the binding interaction. Any or all of these uses are capable of being developed into reagent grade or kit format for commercialization as commercial products.
  • LCATs isolated from humans and their human/mammalian orthologs serve as targets for identifying agents for use in mammalian therapeutic applications, e.g. a human drug, particularly in modulating a biological or pathological response in a cell or tissue that expresses the LCAT.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • Such assays involve any of the known LCAT functions or activities or properties useful for diagnosis and treatment of LCAT-related conditions that are specific for the subfamily of LCATs that the one of the present invention belongs to, particularly in cells and tissues that express the LCAT.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • the proteins of the present invention are also useful in drug screening assays, in cell-based or cell-free systems.
  • Cell-based systems can be native, i.e., cells that normally express the LCAT, as a biopsy or expanded in cell culture.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • cell-based assays involve recombinant host cells expressing the LCAT protein.
  • the polypeptides can be used to identify compounds or agents that modulate LCAT activity of the protein in its natural state or an altered form that causes a specific disease or pathology associated with the LCAT.
  • Both the LCATs of the present invention and appropriate variants and fragments can be used in high-throughput screens to assay candidate compounds for the ability to bind to the LCAT. These compounds can be further screened against a functional LCAT to determine the effect of the compound on the LCAT activity. Further, these compounds can be tested in animal or invertebrate systems to determine activity/effectiveness.
  • Compounds can be identified that activate (agonist) or inactivate (antagonist) the LCAT to a desired degree.
  • the proteins of the present invention can be used to screen a compound or an agent for the ability to stimulate or inhibit interaction between the LCAT protein and a molecule that normally interacts with the LCAT protein, e.g. a substrate or or an extracellular binding ligand or a component of the signal pathway that the LCAT protein normally interacts (for example, a cytosolic signal protein or another LCAT).
  • a molecule that normally interacts with the LCAT protein e.g. a substrate or or an extracellular binding ligand or a component of the signal pathway that the LCAT protein normally interacts (for example, a cytosolic signal protein or another LCAT).
  • Such assays typically include the steps of combining the LCAT protein with a candidate compound under conditions that allow the LCAT protein, or fragment, to interact with the target molecule, and to detect the formation of a complex between the protein and the target or to detect the biochemical consequence of the interaction with the LCAT protein and the target, such as any of the associated effects of signal transduction such as protein phosphorylation, cAMP turnover, and adenylate cyclase activation, etc.
  • Candidate compounds or agents include, for example, 1) peptides such as soluble peptides, including Ig-tailed fusion peptides and members of random peptide libraries (see, e.g., Lam et al., Nature 354:82-84 (1991); Houghten et al., Nature 354:84-86 (1991)) and combinatorial chemistry-derived molecular libraries made of D- and/or L-configuration amino acids; 2) phosphopeptides (e.g., members of random and partially degenerate, directed phosphopeptide libraries, see, e.g., Songyang et al., Cell 72:767-778 (1993)); 3) antibodies (e.g., polyclonal, monoclonal, humanized, anti-idiotypic, chimeric, and single chain antibodies as well as Fab, F(ab′)2, Fab expression library fragments, and epitope-binding fragments of antibodies); and 4) small organic and inorganic molecules (e
  • One candidate compound or agent is a soluble fragment of the LCAT that competes for substrate binding.
  • Other candidate compounds include mutant LCATs or appropriate fragments containing mutations that affect LCAT function and thus compete for substrate. Accordingly, a fragment that competes for substrate, for example with a higher affinity, or a fragment that binds substrate but does not allow release, is encompassed by the invention.
  • the invention further includes other end point assays to identify compounds that modulate (stimulate or inhibit) LCAT activity.
  • the assays typically involve an assay of events in the signal transduction pathway that indicate LCAT activity.
  • the phosphorylation of a substrate, activation of a protein, a change in the expression of genes that are up- or down-regulated in response to the LCAT protein dependent signal cascade can be assayed.
  • Any of the biological or biochemical functions mediated by the LCAT can be used as an endpoint assay.
  • Binding and/or activating compounds can also be screened by using chimeric LCAT proteins in which the amino terminal extracellular domain, or parts thereof, the entire transmembrane domain or subregions, such as any of the seven transmembrane segments or any of the intracellular or extracellular loops and the carboxy terminal intracellular domain, or parts thereof, can be replaced by heterologous domains or subregions.
  • a substrate-binding region can be used that interacts with a different substrate then that which is recognized by the native LCAT. Accordingly, a different set of signal transduction components is available as an end-point assay for activation. This allows for assays to be performed in other than the specific host cell from which the LCAT is derived.
  • the proteins of the present invention are also useful in competition binding assays in methods designed to discover compounds that interact with the LCAT (e.g. binding partners and/or ligands).
  • LCAT binding partners and/or ligands
  • a compound is exposed to a LCAT polypeptide under conditions that allow the compound to bind or to otherwise interact with the polypeptide.
  • Soluble LCAT polypeptide is also added to the mixture. If the test compound interacts with the soluble LCAT polypeptide, it decreases the amount of complex formed or activity from the LCAT.
  • This type of assay is particularly useful in cases in which compounds are sought that interact with specific regions of the LCAT.
  • the soluble polypeptide that competes with the target LCAT region is designed to contain peptide sequences corresponding to the region of interest.
  • a fusion protein can be provided which adds a domain that allows the protein to be bound to a matrix.
  • glutathione-S-transferase fusion proteins can be adsorbed onto glutathione sepharose beads (Sigma Chemical, St. Louis, Mo.) or glutathione derivatized microtitre plates, which are then combined with the cell lysates (e.g., 35 S-labeled) and the candidate compound, and the mixture incubated under conditions conducive to complex formation (e.g., at physiological conditions for salt and pH).
  • the beads are washed to remove any unbound label, and the matrix immobilized and radiolabel determined directly, or in the supernatant after the complexes are dissociated.
  • the complexes can be dissociated from the matrix, separated by SDS-PAGE, and the level of LCAT-binding protein found in the bead fraction quantitated from the gel using standard electrophoretic techniques.
  • the polypeptide or its target molecule can be immobilized utilizing conjugation of biotin and streptavidin using techniques well known in the art.
  • antibodies reactive with the protein but which do not interfere with binding of the protein to its target molecule can be derivatized to the wells of the plate, and the protein trapped in the wells by antibody conjugation.
  • Preparations of a LCAT-binding protein and a candidate compound are incubated in the LCAT protein-presenting wells and the amount of complex trapped in the well can be quantitated.
  • Methods for detecting such complexes include immunodetection of complexes using antibodies reactive with the LCAT protein target molecule, or which are reactive with LCAT protein and compete with the target molecule, as well as LCAT-linked assays which rely on detecting an enzymatic activity associated with the target molecule.
  • Agents that modulate one of the LCATs of the present invention can be identified using one or more of the above assays, alone or in combination. It is generally preferable to use a cell-based or cell free system first and then confirm activity in an animal or other model system. Such model systems are well known in the art and can readily be employed in this context.
  • Modulators of LCAT protein activity identified according to these drug screening assays can be used to treat a subject with a disorder mediated by the LCAT pathway, by treating cells or tissues that express the LCAT.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • the LCAT proteins can be used as “bait proteins” in a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al. (1993) Cell 72:223-232; Madura et al. (1993) J. Biol. Chem. 268:12046-12054; Bartel et al. (1993) Biotechniques 14:920-924; Iwabuchi et al. (1993) Oncogene 8:1693-1696; and Brent WO94/10300), to identify other proteins, which bind to or interact with the LCAT and are involved in LCAT activity.
  • LCAT-binding proteins are also likely to be involved in the propagation of signals by the LCAT proteins or LCAT targets as, for example, downstream elements of a LCAT-mediated signaling pathway.
  • LCAT-binding proteins are likely to be LCAT inhibitors.
  • the two-hybrid system is based on the modular nature of most transcription factors, which consist of separable DNA-binding and activation domains.
  • the assay utilizes two different DNA constructs.
  • the gene that codes for a LCAT protein is fused to a gene encoding the DNA binding domain of a known transcription factor (e.g., GAL-4).
  • a DNA sequence, from a library of DNA sequences that encode an unidentified protein (“prey” or “sample”) is fused to a gene that codes for the activation domain of the known transcription factor.
  • the DNA-binding and activation domains of the transcription factor are brought into close proximity. This proximity allows transcription of a reporter gene (e.g., LacZ) which is operably linked to a transcriptional regulatory site responsive to the transcription factor. Expression of the reporter gene can be detected and cell colonies containing the functional transcription factor can be isolated and used to obtain the cloned gene which encodes the protein which interacts with the LCAT protein.
  • a reporter gene e.g., LacZ
  • This invention further pertains to novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays. Accordingly, it is within the scope of this invention to further use an agent identified as described herein in an appropriate animal model.
  • an agent identified as described herein e.g., a LCAT-modulating agent, an antisense LCAT nucleic acid molecule, an LCAT-RNAi fragment, a LCAT-specific antibody, or a LCAT-binding partner
  • an agent identified as described herein can be used in an animal or other model to determine the efficacy, toxicity, or side effects of treatment with such an agent.
  • an agent identified as described herein can be used in an animal or other model to determine the mechanism of action of such an agent.
  • this invention pertains to uses of novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays for treatments as described herein.
  • the LCAT proteins of the present invention are also useful to provide a target for diagnosing a disease or predisposition to disease mediated by the peptide. Accordingly, the invention provides methods for detecting the presence, or levels of, the protein (or encoding mRNA) in a cell, tissue, or organism. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. The method involves contacting a biological sample with a compound capable of interacting with the LCAT protein such that the interaction can be detected. Such an assay can be provided in a single detection format or a multi-detection format such as an antibody chip array.
  • a biological sample includes tissues, cells and biological fluids isolated from a subject, as well as tissues, cells and fluids present within a subject.
  • the peptides of the present invention also provide targets for diagnosing active protein activity, disease, or predisposition to disease, in a patient having a variant peptide, particularly activities and conditions that are known for other members of the family of proteins to which the present one belongs.
  • the peptide can be isolated from a biological sample and assayed for the presence of a genetic mutation that results in aberrant peptide. This includes amino acid substitution, deletion, insertion, rearrangement, (as the result of aberrant splicing events), and inappropriate post-translational modification.
  • Analytic methods include altered electrophoretic mobility, altered tryptic peptide digest, altered LCAT activity in cell-based or cell-free assay, alteration in substrate or antibody-binding pattern, altered isoelectric point, direct amino acid sequencing, and any other of the known assay techniques useful for detecting mutations in a protein.
  • Such an assay can be provided in a single detection format or a multi-detection format such as an antibody chip array.
  • peptide detection techniques include enzyme linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), Western blots, immunoprecipitations and immunofluorescence using a detection reagent, such as an antibody or protein binding agent.
  • a detection reagent such as an antibody or protein binding agent.
  • the peptide can be detected in vivo in a subject by introducing into the subject a labeled anti-peptide antibody or other types of detection agent.
  • the antibody can be labeled with a radioactive marker whose presence and location in a subject can be detected by standard imaging techniques. Particularly useful are methods that detect the allelic variant of a peptide expressed in a subject and methods which detect fragments of a peptide in a sample.
  • the peptides are also useful in pharmacogenomic analysis.
  • Pharmacogenomics deal with clinically significant hereditary variations in the response to drugs due to altered drug disposition and abnormal action in affected persons. See, e.g., Eichelbaum, M. (Clin. Exp. Pharmacol. Physiol. 23(10-11):983-985 (1996)), and Linder, M. W. (Clin. Chem. 43(2):254-266 (1997)).
  • the clinical outcomes of these variations result in severe toxicity of therapeutic drugs in certain individuals or therapeutic failure of drugs in certain individuals as a result of individual variation in metabolism.
  • the genotype of the individual can determine the way a therapeutic compound acts on the body or the way the body metabolizes the compound.
  • the activity of drug metabolizing enzymes affects both the intensity and duration of drug action.
  • the pharmacogenomics of the individual permit the selection of effective compounds and effective dosages of such compounds for prophylactic or therapeutic treatment based on the individual's genotype.
  • the discovery of genetic polymorphisms in some drug metabolizing enzymes has explained why some patients do not obtain the expected drug effects, show an exaggerated drug effect, or experience serious toxicity from standard drug dosages. Polymorphisms can be expressed in the phenotype of the extensive metabolizer and the phenotype of the poor metabolizer. Accordingly, genetic polymorphism may lead to allelic protein variants of the LCAT protein in which one or more of the LCAT functions in one population are different from those in another population.
  • polymorphism may give rise to amino terminal extracellular domains and/or other substrate-binding regions that are more or less active in substrate binding, and LCAT activation. Accordingly, substrate dosage would necessarily be modified to maximize the therapeutic effect within a given population containing a polymorphism.
  • genotyping specific polymorphic peptides could be identified.
  • the peptides are also useful for treating a disorder characterized by an absence of, inappropriate, or unwanted expression of the protein.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. Accordingly, methods for treatment include the use of the LCAT protein or fragments.
  • the present invention provides antibodies specifically bind to LCAT proteins or fragments thereof, peptides, or antigenic portion thereof.
  • the invention also provides antibodies that selectively bind to one of the peptides of the present invention, a protein comprising such a peptide, as well as variants and fragments thereof as describe above.
  • the antibody of present invention selectively binds a target LCAT when it binds the target domain and does not significantly bind to unrelated proteins.
  • An antibody is still considered to selectively bind a peptide even if it also binds to other proteins that are not substantially homologous with the target peptide so long as such proteins share homology with a fragment or domain of the peptide target of the antibody. In this case, it would be understood that antibody binding to the peptide is still selective despite some degree of cross-reactivity.
  • antibody is used in the broadest sense, and specifically covers monoclonal antibodies (including full length monoclonal antibodies), polyclonal antibodies, multispecific antibodies (e.g., bispecific antibodies), humanized antibody and antibody fragments (e.g., Fab, F(ab′).sub.2 and Fv) so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity.
  • Antibodies (Abs) and immunoglobulins (Igs) are glycoproteins having the same structural characteristics. While antibodies exhibit binding specificity to a specific antigen, immunoglobulins include both antibodies and other antibody-like molecules that lack antigen specificity.
  • antibodies are usually heterotetrameric glycoproteins of about 150,000 daltons, composed of two identical light (L) chains and two identical heavy (H) chains. Each light chain is linked to a heavy chain by one covalent disulfide bond, while the number of disulfide linkages varies between the heavy chains of different immunoglobulin isotypes. Each heavy and light chain also has regularly spaced intrachain disulfide bridges. Each heavy chain has at one end a variable domain (VH) followed by a number of constant domains. Each light chain has a variable domain at one end (VL) and a constant domain at its other end.
  • VH variable domain
  • VL variable domain at one end
  • the constant domain of the light chain is aligned with the first constant domain of the heavy chain, and the light chain variable domain is aligned with the variable domain of the heavy chain. Particular amino acid residues are believed to form an interface between the light and heavy chain variable domains. Chothia et al., J. Mol. Biol. 186, 651-63 (1985); Novotny and Haber, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 82 4592-4596 (1985).
  • an “isolated” antibody is one which has been identified and separated and/or recovered from a component of the environment in which is produced. Contaminant components of its production environment are materials that would interfere with diagnostic or therapeutic uses for the antibody, and may include enzymes, hormones, and other proteinaceous or nonproteinaceous solutes.
  • the antibody will be purified as measurable by at least three different methods: 1) to greater than 95% by weight of antibody as determined by the Lowry method, and most preferably more than 99% by weight; 2) to a degree sufficient to obtain at least 15 residues of N-terminal or internal amino acid sequence by use of a spinning cup sequentator; or 3) to homogeneity by SDS-PAGE under reducing or non-reducing conditions using Coomasie blue or, preferably, silver stain.
  • Isolated antibody includes the antibody in situ within recombinant cells since at least one component of the antibody's natural environment will not be present. Ordinarily, however, isolated antibody will be prepared by at least one purification step.
  • an “antigenic region” or “antigenic determinant” or an “epitope” includes any protein determinant capable of specific binding to an antibody. This is the site on an antigen to which each distinct antibody molecule binds. Epitopic determinants usually consist of active surface groupings of molecules such as amino acids or sugar side chains and usually have specific three-dimensional structural characteristics, as well as charge characteristics.
  • Antibody specificity is an antibody, which has a stronger binding affinity for an antigen from a first subject species than it has for a homologue of that antigen from a second subject species.
  • the antibody “bind specifically” to a human antigen (i.e., has a binding affinity (Kd) value of no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 7 M, preferably no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 8 and most preferably no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 9 M) but has a binding affinity for a homologue of the antigen from a second subject species which is at least about 50 fold, or at least about 500 fold, or at least about 1000 fold, weaker than its binding affinity for the human antigen.
  • Kd binding affinity
  • the antibody can be of any of the various types of antibodies as defined above, but preferably is a humanized or human antibody (Queen et al., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,530,101, 5,585,089; 5,693,762; and 6,180,370).
  • the present invention provides an “antibody variant,” which refers to an amino acid sequence variant of an antibody wherein one or more of the amino acid residues have been modified. Such variant necessarily have less than 100% sequence identity or similarity with the amino acid sequence having at least 75% amino acid sequence identity or similarity with the amino acid sequence of either the heavy or light chain variable domain of the antibody, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and most preferably at least 95%. Since the method of the invention applies equally to both polypeptides, antibodies and fragments thereof, these terms are sometimes employed interchangeably.
  • variable in the context of variable domain of antibodies refers to the fact that certain portions of the variable domains differ extensively in sequence among antibodies and are used in the binding and specificity of each particular antibody for its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed through the variable domains of antibodies. It is concentrated in three segments called complementarity determining regions (CDRs) also known as hypervariable regions both in the light chain and the heavy chain variable domains.
  • CDRs complementarity determining regions
  • variable domains of native heavy and light chains each comprise four FR regions, largely adopting a .beta.-Sheet configuration, connected by three CDRs, which form loops connecting, and in some cases forming part of, the .beta.-sheet structure.
  • the CDRs in each chain are held together in close proximity by the FR regions and, with the CDRs from the other chain, contribute to the formation of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (see Kabat et al.)
  • the constant domains are not involved directly in binding an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various effector functions, such as participation of the antibody in antibody-dependent cellular toxicity.
  • antibody fragment refers to a portion of a full-length antibody, generally the antigen binding or variable region.
  • antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′) 2 and Fv fragments.
  • Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen binding fragments, called the Fab fragment, each with a single antigen binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, so-called for its ability to crystallize readily.
  • Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′) 2 fragment that has two antigen binding fragments which are capable of crosslinking antigen, and a residual other fragment (which is termed pFc′).
  • Additional fragments can include diabodies, linear antibodies, single-chain antibody molecules, and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments.
  • “functional fragment” with respect to antibodies refers to Fv, F(ab) and F(ab′) 2 fragments.
  • an “Fv” fragment is the minimum antibody fragment that contains a complete antigen recognition and binding site. This region consists of a dimer of one heavy and one light chain variable domain in a tight, non-covalent association (V H -V L dimer). It is in this configuration that the three CDRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the V H -V L dimer. Collectively, the six CDRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three CDRs specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
  • the Fab fragment also designated as F(ab) also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain.
  • Fab′ fragments differ from Fab fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxyl terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region.
  • Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains have a free thiol group.
  • F(ab′) fragments are produced by cleavage of the disulfide bond at the hinge cysteines of the F(ab′) 2 pepsin digestion product. Additional chemical couplings of antibody fragments are known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • the present invention further provides monoclonal antibody, polyclonal antibody as well as humanized antibody.
  • an isolated peptide is used as an immunogen and is administered to a mammalian organism, such as a rat, rabbit or mouse.
  • the full-length protein, an antigenic peptide fragment or a fusion protein of the LCAT protein can be used. Particularly important fragments are those covering functional domains, some but not all the examples of the domains are identified in Tables.
  • Many methods are known for generating and/or identifying antibodies to a given target peptide. Several such methods are described by Harlow, Antibodies, Cold Spring Harbor Press, (1989).
  • the term “monoclonal antibody” as used herein refers to an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, i.e., the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible naturally occurring mutations that may be present in minor amounts. Monoclonal antibodies are highly specific, being directed against a single antigenic site. Furthermore, in contrast to conventional (polyclonal) antibody preparations which typically include different antibodies directed against different determinants (epitopes), each monoclonal antibody is directed against a single determinant on the antigen. In additional to their specificity, the monoclonal antibodies are advantageous in that they are synthesized by the hybridoma culture, uncontaminated by other immunoglobulins.
  • the modifier “monoclonal” antibody indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method.
  • the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the present invention may be made by the hybridoma method first described by Kohler and Milstein, Nature 256, 495 (1975), or may be made by recombinant methods, e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567.
  • the monoclonal antibodies for use with the present invention may also be isolated from phage antibody libraries using the techniques described in Clackson et al. Nature 352: 624-628 (1991), as well as in Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol. 222: 581-597 (1991).
  • For detailed procedure for making a monoclonal antibody see the Example below.
  • “Humanized” forms of non-human (e.g. murine or rabbit) antibodies are chimeric immunoglobulins, immunoglobulin chains or fragments thereof (such as Fv, Fab, Fab′, F(ab′).sub.2 or other antigen-binding subsequences of antibodies) which contain minimal sequence derived from non-human immunoglobulin.
  • humanized antibodies are human immunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a complementary determining region (CDR) of the recipient are replaced by residues from a CDR of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat or rabbit having the desired specificity, affinity and capacity.
  • humanized antibody may comprise residues, which are found neither in the recipient antibody nor in the imported CDR or framework sequences. These modifications are made to further refine and optimize antibody performance.
  • the humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the CDR regions correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin and all or substantially all of the FR regions are those of a human immunoglobulin consensus sequence.
  • the humanized antibody optimally also will comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin.
  • Fc immunoglobulin constant region
  • Polyclonal antibodies may be prepared by any known method or modifications of these methods including obtaining antibodies from patients. For example, a complex of an immunogen such as LCAT protein, peptides or fragments thereof and a carrier protein is prepared and an animal is immunized by the complex according to the same manner as that described with respect to the above monoclonal antibody preparation and the description in the Example. A serum or plasma containing the antibody against the protein is recovered from the immunized animal and the antibody is separated and purified. The gamma globulin fraction or the IgG antibodies can be obtained, for example, by use of saturated ammonium sulfate or DEAE Sephadex, or other techniques known to those skilled in the art.
  • an immunogen such as LCAT protein, peptides or fragments thereof and a carrier protein
  • a serum or plasma containing the antibody against the protein is recovered from the immunized animal and the antibody is separated and purified.
  • the gamma globulin fraction or the IgG antibodies can be obtained, for example,
  • the antibody titer in the antiserum can be measured according to the same manner as that described above with respect to the supernatant of the hybridoma culture. Separation and purification of the antibody can be carried out according to the same separation and purification method of antibody as that described with respect to the above monoclonal antibody and in the Example.
  • antibodies are preferably prepared from regions or discrete fragments of the LCAT proteins.
  • Antibodies can be prepared from any region of the peptide as described herein. In particular, they are selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and fragments of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • An antigenic fragment will typically comprise at least 8 contiguous amino acid residues.
  • the antigenic peptide can comprise, however, at least 10, 12, 14, 16 or more amino acid residues.
  • Such fragments can be selected on a physical property, such as fragments correspond to regions that are located on the surface of the protein, e.g., hydrophilic regions or can be selected based on sequence uniqueness.
  • Antibodies may also be produced by inducing production in the lymphocyte population or by screening antibody libraries or panels of highly specific binding reagents as disclosed in Orlandi et al. (1989; Proc Natl Acad Sci 86:3833-3837) or Winter et al. (1991; Nature 349:293-299).
  • a protein may be used in screening assays of phagemid or B-lymphocyte immunoglobulin libraries to identify antibodies having a desired specificity. Numerous protocols for competitive binding or immunoassays using either polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies with established specificities are well known in the art. Smith G. P., 1991, Curr. Opin. Biotechnol. 2: 668-673.
  • the antibodies of the present invention can also be generated using various phage display methods known in the art.
  • phage display methods functional antibody domains are displayed on the surface of phage particles which carry the polynucleotide sequences encoding them.
  • phage can be utilized to display antigen-binding domains expressed from a repertoire or combinatorial antibody library (e.g., human or murine).
  • Phage expressing an antigen binding domain that binds the antigen of interest can be selected or identified with antigen, e.g., using labeled antigen or antigen bound or captured to a solid surface or bead.
  • Phage used in these methods are typically filamentous phage including fd and M13 binding domains expressed from phage with Fab, Fv or disulfide stabilized Fv antibody domains recombinantly fused to either the phage gene III or gene VIII protein.
  • Examples of phage display methods that can be used to make the antibodies of the present invention include those disclosed in Brinkman et al., J. Immunol. Methods 182:41-50 (1995); Ames et al., J. Immunol. Methods 184:177-186 (1995); Kettleborough et al., Eur. J. Immunol.
  • Antibody can be also made recombinantly.
  • the antibody variant can be produced intracellularly, in the periplasmic space, or directly secreted into the medium. If the antibody variant is produced intracellularly, as a first step, the particulate debris, either host cells or lysed fragments, is removed, for example, by centrifugation or ultrafiltration. Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10: 163-167 (1992) describe a procedure for isolating antibodies which are secreted to the periplasmic space of E. coli .
  • cell paste is thawed in the presence of sodium acetate (pH 3.5), EDTA, and phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride (PMSF) over about 30 minutes.
  • PMSF phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride
  • Cell debris can be removed by centrifugation.
  • supernatants from such expression systems are generally first concentrated using a commercially available protein concentration filter, for example, an Amicon or Millipore Pellicon ultrafiltration unit.
  • a protease inhibitor such as PMSF may be included in any of the foregoing steps to inhibit proteolysis and antibiotics may be included to prevent the growth of adventitious contaminants.
  • the antibodies or antigen binding fragments may also be produced by genetic engineering.
  • the technology for expression of both heavy and light cain genes in E. coli is the subject the following PCT patent applications; publication number WO 901443, WO901443, and WO 9014424 and in Huse et al., 1989 Science 246:1275-1281.
  • the general recombinant methods are well known in the art.
  • the antibody composition prepared from the cells can be purified using, for example, hydroxylapatite chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, and affinity chromatography, with affinity chromatography being the preferred purification technique.
  • affinity chromatography is the preferred purification technique.
  • the suitability of protein A as an affinity ligand depends on the species and isotype of any immunoglobulin Fc domain that is present in the antibody.
  • Protein A can be used to purify antibodies that are based on human .delta.1, .delta.2 or .delta.4 heavy chains (Lindmark et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 62: 1-13 (1983)).
  • Protein G is recommended for all mouse isotypes and for human .delta.3 (Guss et al., EMBO J.
  • the matrix to which the affinity ligand is attached is most often agarose, but other matrices are available. Mechanically stable matrices such as controlled pore glass or poly(styrenedivinyl)benzene allow for faster flow rates and shorter processing times than can be achieved with agarose.
  • the antibody comprises a CH3 domain
  • the Bakerbond ABXTM resin J. T. Baker, Phillipsburg, N.J. is useful for purification.
  • the mixture comprising the antibody of interest and contaminants may be subjected to low pH hydrophobic interaction chromatography using an elution buffer at a pH between about 2.5-4.5, preferably performed at low salt concentrations (e.g., from about 0-0.25M salt).
  • the antibodies can be used to isolate one of the proteins of the present invention by standard techniques, such as affinity chromatography or immunoprecipitation.
  • the antibodies can facilitate the purification of the natural protein from cells and recombinantly produced protein expressed in host cells.
  • such antibodies are useful to detect the presence of one of the proteins of the present invention in cells or tissues to determine the pattern of expression of the protein among various tissues in an organism and over the course of normal development.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • antibodies can be used to detect protein in situ, in vitro, or in a cell lysate or supernatant in order to evaluate the abundance and pattern of expression. Also, such antibodies can be used to assess abnormal tissue distribution or abnormal expression during development or progression of a biological condition. Antibody detection of circulating fragments of the full length protein can be used to identify turnover.
  • the antibodies can be used to assess expression in disease states such as in active stages of the disease or in an individual with a predisposition toward disease related to the protein's function.
  • a disorder is caused by an inappropriate tissue distribution, developmental expression, level of expression of the protein, or expressed/processed form
  • the antibody can be prepared against the normal protein.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. If a disorder is characterized by a specific mutation in the protein, antibodies specific for this mutant protein can be used to assay for the presence of the specific mutant protein.
  • the antibodies can also be used to assess normal and aberrant subcellular localization of cells in the various tissues in an organism.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • the diagnostic uses can be applied, not only in genetic testing, but also in monitoring a treatment modality. Accordingly, where treatment is ultimately aimed at correcting expression level or the presence of aberrant sequence and aberrant tissue distribution or developmental expression, antibodies directed against the protein or relevant fragments can be used to monitor therapeutic efficacy. More detection and diagnosis methods are described in detail below.
  • antibodies are useful in pharmacogenomic analysis.
  • antibodies prepared against polymorphic proteins can be used to identify individuals that require modified treatment modalities.
  • the antibodies are also useful as diagnostic tools as an immunological marker for aberrant protein analyzed by electrophoretic mobility, isoelectric point, tryptic peptide digest, and other physical assays known to those in the art.
  • the antibodies are also useful for tissue typing. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. Thus, where a specific protein has been correlated with expression in a specific tissue, antibodies that are specific for this protein can be used to identify a tissue type.
  • the antibodies are also useful for inhibiting protein function, for example, blocking the binding of the LCAT peptide to a binding partner such as a substrate. These uses can also be applied in a therapeutic context in which treatment involves inhibiting the protein's function.
  • An antibody can be used, for example, to block binding, thus modulating (agonizing or antagonizing) the peptides activity.
  • Antibodies can be prepared against specific fragments containing sites required for function or against intact protein that is associated with a cell or cell membrane. More therapeutics methods are described in detail below.
  • kits for using antibodies to detect the presence of a protein in a biological sample can comprise antibodies such as a labeled or labelable antibody and a compound or agent for detecting protein in a biological sample; means for determining the amount of protein in the sample; means for comparing the amount of protein in the sample with a standard; and instructions for use.
  • a kit can be supplied to detect a single protein or epitope or can be configured to detect one of a multitude of epitopes, such as in an antibody detection array. Arrays are described in detail below for nucleic acid arrays and similar methods have been developed for antibody arrays.
  • the present invention further provides isolated nucleic acid molecules that encode a LCAT peptide or protein of the present invention.
  • Such nucleic acid molecules will consist of, consist essentially of, or comprise a nucleotide sequence that encodes one of the LCAT peptides of the present invention, an allelic variant thereof, or an ortholog or paralog thereof.
  • the nucleic acid molecules and the fragments thereof of the present invention pertains, however, are not to be construed as encompassing fragments that may be disclosed publicly prior to the present invention.
  • an “isolated” nucleic acid molecule is one that is separated from other nucleic acid present in the natural source of the nucleic acid.
  • an “isolated” nucleic acid is free of sequences which naturally flank the nucleic acid (i.e., sequences located at the 5′ and 3′ ends of the nucleic acid) in the genomic DNA of the organism from which the nucleic acid is derived.
  • flanking nucleotide sequences for example up to about 5 KB, 4 KB, 3 KB, 2 KB, or 1 KB or less, particularly contiguous peptide encoding sequences and peptide encoding sequences within the same gene but separated by introns in the genomic sequence.
  • nucleic acid is isolated from remote and unimportant flanking sequences such that it can be subjected to the specific manipulations described herein such as recombinant expression, preparation of probes and primers, and other uses specific to the nucleic acid sequences.
  • an “isolated” nucleic acid molecule such as a transcript/cDNA molecule, can be substantially free of other cellular material, or culture medium when produced by recombinant techniques, or chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized.
  • the nucleic acid molecule can be fused to other coding or regulatory sequences and still be considered isolated.
  • recombinant DNA molecules contained in a vector are considered isolated.
  • isolated DNA molecules include recombinant DNA molecules maintained in heterologous host cells or purified (partially or substantially) DNA molecules in solution.
  • isolated RNA molecules include in vivo or in vitro RNA transcripts of the isolated DNA molecules of the present invention.
  • Isolated nucleic acid molecules according to the present invention further include such molecules produced synthetically.
  • the present invention further provides nucleic acid molecules that comprise the nucleotide sequences shown in Table 2, (SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120), or any nucleic acid molecule that encodes the protein provided in Table 2, (SEQ ID NOS:1-1154).
  • a nucleic acid molecule comprises a nucleotide sequence when the nucleotide sequence is at least part of the final nucleotide sequence of the nucleic acid molecule. In such a fashion, the nucleic acid molecule can be only the nucleotide sequence or have additional nucleic acid residues, such as nucleic acid residues that are naturally associated with it or heterologous nucleotide sequences. Such a nucleic acid molecule can have a few additional nucleotides or can comprise several hundred or more additional nucleotides. A brief description of how various types of these nucleic acid molecules can be readily made/isolated is provided below.
  • human transcript sequences are provided. As discussed below, some of the non-coding regions, particularly gene regulatory elements such as promoters, are useful for a variety of purposes, e.g. control of heterologous gene expression, target for identifying gene activity modulating compounds, and are particularly claimed as fragments of the genomic sequence provided herein.
  • the isolated nucleic acid molecules can encode the mature protein plus additional amino or carboxyl-terminal amino acids, or amino acids interior to the mature peptide (when the mature form has more than one peptide chain, for instance).
  • Such sequences may play a role in processing of a protein from precursor to a mature form, facilitate protein trafficking, prolong or shorten protein half-life or facilitate manipulation of a protein for assay or production, among other things.
  • the additional amino acids may be processed away from the mature protein by cellular enzymes.
  • the isolated nucleic acid molecules include, but are not limited to, the sequence encoding the LCAT peptide alone, the sequence encoding the mature peptide and additional coding sequences, such as a leader or secretory sequence (e.g., a pre-pro or pro-protein sequence), the sequence encoding the mature peptide, with or without the additional coding sequences, plus additional non-coding sequences, for example introns and non-coding 5′ and 3′ sequences such as transcribed but non-translated sequences that play a role in transcription, mRNA processing (including splicing and polyadenylation signals), ribosome binding and stability of mRNA.
  • the nucleic acid molecule may be fused to a marker sequence encoding, for example, a peptide that facilitates purification.
  • Isolated nucleic acid molecules can be in the form of RNA, such as mRNA, or in the form DNA, including cDNA and genomic DNA obtained by cloning or produced by chemical synthetic techniques or by a combination thereof.
  • the nucleic acid, especially DNA can be double-stranded or single-stranded.
  • Single-stranded nucleic acid can be the coding strand (sense strand) or the non-coding strand (anti-sense strand).
  • the invention further provides nucleic acid molecules that encode fragments of the peptides of the present invention as well as nucleic acid molecules that encode obvious variants of the LCAT proteins of the present invention that are described above.
  • nucleic acid molecules may be naturally occurring, such as allelic variants (same locus), paralogs (different locus), and orthologs (different organism), or may be constructed by recombinant DNA methods or by chemical synthesis.
  • non-naturally occurring variants may be made by mutagenesis techniques, including those applied to nucleic acid molecules, cells, or organisms. Accordingly, as discussed above, the variants can contain nucleotide substitutions, deletions, inversions and insertions. Variation can occur in either or both the coding and non-coding regions. The variations can produce both conservative and non-conservative amino acid substitutions.
  • the present invention further provides non-coding fragments of the nucleic acid molecules provided in Tables 1 and 2.
  • Preferred non-coding fragments include, but are not limited to, promoter sequences, enhancer sequences, gene modulating sequences and gene termination sequences. Such fragments are useful in controlling heterologous gene expression and in developing screens to identify gene-modulating agents.
  • a promoter can readily be identified as being 5′ to the ATG start site in the genomic sequence.
  • a fragment comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence greater than 12 or more nucleotides. Further, a fragment could at least 30, 40, 50, 100, 250 or 500 nucleotides in length. The length of the fragment will be based on its intended use. For example, the fragment can encode epitope bearing regions of the peptide, or can be useful as DNA probes and primers. Such fragments can be isolated using the known nucleotide sequence to synthesize an oligonucleotide probe. A labeled probe can then be used to screen a cDNA library, genomic DNA library, or mRNA to isolate nucleic acid corresponding to the coding region. Further, primers can be used in PCR reactions to clone specific regions of gene.
  • a probe/primer typically comprises substantially a purified oligonucleotide or oligonucleotide pair.
  • the oligonucleotide typically comprises a region of nucleotide sequence that hybridizes under stringent conditions to at least about 12, 20, 25, 40, 50 or more consecutive nucleotides.
  • Orthologs, homologs, and allelic variants can be identified using methods well known in the art. As described in the Peptide Section, these variants comprise a nucleotide sequence encoding a peptide that is typically 60-70%, 70-80%, 80-90%, and more typically at least about 90-95% or more homologous to the nucleotide sequence shown in the Table 2 or a fragment of this sequence. Such nucleic acid molecules can readily be identified as being able to hybridize under moderate to stringent conditions, to the nucleotide sequence shown in the Figure sheets or a fragment of the sequence. Allelic variants can readily be determined by genetic locus of the encoding gene.
  • hybridizes under stringent conditions is intended to describe conditions for hybridization and washing under which nucleotide sequences encoding a peptide at least 60-70% homologous to each other typically remain hybridized to each other.
  • the conditions can be such that sequences at least about 60%, at least about 70%, or at least about 80% or more homologous to each other typically remain hybridized to each other.
  • stringent conditions are known to those skilled in the art and can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. (1989), 6.3.1-6.3.6.
  • stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6 ⁇ sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45 C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2 ⁇ SSC, 0.1% SDS at 50-65 C.
  • SSC sodium chloride/sodium citrate
  • Examples of moderate to low stringency hybridization conditions are well known in the art.
  • the nucleic acid molecules of the present invention are useful for probes, primers, chemical intermediates, and in biological assays.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are useful as a hybridization probe for messenger RNA, transcript/cDNA and genomic DNA to isolate full-length cDNA and genomic clones encoding the peptide described in Tables 1 and 2 and to isolate cDNA and genomic clones that correspond to variants (alleles, orthologs, etc.) producing the same or related peptides shown in Tables 1 and 2.
  • the probe can correspond to any sequence along the entire length of the nucleic acid molecules provided in the Tables. Accordingly, it could be derived from 5′ noncoding regions, the coding region, and 3′ noncoding regions. However, as discussed, fragments are not to be construed as encompassing fragments disclosed prior to the present invention.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful as primers for PCR to amplify any given region of a nucleic acid molecule and are useful to synthesize antisense molecules of desired length and sequence.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing recombinant vectors.
  • Such vectors include expression vectors that express a portion of, or all of, the peptide sequences.
  • Vectors also include insertion vectors, used to integrate into another nucleic acid molecule sequence, such as into the cellular genome, to alter in situ expression of a gene and/or gene product.
  • an endogenous coding sequence can be replaced via homologous recombination with all or part of the coding region containing one or more specifically introduced mutations.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for expressing antigenic portions of the proteins.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful as probes for determining the chromosomal positions of the nucleic acid molecules by means of in situ hybridization methods.
  • nucleic acid molecules are also useful in making vectors containing the gene regulatory regions of the nucleic acid molecules of the present invention.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for designing ribozymes corresponding to all, or a part, of the mRNA produced from the nucleic acid molecules described herein.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for making vectors that express part, or all, of the peptides.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing host cells expressing a part, or all, of the nucleic acid molecules and peptides.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing transgenic animals expressing all, or a part, of the nucleic acid molecules and peptides.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful as hybridization probes for determining the presence, level, form and distribution of nucleic acid expression.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. Accordingly, the probes can be used to detect the presence of, or to determine levels of, a specific nucleic acid molecule in cells, tissues, and in organisms.
  • the nucleic acid whose level is determined can be DNA or RNA. Accordingly, probes corresponding to the peptides described herein can be used to assess expression and/or gene copy number in a given cell, tissue, or organism. These uses are relevant for diagnosis of disorders involving an increase or decrease in LCAT protein expression relative to normal results.
  • In vitro techniques for detection of mRNA include Northern hybridizations and in situ hybridizations.
  • In vitro techniques for detecting DNA include Southern hybridizations and in situ hybridization.
  • Probes can be used as a part of a diagnostic test kit for identifying cells or tissues that express a LCAT protein, such as by measuring a level of a LCAT-encoding nucleic acid in a sample of cells from a subject e.g., mRNA or genomic DNA, or determining if a LCAT gene has been mutated.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. More detection and diagnosis methods are described in detail below.
  • Nucleic acid expression assays are useful for drug screening to identify compounds that modulate LCAT nucleic acid expression.
  • the invention thus provides a method for identifying a compound that can be used to treat a disorder associated with nucleic acid expression of the LCAT gene, particularly biological and pathological processes that are mediated by the LCAT in cells and tissues that express it.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • the method typically includes assaying the ability of the compound to modulate the expression of the LCAT nucleic acid and thus identifying a compound that can be used to treat a disorder characterized by undesired LCAT nucleic acid expression.
  • the assays can be performed in cell-based and cell-free systems. Cell-based assays include cells naturally expressing the LCAT nucleic acid or recombinant cells genetically engineered to express specific nucleic acid sequences.
  • the assay for LCAT nucleic acid expression can involve direct assay of nucleic acid levels, such as mRNA levels, or on collateral compounds involved in the signal pathway. Further, the expression of genes that are up- or down-regulated in response to the LCAT protein signal pathway can also be assayed. In this embodiment the regulatory regions of these genes can be operably linked to a reporter gene such as luciferase.
  • modulators of LCAT gene expression can be identified in a method wherein a cell is contacted with a candidate compound or agent and the expression of mRNA determined.
  • the level of expression of LCAT mRNA in the presence of the candidate compound or agent is compared to the level of expression of LCAT mRNA in the absence of the candidate compound or agent.
  • the candidate compound can then be identified as a modulator of nucleic acid expression based on this comparison and be used, for example to treat a disorder characterized by aberrant nucleic acid expression.
  • expression of mRNA is statistically significantly greater in the presence of the candidate compound than in its absence, the candidate compound is identified as a stimulator of nucleic acid expression.
  • nucleic acid expression is statistically significantly less in the presence of the candidate compound than in its absence, the candidate compound is identified as an inhibitor of nucleic acid expression.
  • the invention further provides methods of treatment, with the nucleic acid as a target, using a compound or an agent identified through drug screening as a gene modulator to modulate LCAT nucleic acid expression in cells and tissues that express the LCAT.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. Modulation includes both up-regulation (i.e. activation or agonization) or down-regulation (suppression or antagonization) or nucleic acid expression.
  • a modulator for nucleic acid expression can be a small molecule or drug identified using the screening assays described herein as long as the drug or small molecule inhibits the LCAT nucleic acid expression in the cells and tissues that express the protein.
  • Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for monitoring the effectiveness of modulating compounds or agents on the expression or activity of the LCAT gene in clinical trials or in a treatment regimen.
  • the gene expression pattern can serve as a barometer for the continuing effectiveness of treatment with the compound, particularly with compounds to which a patient can develop resistance.
  • the gene expression pattern can also serve as a marker indicative of a physiological response of the affected cells to the compound. Accordingly, such monitoring would allow either increased administration of the compound or the administration of alternative compounds to which the patient has not become resistant. Similarly, if the level of nucleic acid expression falls below a desirable level, administration of the compound could be commensurately decreased.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful in diagnostic assays for qualitative changes in LCAT nucleic acid expression, and particularly in qualitative changes that lead to pathology.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be used to detect mutations in LCAT genes and gene expression products such as mRNA.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be used as hybridization probes to detect naturally occurring genetic mutations in the LCAT gene and thereby to determine whether a subject with the mutation is at risk for a disorder caused by the mutation. Mutations include deletion, addition, or substitution of one or more nucleotides in the gene, chromosomal rearrangement, such as inversion or transposition, modification of genomic DNA, such as aberrant methylation patterns or changes in gene copy number, such as amplification. Detection of a mutated form of the LCAT gene associated with a dysfunction provides a diagnostic tool for an active disease or susceptibility to disease when the disease results from overexpression, underexpression, or altered expression of a LCAT protein.
  • Genomic DNA can be analyzed directly or can be amplified by using PCR prior to analysis.
  • RNA or cDNA can be used in the same way.
  • detection of the mutation involves the use of a probe/primer in a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) (see, e.g. U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • PCR polymerase chain reaction
  • This method can include the steps of collecting a sample of cells from a patient, isolating nucleic acid (e.g., genomic, mRNA or both) from the cells of the sample, contacting the nucleic acid sample with one or more primers which specifically hybridize to a gene under conditions such that hybridization and amplification of the gene (if present) occurs, and detecting the presence or absence of an amplification product, or detecting the size of the amplification product and comparing the length to a control sample. Deletions and insertions can be detected by a change in size of the amplified product compared to the normal genotype. Point mutations can be identified by hybridizing amplified DNA to normal RNA or antisense DNA sequences.
  • nucleic acid e.g., genomic, mRNA or both
  • LCAT gene can be directly identified, for example, by alterations in restriction enzyme digestion patterns determined by gel electrophoresis.
  • sequence-specific ribozymes can be used to score for the presence of specific mutations by development or loss of a ribozyme cleavage site. Perfectly matched sequences can be distinguished from mismatched sequences by nuclease cleavage digestion assays or by differences in melting temperature.
  • Sequence changes at specific locations can also be assessed by nuclease protection assays such as RNase and S1 protection or the chemical cleavage method.
  • sequence differences between a mutant LCAT gene and a wild-type gene can be determined by direct DNA sequencing.
  • a variety of automated sequencing procedures can be utilized when performing the diagnostic assays (Naeve, C. W., (1995) Biotechniques 19:448), including sequencing by mass spectrometry (see, e.g., PCT International Publication No. WO 94/16101; Cohen et al., Adv. Chromatogr. 36:127-162 (1996); and Griffin et al., Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 38:147-159 (1993)).
  • RNA/RNA or RNA/DNA duplexes Other methods for detecting mutations in the gene include methods in which protection from cleavage agents is used to detect mismatched bases in RNA/RNA or RNA/DNA duplexes (Myers et al., Science 230:1242 (1985)); Cotton et al., PNAS 85:4397 (1988); Saleeba et al., Meth. Enzymol. 217:286-295 (1992)), electrophoretic mobility of mutant and wild type nucleic acid is compared (Orita et al., PNAS 86:2766 (1989); Cotton et al., Mutat. Res. 285:125-144 (1993); and Hayashi et al., Genet. Anal. Tech. Appl.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are also useful for testing an individual for a genotype that while not necessarily causing the disease, nevertheless affects the treatment modality.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be used to study the relationship between an individual's genotype and the individual's response to a compound used for treatment (pharmacogenomic relationship).
  • the nucleic acid molecules described herein can be used to assess the mutation content of the LCAT gene in an individual in order to select an appropriate compound or dosage regimen for treatment.
  • nucleic acid molecules displaying genetic variations that affect treatment provide a diagnostic target that can be used to tailor treatment in an individual. Accordingly, the production of recombinant cells and animals containing these polymorphisms allow effective clinical design of treatment compounds and dosage regimens.
  • the nucleic acid molecules are thus useful as antisense constructs to control LCAT gene expression in cells, tissues, and organisms.
  • a DNA antisense nucleic acid molecule is designed to be complementary to a region of the gene involved in transcription, preventing transcription and hence production of LCAT protein.
  • An antisense RNA or DNA nucleic acid molecule would hybridize to the mRNA and thus block translation of mRNA into LCAT protein.
  • RNA interference RNA interference
  • RNAi RNA interference
  • ds double-stranded
  • the present invention relates to isolated RNA molecules (double-stranded; single-stranded) of from about 21 to about 25 nucleotides which mediate RNAi.
  • about 21 to about 25 nt includes nucleotides 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28 and 29 nucleotides in length.
  • the isolated RNAs of the present invention mediate degradation of mRNA, the transcriptional product of a gene. Such mRNA is also referred to herein as mRNA to be degraded.
  • RNA, RNA molecule(s), RNA segment(s) and RNA fragment(s) are used interchangeably to refer to RNA that mediates RNA interference.
  • RNA molecules of the present invention can also comprise non-standard nucleotides, including non-naturally occurring nucleotides or deoxyribonucleotides.
  • RNA of 21-25 nucleotides of the present invention need only be sufficiently similar to natural RNA that it has the ability to mediate RNAi.
  • mediates RNAi refers to the ability to distinguish which RNAs are to be degraded by the RNAi machinery or process.
  • RNA that mediates RNAi interacts with the RNAi machinery such that it directs the degradation of particular mRNAs.
  • Such RNA may include RNAs of various structure, including short hairpin RNA.
  • the present invention relates to RNA molecules of about 21 to about 25 nucleotides that direct cleavage of specific mRNA to which their sequence corresponds. It is not necessary that there be perfect correspondence of the sequences, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the RNA to direct RNAi cleavage of the target mRNA (Holen et al. (2005) Nucleic Acids Res. 33, 4704-4710).
  • the 21-25 nt RNA molecules of the present invention comprise a 3′ hydroxyl group.
  • the present invention relates to 21-25 nt RNAs of specific genes, produced by chemical synthesis or recombinant DNA techniques, that mediate RNAi.
  • isolated RNA includes RNA obtained by any means, including processing or cleavage of dsRNA; production by chemical synthetic methods; and production by recombinant DNA techniques.
  • the invention further relates to uses of the 21-25 nt RNAs, such as for therapeutic or prophylactic treatment and compositions comprising 21-25 nt RNAs that mediate RNAi, such as pharmaceutical compositions comprising 21-25 nt RNAs and an appropriate carrier.
  • the present invention also relates to a method of mediating RNA interference of genes of a patient.
  • RNA of about 21 to about 25 nt which targets the specific mRNA to be degraded is introduced into a patient's cells. The cells are maintained under conditions allowing degradation of the mRNA, resulting in RNA-mediated interference of the mRNA of the gene in the cells of the patient.
  • Treatment of patients with cancer with the RNAi will inhibit the growth and spread of the cancer and reduce the tumor.
  • Treatment of patients using RNAi can also be in combination with other anti-cancer compounds.
  • the RNAi may be used in combination with other treatment modalities, such as chemotherapy, cryotherapy, hyperthermia, radiation therapy, and other similar treatments.
  • a chemotherapy agent was combined with the RNAi.
  • a chemotherapy named Gemzar was used.
  • RNA may be directly introduced into the cell, or introduced extracellularly into a cavity, interstitial space, into the circulation of a patient, or introduced orally.
  • Methods for oral introduction include direct mixing of the RNA with food, as well as engineered approaches in which a species that is used as food is engineered to express the RNA and then ingested.
  • Physical methods of introducing nucleic acids for example, injection directly into the cell or extracellular injection into the patient, may also be used.
  • Vascular or extravascular circulation, the blood or lymph system, and the cerebrospinal fluid are sites where the RNA may be introduced.
  • RNA may be introduced into an embryonic stem cell, or another multipotent cell derived from the patient.
  • introducing nucleic acids include injection of a solution containing the RNA, bombardment by particles covered by the RNA, soaking cells or tissue in a solution of the RNA, or electroporation of cell membranes in the presence of the RNA.
  • a viral construct packaged into a viral particle may be used to introduce an expression construct into the cell, with the construct expressing RNA.
  • Other methods known in the art for introducing nucleic acids to cells may be used, such as lipid-mediated carrier transport, chemical-mediated transport, and the like.
  • the RNA may be introduced along with components that perform one or more of the following activities: enhance RNA uptake by the cell, promote annealing of the duplex strands, stabilize the annealed strands, or otherwise increase inhibition of the target gene.
  • the RNAi may be used in combination with other treatment modalities, such as chemotherapy, cryotherapy, hyperthermia, radiation therapy, and the like.
  • the present invention may be used alone or as a component of a kit having at least one of the reagents necessary to carry out the in vitro or in vivo introduction of RNA to tissue or patients.
  • Preferred components are the dsRNA and a vehicle that promotes introduction of the dsRNA.
  • Such a kit may also include instructions to allow a user of the kit to practice the invention.
  • a class of antisense molecules can be used to inactivate mRNA in order to decrease expression of LCAT nucleic acid. Accordingly, these molecules can treat a disorder characterized by abnormal or undesired LCAT nucleic acid expression.
  • This technique involves cleavage by means of ribozymes containing nucleotide sequences complementary to one or more regions in the mRNA that attenuate the ability of the mRNA to be translated. Possible regions include coding regions and particularly coding regions corresponding to the catalytic and other functional activities of the LCAT protein, such as substrate binding.
  • the nucleic acid molecules also provide vectors for gene therapy in patients containing cells that are aberrant in LCAT gene expression.
  • recombinant cells which include the patient's cells that have been engineered ex vivo and returned to the patient, are introduced into an individual where the cells produce the desired LCAT protein to treat the individual.
  • kits for detecting the presence of a LCAT nucleic acid in a biological sample are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • the kit can comprise reagents such as a labeled or labelable nucleic acid or agent capable of detecting LCAT nucleic acid in a biological sample; means for determining the amount of LCAT nucleic acid in the sample; and means for comparing the amount of LCAT nucleic acid in the sample with a standard.
  • the compound or agent can be packaged in a suitable container.
  • the kit can further comprise instructions for using the kit to detect LCAT protein mRNA or DNA.
  • the invention also provides vectors containing the nucleic acid molecules described herein.
  • the term “vector” refers to a vehicle, preferably a nucleic acid molecule, which can transport the nucleic acid molecules.
  • the vector is a nucleic acid molecule, the nucleic acid molecules are covalently linked to the vector nucleic acid.
  • the vector includes a plasmid, single or double stranded phage, a single or double stranded RNA or DNA viral vector, or artificial chromosome, such as a BAC, PAC, YAC, OR MAC.
  • a vector can be maintained in the host cell as an extrachromosomal element where it replicates and produces additional copies of the nucleic acid molecules.
  • the vector may integrate into the host cell genome and produce additional copies of the nucleic acid molecules when the host cell replicates.
  • the invention provides vectors for the maintenance (cloning vectors) or vectors for expression (expression vectors) of the nucleic acid molecules.
  • the vectors can function in prokaryotic or eukaryotic cells or in both (shuttle vectors).
  • Expression vectors contain cis-acting regulatory regions that are operably linked in the vector to the nucleic acid molecules such that transcription of the nucleic acid molecules is allowed in a host cell.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be introduced into the host cell with a separate nucleic acid molecule capable of affecting transcription.
  • the second nucleic acid molecule may provide a trans-acting factor interacting with the cis-regulatory control region to allow transcription of the nucleic acid molecules from the vector.
  • a trans-acting factor may be supplied by the host cell.
  • a trans-acting factor can be produced from the vector itself. It is understood, however, that in some embodiments, transcription and/or translation of the nucleic acid molecules can occur in a cell-free system.
  • the regulatory sequences to which the nucleic acid molecules described herein can be operably linked include promoters for directing mRNA transcription. These include, but are not limited to, the left promoter from bacteriophage, the lac, TRP, and TAC promoters from E. coli , the early and late promoters from SV40, the CMV immediate early promoter, the adenovirus early and late promoters, and retrovirus long-terminal repeats.
  • expression vectors may also include regions that modulate transcription, such as repressor binding sites and enhancers.
  • regions that modulate transcription include the SV40 enhancer, the cytomegalovirus immediate early enhancer, polyoma enhancer, adenovirus enhancers, and retrovirus LTR enhancers.
  • expression vectors can also contain sequences necessary for transcription termination and, in the transcribed region a ribosome binding site for translation.
  • Other regulatory control elements for expression include initiation and termination codons as well as polyadenylation signals.
  • the person of ordinary skill in the art would be aware of the numerous regulatory sequences that are useful in expression vectors. Such regulatory sequences are described, for example, in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • a variety of expression vectors can be used to express a nucleic acid molecule.
  • Such vectors include chromosomal, episomal, and virus-derived vectors, for example vectors derived from bacterial plasmids, from bacteriophage, from yeast episomes, from yeast chromosomal elements, including yeast artificial chromosomes, from viruses such as baculoviruses, papovaviruses such as SV40, Vaccinia viruses, adenoviruses, poxviruses, pseudorabies viruses, and retroviruses.
  • Vectors may also be derived from combinations of these sources such as those derived from plasmid and bacteriophage genetic elements, e.g. cosmids and phagemids.
  • the regulatory sequence may provide constitutive expression in one or more host cells (i.e. tissue specific) or may provide for inducible expression in one or more cell types such as by temperature, nutrient additive, or exogenous factor such as a hormone or other ligand.
  • host cells i.e. tissue specific
  • inducible expression in one or more cell types such as by temperature, nutrient additive, or exogenous factor such as a hormone or other ligand.
  • a variety of vectors providing for constitutive and inducible expression in prokaryotic and eukaryotic hosts are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be inserted into the vector nucleic acid by well-known methodology.
  • the DNA sequence that will ultimately be expressed is joined to an expression vector by cleaving the DNA sequence and the expression vector with one or more restriction enzymes and then ligating the fragments together. Procedures for restriction enzyme digestion and ligation are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • Bacterial cells include, but are not limited to, E. coli, Streptomyces , and Salmonella typhimurium .
  • Eukaryotic cells include, but are not limited to, yeast, insect cells such as Drosophila , animal cells such as COS and CHO cells, and plant cells.
  • the invention provides fusion vectors that allow for the production of the peptides.
  • Fusion vectors can increase the expression of a recombinant protein; increase the solubility of the recombinant protein, and aid in the purification of the protein by acting for example as a ligand for affinity purification.
  • a proteolytic cleavage site may be introduced at the junction of the fusion moiety so that the desired peptide can ultimately be separated from the fusion moiety.
  • Proteolytic enzymes include, but are not limited to, factor Xa, thrombin, and enteroenzyme.
  • Typical fusion expression vectors include pGEX (Smith et al., Gene 67:31-40 (1988)), pMAL (New England Biolabs, Beverly, Mass.) and pRIT5 (Pharmacia, Piscataway, N.J.) which fuse glutathione S-transferase (GST), maltose E binding protein, or protein A, respectively, to the target recombinant protein.
  • GST glutathione S-transferase
  • suitable inducible non-fusion E. coli expression vectors include pTrc (Amann et al., Gene 69:301-315 (1988)) and pET 11d (Studier et al., Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185:60-89 (1990)).
  • Recombinant protein expression can be maximized in host bacteria by providing a genetic background wherein the host cell has an impaired capacity to proteolytically cleave the recombinant protein.
  • the sequence of the nucleic acid molecule of interest can be altered to provide preferential codon usage for a specific host cell, for example E. coli . (Wada et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 20:2111-2118 (1992)).
  • the nucleic acid molecules can also be expressed by expression vectors that are operative in yeast.
  • yeast e.g., S. cerevisiae
  • vectors for expression in yeast include pYepSec1 (Baldari, et al., EMBO J. 6:229-234 (1987)), pMFa (Kurjan et al., Cell 30:933-943 (1982)), pJRY88 (Schultz et al., Gene 54:113-123 (1987)), and pYES2 (Invitrogen Corporation, San Diego, Calif.).
  • the nucleic acid molecules can also be expressed in insect cells using, for example, baculovirus expression vectors.
  • Baculovirus vectors available for expression of proteins in cultured insect cells include the pAc series (Smith et al., Mol. Cell. Biol. 3:2156-2165 (1983)) and the pVL series (Lucklow et al., Virology 170:31-39 (1989)).
  • the nucleic acid molecules described herein are expressed in mammalian cells using mammalian expression vectors.
  • mammalian expression vectors include pCDM8 (Seed, B. Nature 329:840 (1987)) and pMT2PC (Kaufman et al., EMBO J. 6:187-195 (1987)).
  • the expression vectors listed herein are provided by way of example only of the well-known vectors available to those of ordinary skill in the art that would be useful to express the nucleic acid molecules.
  • the person of ordinary skill in the art would be aware of other vectors suitable for maintenance propagation or expression of the nucleic acid molecules described herein. These are found for example in Sambrook, J., Fritsh, E. F., and Maniatis, T. Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • the invention also encompasses vectors in which the nucleic acid sequences described herein are cloned into the vector in reverse orientation, but operably linked to a regulatory sequence that permits transcription of antisense RNA.
  • an antisense transcript can be produced to all, or to a portion, of the nucleic acid molecule sequences described herein, including both coding and non-coding regions. Expression of this antisense RNA is subject to each of the parameters described above in relation to expression of the sense RNA (regulatory sequences, constitutive or inducible expression, tissue-specific expression).
  • the invention also relates to recombinant host cells containing the vectors described herein.
  • Host cells therefore include prokaryotic cells, lower eukaryotic cells such as yeast, other eukaryotic cells such as insect cells, and higher eukaryotic cells such as mammalian cells.
  • the recombinant host cells are prepared by introducing the vector constructs described herein into the cells by techniques readily available to the person of ordinary skill in the art. These include, but are not limited to, calcium phosphate transfection, DEAE-dextran-mediated transfection, cationic lipid-mediated transfection, electroporation, transduction, infection, lipofection, and other techniques such as those found in Sambrook, et al. (Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • Host cells can contain more than one vector.
  • different nucleotide sequences can be introduced on different vectors of the same cell.
  • the nucleic acid molecules can be introduced either alone or with other nucleic acid molecules that are not related to the nucleic acid molecules such as those providing trans-acting factors for expression vectors.
  • the vectors can be introduced independently, co-introduced or joined to the nucleic acid molecule vector.
  • bacteriophage and viral vectors these can be introduced into cells as packaged or encapsulated virus by standard procedures for infection and transduction.
  • Viral vectors can be replication-competent or replication-defective. In the case in which viral replication is defective, replication will occur in host cells providing functions that complement the defects.
  • Vectors generally include selectable markers that enable the selection of the subpopulation of cells that contain the recombinant vector constructs.
  • the marker can be contained in the same vector that contains the nucleic acid molecules described herein or may be on a separate vector. Markers include tetracycline or ampicillin-resistance genes for prokaryotic host cells and dihydrofolate reductase or neomycin resistance for eukaryotic host cells. However, any marker that provides selection for a phenotypic trait will be effective.
  • RNA derived from the DNA constructs described herein can be produced in bacteria, yeast, mammalian cells, and other cells under the control of the appropriate regulatory sequences, cell-free transcription and translation systems can also be used to produce these proteins using RNA derived from the DNA constructs described herein.
  • secretion of the peptide is desired, which is difficult to achieve with multi-transmembrane domain containing proteins such as LCATs, appropriate secretion signals are incorporated into the vector.
  • the signal sequence can be endogenous to the peptides or heterologous to these peptides.
  • the protein can be isolated from the host cell by standard disruption procedures, including freeze thaw, sonication, mechanical disruption, use of lysing agents and the like.
  • the peptide can then be recovered and purified by well-known purification methods including ammonium sulfate precipitation, acid extraction, anion or cationic exchange chromatography, phosphocellulose chromatography, hydrophobic-interaction chromatography, affinity chromatography, hydroxylapatite chromatography, lectin chromatography, or high performance liquid chromatography.
  • the peptides can have various glycosylation patterns, depending upon the cell, or maybe non-glycosylated as when produced in bacteria.
  • the peptides may include an initial modified methionine in some cases as a result of a host-mediated process.
  • the recombinant host cells expressing the peptides described herein have a variety of uses.
  • the cells are useful for producing a LCAT protein or peptide that can be further purified to produce desired amounts of LCAT protein or fragments.
  • host cells containing expression vectors are useful for peptide production.
  • Host cells are also useful for conducting cell-based assays involving the LCAT protein or LCAT protein fragments, such as those described above as well as other formats known in the art.
  • a recombinant host cell expressing a native LCAT protein is useful for assaying compounds that stimulate or inhibit LCAT protein function.
  • Host cells are also useful for identifying LCAT protein mutants in which these functions are affected. If the mutants naturally occur and give rise to a pathology, host cells containing the mutations are useful to assay compounds that have a desired effect on the mutant LCAT protein (for example, stimulating or inhibiting function) which may not be indicated by their effect on the native LCAT protein.
  • a transgenic animal is preferably a mammal, for example a rodent, such as a rat or mouse, in which one or more of the cells of the animal include a transgene.
  • a transgene is exogenous DNA which is integrated into the genome of a cell from which a transgenic animal develops and which remains in the genome of the mature animal in one or more cell types or tissues of the transgenic animal. These animals are useful for studying the function of a LCAT protein and identifying and evaluating modulators of LCAT protein activity.
  • Other examples of transgenic animals include non-human primates, sheep, dogs, cows, goats, chickens, and amphibians.
  • a transgenic animal can be produced by introducing nucleic acid into the male pronuclei of a fertilized oocyte, e.g., by microinjection, retroviral infection, and allowing the oocyte to develop in a pseudopregnant female foster animal.
  • Any of the LCAT protein nucleotide sequences can be introduced as a transgene into the genome of a non-human animal, such as a mouse.
  • Any of the regulatory or other sequences useful in expression vectors can form part of the transgenic sequence. This includes intronic sequences and polyadenylation signals, if not already included.
  • a tissue-specific regulatory sequence(s) can be operably linked to the transgene to direct expression of the LCAT protein to particular cells.
  • transgenic founder animal can be identified based upon the presence of the transgene in its genome and/or expression of transgenic mRNA in tissues or cells of the animals. A transgenic founder animal can then be used to breed additional animals carrying the transgene.
  • transgenic animals carrying a transgene can further be bred to other transgenic animals carrying other transgenes.
  • a transgenic animal also includes animals in which the entire animal or tissues in the animal have been produced using the homologously recombinant host cells described herein.
  • transgenic non-human animals can be produced which contain selected systems that allow for regulated expression of the transgene.
  • a system is the cre/loxP recombinase system of bacteriophage P1.
  • cre/loxP recombinase system of bacteriophage P1.
  • FLP recombinase system of S. cerevisiae (O'Gorman et al. Science 251:1351-1355 (1991).
  • mice containing transgenes encoding both the Cre recombinase and a selected protein is required.
  • Such animals can be provided through the construction of “double” transgenic animals, e.g., by mating two transgenic animals, one containing a transgene encoding a selected protein and the other containing a transgene encoding a recombinase.
  • Clones of the non-human transgenic animals described herein can also be produced according to the methods described in Wilmut, I. et al. Nature 385:810-813 (1997) and PCT International Publication Nos. WO 97/07668 and WO 97/07669.
  • a cell e.g., a somatic cell
  • the quiescent cell can then be fused, e.g., through the use of electrical pulses, to an enucleated oocyte from an animal of the same species from which the quiescent cell is isolated.
  • the reconstructed oocyte is then cultured such that it develops to morula or blastocyst and then transferred to pseudopregnant female foster animal.
  • the offspring born of this female foster animal will be a clone of the animal from which the cell, e.g., the somatic cell, is isolated.
  • Transgenic animals containing recombinant cells that express the peptides described herein are useful to conduct the assays described herein in an in vivo context. Accordingly, the various physiological factors that are present in vivo and that could effect substrate binding, LCAT protein activation, and signal transduction, may not be evident from in vitro cell-free or cell-based assays. Accordingly, it is useful to provide non-human transgenic animals to assay in vivo LCAT protein function, including substrate interaction, the effect of specific mutant LCAT proteins on LCAT protein function and substrate interaction, and the effect of chimeric LCAT proteins. It is also possible to assess the effect of null mutations, that is, mutations that substantially or completely eliminate one or more LCAT protein functions.
  • the present invention provides a method for detecting LCAT nucleic acids, proteins, peptides and fragments thereof that are differentially expressed in lung diseases in a test sample, preferably in a biological sample.
  • the present invention further provides a method for diagnosing the lung diseases, by detecting the nucleic acids, proteins, peptides and fragments thereof.
  • the further embodiment includes but is not limited to, monitoring the disease prognosis (recurrence), diagnosing disease stage, preventing the disease and treating the disease. While the protein is overexpressed, the expression of LCAT is preferably greater than about 20%, or preferably greater than about 30%, and most preferably greater than about 50% or more of lung disease sample, at a level that is at least two fold, and preferably at least five fold, greater than the level of expression in control samples, as determined using a representative assay provided herein.
  • the expression of LCAT is preferably less than about 20%, or preferably less than 30%, and most preferably less than about 50% or more of the lung disease sample, at a level that is at least 0.5 fold, and preferably at least 0.2 fold less than the level of the expression in control samples, as determined using a representative assay provided herein.
  • a “biological sample” can be collected from tissues, blood, sera, cell lines or biological fluids such as, plasma, interstitial fluid, urine, cerebrospinal fluid, and the like, containing cells.
  • a biological sample comprises cells or tissues suspected of having diseases (e.g., cells obtained from a biopsy).
  • a “differential level” is defined as the level of LCAT protein or nucleic acids in a test sample either above or below the level of the ones in control samples, wherein the level of control samples is obtained either from a control cell line, a normal tissue or body fluids, or combination thereof, from a healthy subject.
  • a “subject” can be a mammalian subject or non mammalian subject, preferably, a mammalian subject.
  • a mammalian subject can be human or non-human, preferably human.
  • a healthy subject is defined as a subject without detectable lung diseases or lung associated diseases by using conventional diagnostic methods.
  • diseases include lung diseases and lung associated disease.
  • cancer includes epithelial-cell related cancers, for example pancreatic, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian, breast as well as bladder and renal cancer.
  • RNA corresponding to a LCAT gene is detected by hybridization to an antisense oligonucleotide (described below).
  • RNA expression is detected by hybridization assays such as Northern blots, RNase assays, reverse transcriptase PCR amplification, and the like.
  • hybridization assays such as Northern blots, RNase assays, reverse transcriptase PCR amplification, and the like.
  • One preferred detection method is using RT PCR by using TaqMan technology (ABI, Foster City, Calif.).
  • the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung diseases in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid molecules or any fragment(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT nucleic acid molecule(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 and a combination thereof; wherein a differential level of said LCAT nucleic acid molecule(s) relative to the level of said nucleic acid molecule(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung diseases.
  • the detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 2, 4, 8, 10, 20 or more nucleic acid molecules, preferably, the nucleic acid molecules comprise or consists of a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 and combination thereof.
  • sequences in the genome of a subject are detected.
  • sequences include LCAT sequences associated with abnormal expression of LCAT (e.g., overexpression or expression at a physiological inappropriate time).
  • sequences include polymorphisms, including polymorphisms in the transcribed sequence (e.g., that effect LCAT processing and/or translation) and regulatory sequences such as promoters, enhances, repressors, and the like.
  • sequences may also include polymorphisms in genes or control sequences associated with factors that affect expression such as transcription factors, and the like.
  • any suitable method for detecting and/or identifying these sequences is within the scope of the present invention including, but not limited to, nucleic acid sequencing, hybridization assays (e.g., Southern blotting), single nucleotide polymorphism assays (See e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,069, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety), and the like.
  • the present invention provides methods for diagnosing or detecting the differential presence of LCAT protein.
  • LCAT proteins are detected directly.
  • LCAT to the disease antigens are detected non-existence.
  • the diagnostic methods of the present invention find utility in the diagnosis and characterization of diseases.
  • the presence of an antibody to a specific protein may be indicative of a cancer or disease.
  • certain LCAT may be indicative of a specific stage or sub-type of the same cancer or disease.
  • the information obtained is also used to determine prognosis and appropriate course of treatment. For example, it is contemplated that individuals with a specific LCAT expression or stage of lung diseases may respond differently to a given treatment that individuals lacking the LCAT expression.
  • the information obtained from the diagnostic methods of the present invention thus provides for the personalization of diagnosis and treatment.
  • the present invention provides a method for monitoring lung diseases treatment in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptide(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and a combination thereof; wherein an level of said LCAT protein(s) similar to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of successful treatment.
  • the present invention provides a method for diagnosing recurrence of lung diseases following successful treatment in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptide(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 or a combination thereof; wherein a changed level of said LCAT protein(s) relative to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of recurrence of lung diseases.
  • the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung diseases in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptides thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and a combination thereof; wherein a differential level of said LCAT protein(s) relative to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung diseases.
  • the detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 2, 4, 8, 10, 20 or more proteins, preferably, the proteins are selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS: 1-1154 and combination thereof.
  • the detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 5, 10, 15, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 or more LCAT peptides, preferably the peptides are selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and combination thereof.
  • the present invention provides a detection or diagnostic method of LCATs by using LC/MS.
  • the proteins from cells are prepared by methods known in the art (R. Aebersold Nature Biotechnology Volume 21 Number 6 Jun. 2003).
  • the differential expression of proteins in disease and healthy samples are quantitated using Mass Spectrometry and ICAT (Isotope Coded Affinity Tag) labeling, which is known in the art.
  • ICAT is an isotope label technique that allows for discrimination between two populations of proteins, such as a healthy and a disease sample.
  • the LC/MS spectra are collected for the labeled samples.
  • the raw scans from the LC/MS instrument are subjected to peak detection and noise reduction software. Filtered peak lists are then used to detect ‘features’ corresponding to specific peptides from the original sample(s).
  • Features are characterized by their mass/charge, charge, retention time, isotope pattern and intensity.
  • the intensity of a peptide present in both healthy and disease samples can be used to calculate the differential expression, or relative abundance, of the peptide.
  • the intensity of a peptide found exclusively in one sample can be used to calculate a theoretical expression ratio for that peptide (singleton). Expression ratios are calculated for each peptide of each replicate of the experiment (Table 1). Thus overexpression or under expression of LCAT protein or peptide are similar to the expression pattern in Table 1 in a test subject indicates the likelihood of having lung diseases or diseases associated with lung.
  • Immunological methods for detecting and measuring complex formation as a measure of protein expression using either specific polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies are known in the art. Examples of such techniques include enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), radioimmunoassays (RIAs), fluorescence-activated cell sorting (FACS) and antibody arrays. Such immunoassays typically involve the measurement of complex formation between the protein and its specific antibody. These assays and their quantitation against purified, labeled standards are well known in the art (Ausubel, supra, unit 10.1-10.6).
  • a two-site, monoclonal-based immunoassay utilizing antibodies reactive to two non-interfering epitopes is preferred, but a competitive binding assay may be employed (Pound (1998) Immunochemical Protocols, Humana Press, Totowa N.J.). More immunological detections are described in section below.
  • Antibodies are useful to detect the presence of one of the proteins or fragments thereof, peptides of the present invention in cells or tissues to determine the pattern of expression of the protein among various tissues in an organism and over the course of normal development.
  • the antibodies can be used to assess expression in disease states such as in active stages of the disease or in an individual with a predisposition toward disease related to the protein's function.
  • the antibodies can also be used to assess normal and aberrant subcellular localization of cells in the various tissues in an organism.
  • Detection on a protein by an antibody can be facilitated by coupling (i.e., physically linking) the antibody to a detectable substance.
  • detectable substances include various enzymes, prosthetic groups, fluorescent materials, luminescent materials, bioluminescent materials, and radioactive materials (see below).
  • the antibodies may also be useful in diagnostic assays, e.g., for detecting expression of an antigen, for example LCAT protein, peptide or fragment thereof, in specific cells, tissues, blood, serum or body fluids.
  • the antibody or its variant typically will be labeled with a detectable moiety.
  • a detectable moiety Numerous labels are available which can be generally grouped into the following categories:
  • Radioisotopes such as 36 S, 14 C, 125 H, and 131 I.
  • the antibody variant can be labeled with the radioisotope using the techniques described in Current Protocols in Immunology, vol 1-2, Coligen et al., Ed., Wiley-Interscience, New York, Pubs. (1991) for example and radioactivity can be measured using scintillation counting.
  • Fluorescent labels such as rare earth chelates (europium chelates) or fluorescein and its derivatives, rhodamine and its derivatives, dansyl, Lissamine, phycoerythrin and Texas Red are available.
  • the fluorescent labels can be conjugated to the antibody variant using the techniques disclosed in Current Protocols in Immunology, supra, for example. Fluorescence can be quantified using a fluorimeter.
  • the enzyme generally catalyzes a chemical alteration of the chromogenic substrate which can be measured using various techniques. For example, the enzyme may catalyze a color change in a substrate, which can be measured spectrophotometrically. Alternatively, the enzyme may alter the fluorescence or chemiluminescence of the substrate. Techniques for quantifying a change in fluorescence are described above.
  • the chemiluminescent substrate becomes electronically excited by a chemical reaction and may then emit light which can be measured (using a chemiluminometer, for example) or donates energy to a fluorescent acceptor.
  • enzymatic labels include luciferases (e.g., firefly luciferase and bacterial luciferase; U.S. Pat. No. 4,737,456), luciferin, 2,3-dihydrophthalazinediones, malate dehydrogenase, urease, peroxidase such as horseradish peroxidase (HRPO), alkaline phosphatase, .beta.-galactosidase, glucoamylase, lysozyme, saccharide oxidases (e.g., glucose oxidase, galactose oxidase, and glucose-6-phosphate dehydrogenase), heterocyclic oxidases (such as uricase and xanthine oxidase), lactoperoxidase, microperoxidase, and the like.
  • luciferases e.g., firefly luciferase and bacterial
  • the label is indirectly conjugated with the antibody.
  • the antibody can be conjugated with biotin and any of the three broad categories of labels mentioned above can be conjugated with avidin, or vice versa. Biotin binds selectively to avidin and thus, the label can be conjugated with the antibody in this indirect manner.
  • the antibody is conjugated with a small hapten (e.g. digloxin) and one of the different types of labels mentioned above is conjugated with an anti-hapten antibody (e.g. anti-digloxin antibody).
  • a small hapten e.g. digloxin
  • an anti-hapten antibody e.g. anti-digloxin antibody
  • the antibody need not be labeled, and the presence thereof can be detected using a labeled antibody, which binds to the antibody.
  • the antibodies of the present invention may be employed in any known assay method, such as competitive binding assays, direct and indirect sandwich assays, and immunoprecipitation assays. Zola, Monoclonal Antibodies: A Manual of Techniques, pp. 147-158 (CRC Press, Inc. 1987).
  • the biological samples can then be tested directly for the presence of LCAT by assays (e.g., ELISA or radioimmunoassay) and format (e.g., microwells, dipstick (e.g., as described in International Patent Publication WO 93/03367), etc).
  • assays e.g., ELISA or radioimmunoassay
  • format e.g., microwells, dipstick (e.g., as described in International Patent Publication WO 93/03367), etc.
  • proteins in the sample can be size separated (e.g., by polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis (PAGE)), in the presence or absence of sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS), and the presence of LCAT detected by immunoblotting (e.g., Western blotting).
  • Immunoblotting techniques are generally more effective with antibodies generated against a peptide corresponding to an epitope of a protein, and hence, are particularly suited to the present invention
  • Antibody binding is detected by techniques known in the art (e.g., radioimmunoassay, ELISA (enzyme-linked immunosorbant assay), “sandwich” immunoassays, immunoradiometric assays, gel diffusion precipitation reactions, immunodiffusion assays, in situ immunoassays (e.g., using colloidal gold, enzyme or radioisotope labels, for example), Western blots, precipitation reactions, agglutination assays (e.g., gel agglutination assays, hemagglutination assays, etc.), complement fixation assays, immunofluorescence assays, protein A assays, and immunoelectrophoresis assays, etc.
  • radioimmunoassay e.g., ELISA (enzyme-linked immunosorbant assay), “sandwich” immunoassays, immunoradiometric assays, gel diffusion precipitation reactions, immunodiffusion assays,
  • antibody binding is detected by detecting a label on the primary antibody.
  • the primary antibody is detected by detecting binding of a secondary antibody or reagent to the primary antibody.
  • the secondary antibody is labeled.
  • the immunogenic peptide should be provided free of the carrier molecule used in any immunization protocol. For example, if the peptide was conjugated to KLH, it may be conjugated to BSA, or used directly, in a screening assay. In some embodiments, an automated detection assay is utilized.
  • Sandwich assays involve the use of two antibodies, each capable of binding to a different immunogenic portion, or epitope, or the protein to be detected.
  • the test sample to be analyzed is bound by a first antibody, which is immobilized on a solid support, and thereafter a second antibody binds to the test sample, thus forming an insoluble three-part complex.
  • the second antibody may itself be labeled with a detectable moiety (direct sandwich assays) or may be measured using an anti-immunoglobulin antibody that is labeled with a detectable moiety (indirect sandwich assay).
  • sandwich assay is an ELISA assay, in which case the detectable moiety is an enzyme.
  • the antibodies may also be used for in vivo diagnostic assays.
  • the antibody is labeled with a radionucleotide (such as . 111 In 99 Tc, 14 C, 131 I, 3 H, 32 P or 35 S) so that the tumor can be localized using immunoscintiography.
  • a radionucleotide such as . 111 In 99 Tc, 14 C, 131 I, 3 H, 32 P or 35 S
  • antibodies or fragments thereof bind to the extracellular domains of two or more LCAT targets and the affinity value(Kd) is less than 1 ⁇ 10 8 M.
  • Antibodies for diagnostic use may be labeled with probes suitable for detection by various imaging methods.
  • Methods for detection of probes include, but are not limited to, fluorescence, light, confocal and electron microscopy; magnetic resonance imaging and spectroscopy; fluoroscopy, computed tomography and positron emission tomography.
  • Suitable probes include, but are not limited to, fluorescein, rhodamine, eosin and other fluorophores, radioisotopes, gold, gadolinium and other lanthanides, paramagnetic iron, fluorine-18 and other positron-emitting radionuclides. Additionally, probes may be bi- or multi-functional and be detectable by more than one of the methods listed.
  • Attachment of probes to the antibodies includes covalent attachment of the probe, incorporation of the probe into the antibody, and the covalent attachment of a chelating compound for binding of probe, amongst others well recognized in the art.
  • the disease tissue sample may be fresh or frozen or may be embedded in paraffin and fixed with a preservative such as formalin (see Example).
  • the fixed or embedded section contains the sample are contacted with a labeled primary antibody and secondary antibody, wherein the antibody is used to detect the LCAT protein express in situ.
  • the detailed procedure is shown in the Example.
  • array technologies and quantitative PCR provide the means to explore the expression profiles of a large number of related or unrelated genes, and proteins.
  • arrays provide a platform for examining which genes or proteins are tissue-specific, carrying out housekeeping functions, parts of a signaling cascade, or specifically related to a particular genetic predisposition, condition, disease, or disorder.
  • the potential application of gene or protein expression profiling is particularly relevant to improving diagnosis, prognosis, and treatment of disease. For example, both the sequences and the amount of expression can be compared between tissues from subjects with different types of lung diseases and cytologically normal healthy tissue.
  • Array refers to an ordered arrangement of at least two transcripts, proteins or peptides, or antibodies on a substrate. At least one of the transcripts, proteins, or antibodies represents a control or standard, and the other transcript, protein, or antibody is of diagnostic or therapeutic interest. The arrangement of at least two and up to about 40,000 transcripts, proteins, or antibodies on the substrate assures that the size and signal intensity of each labeled complex, formed between each transcript and at least one nucleic acid, each protein and at least one ligand or antibody, or each antibody and at least one protein to which the antibody specifically binds, is individually distinguishable.
  • An “expression profile” is a representation of gene expression in a sample.
  • a nucleic acid expression profile is produced using sequencing, hybridization, or amplification technologies using transcripts from a sample.
  • a protein expression profile although time delayed, minors the nucleic acid expression profile and is produced using gel electrophoresis, mass spectrometry, or an array and labeling moieties or antibodies which specifically bind the protein.
  • the nucleic acids, proteins, or antibodies specifically binding the protein may be used in solution or attached to a substrate, and their detection is based on methods well known in the art.
  • a substrate includes but not limited to, paper, nylon or other type of membrane, filter, chip, glass slide, or any other suitable solid support.
  • the invention also provides an array with a cDNA or transcript encoding LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof, antibodies which specifically bind LCAT proteins, peptides or fragments thereof.
  • a cDNA or transcript encoding LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof, antibodies which specifically bind LCAT proteins, peptides or fragments thereof.
  • two or more of the nucleic acid molecules e.g., SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120
  • proteins e.g., SEQ ID NOS:1-1154
  • peptides e.g., SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525
  • the present invention also provides an antibody array.
  • Antibody arrays have allowed the development of techniques for high-throughput screening of recombinant antibodies. Such methods use robots to pick and grid bacteria containing antibody genes, and a filter-based ELISA to screen and identify clones that express antibody fragments. Because liquid handling is eliminated and the clones are arrayed from master stocks, the same antibodies can be spotted multiple times and screened against multiple antigens simultaneously. For more information, see de Wildt et al. (2000) Nat Biotechnol 18:989-94.
  • the array is prepared and used according to the methods described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,837,832, Chee et al., PCT application WO95/11995 (Chee et al.), Lockhart, D. J. et al. (1996; Nat. Biotech. 14: 1675-1680) and Schena, M. et al. (1996; Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 93: 10614-10619), U.S. Pat. No. 5,807,522, Brown et al., all of which are incorporated herein in their entirety by reference.
  • a nucleic acid array or a microarray preferably composed of a large number of unique, single-stranded nucleic acid sequences, usually either synthetic antisense oligonucleotides or fragments of cDNAs, fixed to a solid support.
  • the oligonucleotides are preferably about 6-60 nucleotides in length, more preferably 15-30 nucleotides in length, and most preferably about 20-25 nucleotides in length.
  • the gene(s) of interest (or an ORF identified from the contigs of the present invention) is typically examined using a computer algorithm which starts at the 5′ or at the 3′ end of the nucleotide sequence.
  • Typical algorithms will then identify oligomers of defined length that are unique to the gene, have a GC content within a range suitable for hybridization, and lack predicted secondary structure that may interfere with hybridization. In certain situations it may be appropriate to use pairs of oligonucleotides on an array.
  • the “pairs” will be identical, except for one nucleotide that preferably is located in the center of the sequence.
  • the second oligonucleotide in the pair serves as a control.
  • the number of oligonucleotide pairs may range from two to one million.
  • the oligomers are synthesized at designated areas on a substrate using a light-directed chemical process, wherein the substrate may be paper, nylon or other type of membrane, filter, chip, glass slide or any other suitable solid support as described above.
  • an oligonucleotide may be synthesized on the surface of the substrate by using a chemical coupling procedure and an ink jet application apparatus, as described in PCT application WO95/251116 (Baldeschweiler et al.) which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference.
  • a gene expression profile comprises the expression of a plurality of transcripts as measured by after hybridization with a sample.
  • the transcripts of the invention may be used as elements on an array to produce a gene expression profile.
  • the array is used to diagnose or monitor the progression of disease. researchers can assess and catalog the differences in gene expression between healthy and diseased tissues or cells.
  • the transcript or probe may be labeled by standard methods and added to a biological sample from a patient under conditions for the formation of hybridization complexes. After an incubation period, the sample is washed and the amount of label (or signal) associated with hybridization complexes, is quantified and compared with a standard value. If complex formation in the patient sample is significantly altered (higher or lower) in comparison to either a normal or disease standard, then differential expression indicates the presence of a disorder.
  • normal and disease expression profiles are established. This is accomplished by combining a sample taken from normal subjects, either animal or human or nonmammal, with a transcript under conditions for hybridization to occur. Standard hybridization complexes may be quantified by comparing the values obtained using normal subjects with values from an experiment in which a known amount of a purified sequence is used. Standard values obtained in this manner may be compared with values obtained from samples from patients who were diagnosed with a particular condition, disease, or disorder. Deviation from standard values toward those associated with a particular disorder is used to diagnose that disorder.
  • the invention can be used to formulate a prognosis and to design a treatment regimen.
  • the invention can also be used to monitor the efficacy of treatment.
  • the array is employed to improve the treatment regimen. A dosage is established that causes a change in genetic expression patterns indicative of successful treatment. Expression patterns associated with the onset of undesirable side effects are avoided.
  • animal models which mimic a human disease can be used to characterize expression profiles associated with a particular condition, disease, or disorder; or treatment of the condition, disease, or disorder. Novel treatment regimens may be tested in these animal models using arrays to establish and then follow expression profiles over time.
  • arrays may be used with cell cultures or tissues removed from animal models to rapidly screen large numbers of candidate drug molecules, looking for ones that produce an expression profile similar to those of known therapeutic drugs, with the expectation that molecules with the same expression profile will likely have similar therapeutic effects.
  • the invention provides the means to rapidly determine the molecular mode of action of a drug.
  • Such assays may also be used to evaluate the efficacy of a particular therapeutic treatment regimen in animal studies or in clinical trials or to monitor the treatment of an individual patient. Once the presence of a condition is established and a treatment protocol is initiated, diagnostic assays may be repeated on a regular basis to determine if the level of expression in the patient begins to approximate that which is observed in a normal subject. The results obtained from successive assays may be used to show the efficacy of treatment over a period ranging from several days to years.
  • Treat,” “treating” or “treatment” of a disease includes: (1) inhibiting the disease, i.e., arresting or reducing the development of the disease or its clinical symptoms, or (2) relieving the disease, i.e., causing regression of the disease or its clinical symptoms.
  • a “therapeutically effective amount” means the amount of an agent that, when administered to a subject for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect such treatment for the disease.
  • the “therapeutically effective amount” will vary depending on the agent, the disease and its severity and the age, weight, etc., of the subject to be treated.
  • a “lung disease” includes lung cancer, lung tumor (exocrine or endocrine), lung cysts as well as lung trauma; preferably lung cancer.
  • a “cancer” is epithelial-cell related cancers.
  • the present invention provides an application of treatment by using antibody, immunogenic peptides as well as other LCAT agonists or antagonists.
  • LCATs are proteins differentially expressed in the lung diseases cell lines or tissues.
  • the proteins are either cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, or secreted proteins (see the list in Table 2). These proteins are associated with the diseases especially lung diseases, particularly lung cancer; thus, they serve as candidate targets for the treatment of the diseases.
  • an inhibitor, antagonist, antibody and the like or a pharmaceutical agent containing one or more of these molecules may be delivered. Such delivery may be effected by methods well known in the art and may include delivery by an antibody specifically targeted to the protein. Neutralizing antibodies, which inhibit dimer formation, are generally preferred for therapeutic use.
  • the protein, an agonist, an enhancer and the like or a pharmaceutical agent containing one or more of these molecules may be delivered.
  • Such delivery may be effected by methods well known in the art and may include delivery of a pharmaceutical agent by an antibody specifically targeted to the protein.
  • transcripts, complementary molecules, or fragments thereof, proteins or portions thereof, vectors delivering these nucleic acid molecules or expressing the proteins, and their ligands may be administered in combination with other therapeutic agents.
  • Selection of the agents for use in combination therapy may be made by one of ordinary skill in the art according to conventional pharmaceutical principles.
  • a combination of therapeutic agents may act synergistically to affect treatment of a particular disorder at a lower dosage of each agent.
  • the antibody of the present invention can be used for therapeutic reason. It is contemplated that the antibody of the present invention may be used to treat a mammal, preferably human with lung diseases.
  • the antibodies are also useful for inhibiting protein function, for example, blocking the binding of the LCAT protein or peptide to a binding partner such as a substrate. These uses can also be applied in a therapeutic context in which treatment involves inhibiting the protein's function.
  • An antibody can be used, for example, to block binding, thus modulating (agonizing or antagonizing) the peptides activity.
  • Antibodies can be prepared against specific fragments containing sites required for function or against intact protein that is associated within a cell or cell membrane. The function blocking assays are provided in detail in the Examples.
  • the antibodies of present invention can also be used as means of enhancing the immune response.
  • the antibodies can be administered in amounts similar to those used for other therapeutic administrations of antibody.
  • pooled gamma globulin is administered at a range of about 1 mg to about 100 mg per patient.
  • antibodies reactive with the protein or peptides of LCAT can be passively administered alone or in conjunction with other anti-cancer therapies to a mammal afflicted-with lung diseases or cancer.
  • anti-cancer therapies include, but are not limited to, chemotherapy, radiation therapy, adoptive immunotherapy therapy with TIL (Tumor Infiltration Lymphocytes).
  • an antibody subclass for therapy will depend upon the nature of the disease tumor antigen. For example, an IgM may be preferred in situations where the antigen is highly specific for the diseased target and rarely occurs on normal cells. However, where the disease-associated antigen is also expressed in normal tissues, although at much lower levels, the IgG subclass may be preferred for the following reason: since the binding of at least two IgG molecules in close proximity is required to activate complement, less complement mediated damage may occur in the normal tissues which express smaller amounts of the antigen and, therefore, bind fewer IgG antibody molecules. Furthermore, IgG molecules by being smaller may be more able than IgM molecules to localize to the diseased tissue.
  • the mechanism for antibody therapy is that the therapeutic antibody recognizes a cell surface protein, cytosolic protein, or a secreted protein that is overexpressed in diseased cells.
  • NK cell or complement activation conjugation of the antibody with an immunotoxin or radiolabel, the interaction can abrogate ligand/receptor interaction or activation of apoptosis.
  • antibody-mediated cytotoxicity of diseased cells are phagocyte (antibody dependent cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC)) (see Example), complement (Complement-mediated cytotoxicity (CMC)) (see Example), naked antibody (receptor cross-linking apoptosis and growth factor inhibition), or targeted payload labeled with radionuclide or immunotoxins or immunochemotherapeutics.
  • ADCC antibody dependent cellular cytotoxicity
  • CMC complement-mediated cytotoxicity
  • naked antibody receptor cross-linking apoptosis and growth factor inhibition
  • targeted payload labeled with radionuclide or immunotoxins or immunochemotherapeutics are targeted payload labeled with radionuclide or immunotoxins or immunochemotherapeutics.
  • the antibody is administered to a nonhuman mammal for the purposes of obtaining preclinical data, for example.
  • exemplary nonhuman mammals to be treated include nonhuman primates, dogs, cats, rodents and other mammals in which preclinical studies are performed. Such mammals may be established animal models for a disease to be treated with the antibody or may be used to study toxicity of the antibody of interest. In each of these embodiments, dose escalation studies may be performed on the mammal.
  • the antibody is administered by any suitable means, including parenteral, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intrapulmonary, and intranasal, and, if desired for local immunosuppressive treatment, intralesional administration.
  • Parenteral infusions include intramuscular, intravenous, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, or subcutaneous administration.
  • the antibody variant is suitably administered by pulse infusion, particularly with declining doses of the antibody variant.
  • the dosing is given by injections, most preferably intravenous or subcutaneous injections, depending in part on whether the administration is brief or chronic.
  • the appropriate dosage of the antibody will depend on the type of disease to be treated, the severity and the course of the disease, whether the antibody is administered for preventive or therapeutic purposes, previous therapy, the patient's clinical history and response to the antibody, and the discretion of the attending physician.
  • .mu.g/kg to 150 mg/kg (e.g., 0.1-20 mg/kg) of antibody is an initial candidate dosage for administration to the patient, whether, for example, by one or more separate administrations, or by continuous infusion.
  • a typical daily dosage might range from about 1 .mu.g/kg to 100 mg/kg or more, depending on the factors mentioned above.
  • the treatment is sustained until a desired suppression of disease symptoms occurs.
  • other dosage regimens may be useful. The progress of this therapy is easily monitored by conventional techniques and assays.
  • the antibody composition will be formulated, dosed and administered in a manner consistent with good medical practice.
  • Factors for consideration in this context include the particular disorder being treated, the particular mammal being treated, the clinical condition of the individual patient, the cause of the disorder, the site of delivery of the agent, the method of administration, the scheduling of administration, and other factors known to medical practitioners.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the antibody to be administered will be governed by such considerations, and is the minimum amount necessary to prevent, ameliorate, or treat a disease or disorder.
  • the antibody need not be, but is optionally formulated with one or more agents currently used to prevent or treat the disorder in question.
  • Antibodies of the present invention may also be used as therapeutic reagents, to diminish or eliminate cancer or tumors.
  • the antibodies may be used on their own (for instance, to inhibit metastases) or coupled to one or more therapeutic agents.
  • Suitable agents in this regard include radionuclides, differentiation inducers, drugs, toxins, and derivatives thereof.
  • Preferred radionuclides include 90 Y, 123 I, 125 I, 131 I, 186 Re, 188 Re, 212 Bi.
  • Preferred drugs include methotrexate, and pyrimidine and purine analogs.
  • Preferred differentiation inducers include phorbol esters and butyric acid.
  • Preferred toxins include ricin, abrin, diptheria toxin, cholera toxin, gelonin, Pseudomonas exotoxin, Shigella toxin, and pokeweed antiviral protein
  • a therapeutic agent may be coupled (e.g., covalently bonded) to a suitable monoclonal antibody either directly or indirectly (e.g., via a linker group).
  • a direct reaction between an agent and an antibody is possible when each possesses a substituent capable of reacting with the other.
  • a nucleophilic group such as an amino or sulfhydryl group
  • on one may be capable of reacting with a carbonyl-containing group, such as an anhydride or an acid halide, or with an alkyl group containing a good leaving group (e.g., a halide) on the other.
  • a linker group can function as a spacer to distance an antibody from an agent in order to avoid interference with binding capabilities.
  • a linker group can also serve to increase the chemical reactivity of a substituent on an agent or an antibody, and thus increase the coupling efficiency. An increase in chemical reactivity may also facilitate the use of agents, or functional groups on agents, which otherwise would not be possible.
  • a linker group which is cleavable during or upon internalization into a cell.
  • a number of different cleavable linker groups have been described.
  • the mechanisms for the intracellular release of an agent from these linker groups include cleavage by reduction of a disulfide bond (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,489,710, to Spitler), by irradiation of a photolabile bond (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,625,014, to Senter et al.), by hydrolysis of derivatized amino acid side chains (e.g., U.S. Pat.
  • immunoconjugates with more than one agent may be prepared in a variety of ways as described above.
  • the immunogen While it is possible for the immunogen to be administered in a pure or substantially pure form, it is preferable to present it as a pharmaceutical composition, formulation or preparation with a carrier.
  • formulations of the present invention both for veterinary and for human use, comprise an immunogen as described above, together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and, optionally, other therapeutic ingredients.
  • the carrier(s) must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not deleterious to the recipient thereof.
  • the formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any method well-known in the pharmaceutical art.
  • Suitable pharmaceutical carriers include proteins such as albumins (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,507,234, to Kato et al.), peptides and polysaccharides such as aminodextran (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,699,784, to Shih et al.), or water.
  • a carrier may also bear an agent by noncovalent bonding or by encapsulation, such as within a liposome vesicle (e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,429,008 and 4,873,088).
  • Carriers specific for radionuclide agents include radiohalogenated small molecules and chelating compounds. For example, U.S. Pat. No.
  • a radionuclide chelate may be formed from chelating compounds that include those containing nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the donor atoms for binding the metal, metal oxide, radionuclide.
  • U.S. Pat. No. 4,673,562 to Davison et al. discloses representative chelating compounds and their synthesis.
  • All methods include the step of bringing into association the active ingredient with the carrier, which constitutes one or more accessory ingredients.
  • the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product into the desired formulation.
  • Formulations suitable for intravenous intramuscular, subcutaneous, or intraperitoneal administration conveniently comprise sterile aqueous solutions of the active ingredient with solutions, which are preferably isotonic with the blood of the recipient.
  • Such formulations may be conveniently prepared by dissolving solid active ingredient in water containing physiologically compatible substances such as sodium chloride (e.g. 0.1-2.0M), glycine, and the like, and having a buffered pH compatible with physiological conditions to produce an aqueous solution, and rendering said solution sterile.
  • physiologically compatible substances such as sodium chloride (e.g. 0.1-2.0M), glycine, and the like
  • physiologically compatible substances such as sodium chloride (e.g. 0.1-2.0M), glycine, and the like
  • pH compatible substances such as sodium chloride (e.g. 0.1-2.0M), glycine, and the like
  • These may be present in unit or multi-dose containers, for example, sealed ampoules or vials.
  • the formulations of the present invention may incorporate a stabilizer.
  • Illustrative stabilizers are polyethylene glycol, proteins, saccharides, amino acids, inorganic acids, and organic acids, which may be used either on their own or as admixtures. These stabilizers are preferably incorporated in an amount of 0.11-10,000 parts by weight per part by weight of immunogen. If two or more stabilizers are to be used, their total amount is preferably within the range specified above. These stabilizers are used in aqueous solutions at the appropriate concentration and pH. The specific osmotic pressure of such aqueous solutions is generally in the range of 0.1-3.0 osmoles, preferably in the range of 0.8-1.2. The pH of the aqueous solution is adjusted to be within the range of 5.0-9.0, preferably within the range of 6-8. In formulating the antibody of the present invention, anti-adsorption agent may be used.
  • Controlled release preparations may be achieved through the use of polymer to complex or absorb the proteins or their derivatives.
  • the controlled delivery may be exercised by selecting appropriate macromolecules (for example polyester, polyamino acids, polyvinyl, pyrrolidone, ethylenevinylacetate, methylcellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, or protamine sulfate) and the concentration of macromolecules as well as the methods of incorporation in order to control release.
  • Another possible method to control the duration of action by controlled-release preparations is to incorporate the LCAT antibody into particles of a polymeric material such as polyesters, polyamino acids, hydrogels, poly(lactic acid) or ethylene vinylacetate copolymers.
  • microcapsules prepared, for example, by coacervation techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example, hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and poly(methylmethacylate) microcapsules, respectively, or in colloidal drug delivery systems, for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nanoparticles, and nanocapsules or in macroemulsions.
  • compositions may be combined with typical carriers, such as lactose, sucrose, starch, talc magnesium stearate, crystalline cellulose, methyl cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, glycerin, sodium alginate or gum arabic among others.
  • typical carriers such as lactose, sucrose, starch, talc magnesium stearate, crystalline cellulose, methyl cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, glycerin, sodium alginate or gum arabic among others.
  • the therapeutic antibody may be supplied in the form of a kit, alone, or in the form of a pharmaceutical composition as described above.
  • the LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof of this invention are also intended for use in producing antiserum designed for pre- or post-disease prophylaxis.
  • the protein, peptides or fragment thereof is formulated with a suitable adjuvant and administered by injection to human volunteers, according to known methods for producing human antisera.
  • Antibody response to the injected proteins is monitored, during a several-week period following immunization, by periodic serum sampling to detect the presence of antiserum antibodies, using an immunoassay as described herein.
  • the antiserum from immunized individuals may be administered as a prophylactic measure for individuals who are at risk of developing lung diseases or cancer.
  • the antiserum is also useful in treating an individual afflicted with lung diseases or cancer for post-disease prophylaxis.
  • peptides derived form the LCAT protein sequence may be modified to increase their immunogenicity by enhancing binding of the peptide to the MHC molecules in which the peptide is presented.
  • the peptide or modified peptide may be conjugated to a carrier molecule to enhance the antigenicity of the peptide.
  • carrier molecules include, but are not limited to, human albumin, bovine albumin, lipoprotein and keyhole limpet hemo-cyanin (“Basic and Clinical Immunology” (1991) Stites, D. P. and Terr A. I. (eds) Appleton and Lange, Norwalk Conn., San Mateo, Calif.).
  • immunogenic peptide is a peptide, which comprises an allele-specific motif such that the peptide will bind the MHC allele (HLA in human) and be capable of inducing a CTL (cytoxic T-lymphocytes) response.
  • immunogenic peptides are capable of binding to an appropriate class I or II MHC molecule and inducing a cytotoxic T cell or T helper cell response against the antigen from which the immunogenic peptide is derived.
  • amino acid sequence variants of the peptide can be prepared by mutations in the DNA, which encodes the peptide, or by peptide synthesis.
  • these variants ordinarily are prepared by site-directed mutagenesis of nucleotides in the DNA encoding the peptide molecule, thereby producing DNA encoding the variant, and thereafter expressing the DNA in recombinant cell culture.
  • the variants typically exhibit the same qualitative biological activity as the nonvariant peptide.
  • T-lymphocytes recognize antigen in association with Class I or Class II MHC molecules in the form of a peptide fragment bound to an MHC molecule.
  • the degree of peptide binding to a given MHC allele is based on amino acids at particular positions within the peptide (Parker et al. (1992) Journal of Immunology 149:3580; Kubo, et al. (1994) Journal of Immunology 52:3913-3924; Ruppert J. et al. (1993) Cell 74:929-937; Falk et al. (1991) Nature 351:290-296).
  • the peptides of the present invention are useful as an epitope for immunogenic response (see more detailed description below).
  • MHC is called HLA, wherein class I molecules are encoded by the HLA-A, B, and C loci. HLA-A and B antigens are expressed at the cell surface at approximately equal densities, whereas the expression of HLA-C is significantly lower (about 10-fold lower). Each of these loci has a number of alleles.
  • MHC class II molecules are encoded by three pairs of MHC II alpha- and beta-chain genes, called HLA DR, -DP, and -DQ in human. In many haplotypes the HLA-DR cluster contains an extra beta-chain gene whose product can pair with the DR alpha chain. Each MHC class I and II molecule binds a different rage of peptides.
  • the present of several loci means that any one individual is equipped to present a much broader ranger of different peptides than if only one MHC protein of each class were expressed at the cell surface.
  • the peptide binding motifs of the present invention are designed to be specific for each allelic subtype.
  • the peptides of the present invention are used for treatment of the lung diseases. Treatment involves administration of the protective composition after the appearance of the disease.
  • the present invention is also applied to prevent and suppress the disease. It is not always possible to distinguish between “preventing” and “suppressing” since the ultimate inductive event or events may be unknown, latent, or the patient is not ascertained until well after the occurrence of the event or events. Therefore, it is common to use the term “prophylaxis” as distinct from “treatment” to encompass both “preventing” and “suppressing” as defined herein.
  • the term “protection,” as used herein, is meant to include “prophylaxis.”
  • T cell-mediated pathology refers to any condition in which an inappropriate T cell response is a component of the pathology.
  • the term is intended to encompass both T cell mediated lung diseases and diseases resulting from unregulated clonal T cell replication.
  • the present invention relates to peptides or modified peptides derived from the protein sequences of the LCAT proteins that differentially expressed in the lung diseases.
  • modification may include substitution, deletion or addition of an amino acid in the given immunogenic peptide sequence or mutation of existing amino acids within the given immunogenic peptide sequence, or derivatization of existing amino acids within the given immunogenic peptide sequence.
  • Any amino acid comprising the immunogenic peptide sequence may be modified in accordance with this invention.
  • at least one amino acid is substituted or replaced within the given immunogenic peptide sequence. Any amino acid may be used to substitute or replace a given amino acid within the immunogenic peptide sequence.
  • Modified peptides are intended to include any immunogenic peptide obtained from differentially expressed proteins, which has been modified and exhibits enhanced binding to the MHC molecule with which it associates when presented to the T-cell. These modified peptides may be synthetically or recombinantly produced by conventional methods.
  • the peptides of the present invention comprise, or consisting sequences of about 5-8, 8-10, 10-15 or 15-30 amino acids which are immunogenic, that is, capable of inducing an immune response when injected into a subject.
  • the recombinant or natural protein, peptides, or fragment thereof of LCAT, or modified peptides may be used as a vaccine either prophylactically or therapeutically.
  • the vaccine is provided in advance of any evidence of lung diseases, particularly, cancer.
  • the prophylactic administration of the lung diseases vaccine should serve to prevent or attenuate lung diseases, preferably cancer, in a mammal.
  • Preparation of vaccine is using recombinant protein or peptide expression vectors comprising all or part of nucleic acid sequence of LCAT proteins encoding peptides.
  • vectors that may be used in the aforementioned vaccines include, but are not limited to, defective retroviral vectors, adenoviral vectors vaccinia viral vectors, fowl pox viral vectors, or other viral vectors (Mulligan, R. C., (1993) Science 260:926-932).
  • the viral vectors carrying all or part of nucleic sequence of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 can be introduced into a mammal either prior to any evidence of lung diseases or to mediate regression of the disease in a mammal afflicted with lung diseases.
  • Examples of methods for administering the viral vector into the mammals include, but are not limited to, exposure of cells to the virus ex vivo, or injection of the retrovirus or a producer cell line of the virus into the affected tissue or intravenous administration of the virus.
  • the viral vector carrying all or part of the LCAT nucleic acid sequence that encode peptides may be administered locally by direct injection into the cancer lesion or topical application in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the quantity of viral vector, carrying all or part of the LCAT nucleic acid sequence, to be administered is based on the titer of virus particles.
  • a preferred range of the immunogen to be administered may be about 106 to about 1011 virus particles per mammal, preferably a human.
  • the efficacy of the vaccine can be assessed by production of antibodies or immune cells that recognize the antigen, as assessed by specific lytic activity or specific cytokine production or by tumor regression.
  • the vaccine can be administered in conjunction with other therapeutic treatments. Examples of other therapeutic treatments includes, but are not limited to, adoptive T cell immunotherapy, coadministration of cytokines or other therapeutic drugs for cancer.
  • all or parts thereof of a substantially or partially purified the LCAT protein or their peptides may be administered as a vaccine in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • Ranges of the protein that may be administered are about 0.001 to about 100 mg per patient, preferred doses are about 0.01 to about 100 mg per patient.
  • the peptides or modified peptides thereof is administered therapeutically or prophylactically to a mammal in need of such treatment.
  • the peptide may be synthetically or recombinantly produced. Immunization is repeated as necessary, until a sufficient titer of anti-immunogen antibody or immune cells has been obtained.
  • a viral vector such as a retroviral vector
  • mammalian cells into which the retroviral vector can be introduced include, but are not limited to, primary mammalian cultures or continuous mammalian cultures, COS cells, NIH3T3, or 293 cells (ATTC #CRL 1573), dendritic cells.
  • the means by which the vector carrying the gene may be introduced into a cell includes, but is not limited to, microinjection, electroporation, transfection or transfection using DEAE dextran, lipofection, calcium phosphate or other procedures known to one skilled in the art (Sambrook et al. (EDS) (2001) in “Molecular Cloning. A laboratory manual”, Cold Spring Harbor Press Plainview, N.Y.).
  • the vaccine formulation of the present invention comprises an immunogen that induces an immune response directed against the cancer associated antigens such as the LCATs, and in nonhuman primates and finally in humans.
  • the safety of the immunization procedures is determined by looking for the effect of immunization on the general health of the immunized animal (weight change, fever, appetite behavior etc.) and looking for pathological changes on autopsies. After initial testing in animals, cancer patients can be tested. Conventional methods would be used to evaluate the immune response of the patient to determine the efficiency of the vaccine.
  • Measurement of candidate disease tumor antigen or vaccine expression in patients is the first step of the present invention. Subsequent steps will focus on measuring immune responses to these candidate antigens or vaccine. Sera from disease patients, particularly cancer patients, and healthy donors will be screened for antibodies to the candidate antigens as well as for levels of circulating tumor derived antigens. antigen.
  • the vaccine formulations may be evaluated first in animal models, initially rodents
  • mammals preferably human, at high risk for lung diseases, particularly cancer, are prophylactically treated with the vaccines of this invention.
  • examples of such mammals include, but are not limited to, humans with a family history of lung diseases, humans with a history of lung diseases, particular cancer, or humans afflicted with lung cancer previously resected and therefore at risk for reoccurrence.
  • the vaccine is provided to enhance the patient's own immune response to the diseased antigen present on the lung diseases or advanced stage of lung diseases.
  • the vaccine which acts as an immunogen, may be a cell, cell lysate from cells transfected with a recombinant expression vector, cell lysates from cells transfected with a recombinant expression vector, or a culture supernatant containing the expressed protein.
  • the immunogen is a partially or substantially purified recombinant protein, peptide or analog thereof or modified peptides or analogs thereof.
  • the proteins or peptides may be conjugated with lipoprotein or administered in liposomal form or with adjuvant.
  • the immunogen While it is possible for the immunogen to be administered in a pure or substantially pure form, it is preferable to present it as a pharmaceutical composition, formulation or preparation.
  • the formulations of the present invention are described in the previous section.
  • Vaccination can be conducted by conventional methods.
  • the immunogen can be used in a suitable diluent such as saline or water, or complete or incomplete adjuvants.
  • the immunogen may or may not be bound to a carrier to make the protein immunogenic.
  • carrier molecules include but are not limited to bovine serum albumin (BSA), keyhole limpet hemocyanin (KLH), tetanus toxoid, and the like.
  • BSA bovine serum albumin
  • KLH keyhole limpet hemocyanin
  • the immunogen also may be coupled with lipoproteins or administered in liposomal form or with adjuvants.
  • the immunogen can be administered by any route-appropriate for antibody production such as intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, subcutaneous, and the like.
  • the immunogen may be administered once or at periodic intervals until a significant titer of anti-LCAT immune cells or anti-LCAT antibody is produced.
  • the presence of anti-LCAT immune cells may be assessed by measuring the frequency of precursor CTL (cytoxic T-lymphocytes) against LCAT antigen prior to and after immunization by a CTL precursor analysis assay (Coulie, P. et al., (1992) International Journal Of Cancer 50:289-297).
  • the antibody may be detected in the serum using the immunoassay described above.
  • the safety of the immunization procedures is determined by looking for the effect of immunization on the general health of the immunized animal (weight change, fever, appetite behavior etc.) and looking for pathological changes on autopsies. After initial testing in animals, lung diseases patients can be tested. Conventional methods would be used to evaluate the immune response of the patient to determine the efficiency of the vaccine.
  • all, part, or parts of the LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof, or modified peptides may be exposed to dendritic cells cultured in vitro.
  • the cultured dendritic cells provide a means of producing T-cell dependent antigens comprised of dendritic cell modified antigen or dendritic cells pulsed with antigen, in which the antigen is processed and expressed on the antigen activated dendritic cell.
  • the LCAT antigen activated dendritic cells or processed dendritic cell antigens may be used as immunogens for vaccines or for the treatment of lung diseases, particularly lung cancer.
  • the dendritic cells should be exposed to antigen for sufficient time to allow the antigens to be internalized and presented on the dendritic cells surface.
  • the resulting dendritic cells or the dendritic cell process antigens can than be administered to an individual in need of therapy.
  • Such methods are described in Steinman et al. (WO93/208185) and in Banchereau et al. (EPO Application 0563485A1).
  • T-cells isolated from individuals can be exposed to the LCAT proteins, peptides or fragment thereof, or modified peptides in vitro and then administered to a patient in need of such treatment in a therapeutically effective amount.
  • T-lymphocytes include but are not limited to, peripheral blood cells lymphocytes (PBL), lymph nodes, or tumor infiltrating lymphocytes (TIL).
  • PBL peripheral blood cells lymphocytes
  • TIL tumor infiltrating lymphocytes
  • lymphocytes can be isolated from the individual to be treated or from a donor by methods known in the art and cultured in vitro (Kawakami, Y. et al. (1989) J. Immunol. 142: 2453-3461).
  • Lymphocytes are cultured in media such as RPMI or RPMI 1640 or AIM V for 1-10 weeks. Viability is assessed by trypan blue dye exclusion assay. Examples of how these sensitized T-cells can be administered to the mammal include but are not limited to, intravenously, intraperitoneally or intralesionally. Parameters that may be assessed to determine the efficacy of these sensitized T-lymphocytes include, but are not limited to, production of immune cells in the mammal being treated or tumor regression. Conventional methods are used to assess these parameters. Such treatment can be given in conjunction with cytokines or gene modified cells (Rosenberg, S. A. et al. (1992) Human Gene Therapy, 3: 75-90; Rosenberg, S. A. et al. (1992) Human Gene Therapy, 3: 57-73).
  • the model system employed here involves the use of Beas2B as a “normal” reference (i.e., control) to which cell surface expression in tumor derived cell lines is compared. These differentials or candidates are then validated in tissues, lung cancer and normal lung, to confirm that they are differentially expressed between these tissues as well as within the cell line model system.
  • Cell lines were grown in a culturing medium that is supplemented as necessary with growth factors and serum, in accordance with the American Type Culture Collection (ATCC) (Mannassas, Va.) guidelines for each particular cell line (the ATCC catalog number for each cell line is indicated in Table 1). Cultures were established from frozen stocks in which the cells were suspended in a freezing medium (cell culture medium with 10% DMSO [v/v]) and flash frozen in liquid nitrogen. Frozen stocks prepared in this way were stored in the liquid nitrogen vapour. Cell cultures were established by rapidly thawing frozen stocks at 37° C. Thawed stock cultures were slowly transferred to a culture vessel containing a large volume of culture medium that was supplemented.
  • ATCC American Type Culture Collection
  • cells were seeded at 1 ⁇ 10 5 cells/per ml in medium and incubated at 37° C. until confluence of cells in the culture vessel exceeds 50% by area. At this time, cells were harvested from the culture vessel using enzymes or EDTA where necessary. The density of harvested, viable cells was estimated by hemocytometry and the culture reseeded as above. A passage of this nature was repeated no more than 25 times at which point the culture was destroyed and reestablished from frozen stocks as described above.
  • Lung tumor and distal normal tissue is collected. Tissue specimens may be transported from surgery in Lung Transport Buffer (transportation time may be, e.g., about 12-16 hours).
  • Lung Transport Buffer is composed of LHC-9 media supplemented with 1 ⁇ penicillin-streptomycin-glutamine, 1 ⁇ fungizone (BioFluids) and Protease Inhibitor Cocktail (Sigma).
  • tissues are imaged, weighed, and dimensions measured (L ⁇ W ⁇ H). Tumor tissue is dissected when necessary for removal of necrotic regions. Tissue is re-weighed post-dissection.
  • Tissue is crudely minced and incubated for 20-30 minutes with periodic agitation at 37° C. in Enzyme Combination #1 (200 units Collagenase, cat# C5894 Sigma; 126 ug DNAse I, cat#D4513 Sigma (in 10 mM Tris/HCl pH7.5); 50 mM NaCl; 10 mM MgCl2; 0.05% Elastase, cat# E7885 Sigma).
  • D-PBS is added at 3 times the volume of the enzyme combination, the tissue finely minced, and disassociated cells passed through a 200 um filter. The cells are washed twice with D-PBS. Red blood cells are lysed with PharMLyse (BD Biosciences) when necessary. Cell number and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA). Cells at a total cell number greater than 20 ⁇ 10 6 are sorted using a high-speed sorter (MoFlo Cytomation) for epithelial cells (EpCAM positive).
  • the remaining undigested tissue is incubated for 20-30 minutes with periodic agitation at 37° C. in Enzyme Combination #2 (1 ⁇ Liberase Blendzyme 1 cat# 988-417 Roche, 1 ⁇ Liberase Blendzyme 3 cat#814-184 Roche, 0.05% Elastase cat# E7885 Sigma).
  • D-PBS is added at 3 times the volume of the enzyme combination, and the tissue finely minced until tissue is completely disassociated.
  • the cells are passed through a 200 um filter, washed twice with D-PBS, and pooled with cells from Enzyme Combination #1 digestion.
  • Cells are passed through a 70 um filter for single cell suspension and cell number and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA).
  • GUIVA PI exclusion
  • red blood cells are lysed with PharMLyse (BD Biosciences).
  • Cells are incubated in 20 ml of 1 ⁇ PharMLyse in D-PBS for 30 seconds with gentle agitation and cells pelleted at 300 ⁇ g for 5 minutes at 4° C.
  • Cells are washed once in D-PBS and cell number and viability are recalculated by PI exclusion using the GUAVA.
  • Cells at a total cell number greater than 20 ⁇ 10 6 are sorted using a high-speed sorter (MoFlo Cytomation) for epithelial cells (EpCAM positive).
  • Peptide sequences were searched by BlastP against the Celera Discovery System (CDS) and public database to identify the corresponding full-length open reading frames (ORFs). Each ORF sequence was then searched by BlastN against the Celera in-house human cDNA clone collection. For each sequence of interest, up to three clones are pulled and streaked onto LB/Ampicillin (100 ug/ml) plates. Plasmid DNA is isolated using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and verified by restriction digest. Subsequently, the isolated plasmid DNA is sequence verified against the ORF reference sequence. Sequencing reactions are carried out using Applied Biosystems BigDye Terminator kit followed by ethanol precipitation. Sequence data is collected using the Applied Biosystems 3100 Genetic Analyzer and analyzed by alignment to the reference sequence using the Clone Manager alignment tool.
  • PCR primers are designed to amplify the full-length ORF as well as any regions of the ORF that are interest for expression (antigenic or hydrophilic regions as determined by the Clone Manager sequence analysis tool). Primers also contain 5′ and 3′ overhangs to facilitate cloning (see below). PCR reactions contain 2.5 units Platinum Taq DNA Polymerase High Fidelity (Invitrogen), 50 ng cDNA plasmid template, 1 uM forward and reverse primers, 800 uM dNTP cocktail (Applied Biosystems) and 2 mM MgSO4. After 20-30 cycles (94° C. for 30 seconds, 55° C. for 1 minutes and 73° C. for 2 minutes), product is verified and quantitated by agarose gel electrophoresis.
  • PCR products are cloned into an entry vector for use with the Gateway recombination based cloning system (Invitrogen).
  • These vectors include pDonr221, pDonr201, pEntr/D-TOPO or pEntr/SD/D-TOPO and are used as described in the cloning methods below.
  • the forward PCR primer contained a 5′ overhang containing the sequence “CACC”.
  • PCR products are generated as described above and cloned into the entry vector using the Invitrogen TOPO cloning kit. Reactions are typically carried out at room temperature for 10 minutes and subsequently transformed into TOP10 chemically competent cells (Invitrogen, CA). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest. Inserts are subsequently sequence verified as described above.
  • PCR primers contained the following overhangs:
  • PCR products are generated as described above. ORFs are recombined into the entry vector using the Invitrogen Gateway BP Clonase enzyme mix. Reactions are typically carried out at 25° C. for 1 hour, treated with Proteinase K at 37° C. for 10 minutes and transformed into Library Efficiency DH5 ⁇ chemically competent cells (Invitrogen, CA). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest. Inserts are subsequently sequence verified as described above.
  • ORFs are transferred from the entry construct into a series of expression vectors using the Gateway LR Clonase enzyme mix. Reactions are typically carried out for 1 hour at 25° C., treated with Proteinase K at 37° C. for 10 minutes and subsequently transformed into Library Efficiency DH5a chemically competent cells (Invitrogen). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest.
  • Expression vectors include but are not limited to pDest14, pDest15, pDest17, pDest8, pDest10 and pDest20. These vectors allow expression in systems such as E. coli and recombinant baculovirus. Other vectors not listed here allow expression in yeast, mammalian cells, or in vitro.
  • Constructs are transformed into one or more of the following host strains: BL21 SI, BL21 AI, (Invitrogen); Origami B (DE3), Origami B (DE3) pLysS, Rosetta (DE3), Rosetta (DE3) pLysS, Rosetta-Gami (DE3), Rosetta-Gami (DE3) pLysS, or Rosetta-Gami B (DE3) pLysS (Novagen).
  • the transformants are grown in LB with or without NaCl and with appropriate antibiotics, at temperatures in the range of 20-37° C., with aeration.
  • IPTG 0.03-0.3 mM
  • NaCl 75-300 mM
  • Growth is continued for one to 24 hours post-induction.
  • Cells are harvested by centrifugation in a Sorvall RC-3C centrifuge in a H6000A rotor for 10 minutes at 3000 rpm, at 4° C. Cell pellets are stored at ⁇ 80° C.
  • Recombinant proteins are expressed using baculovirus in Sf21 fall army worm ovarian cells.
  • Recombinant baculoviruses are prepared using the Bac-to-Bac system (Invitrogen) per the manufacturer's instructions. Proteins are expressed on the large scale in Sf900II serum-free medium (Invitrogen) in a 10 L bioreactor tank (27° C., 130 rpm, 50% dissolved oxygen for 48 hours).
  • Recombinant proteins are purified from E. coli and/or insect cells using a variety of standard chromatography methods. Briefly, cells are lysed using sonication or detergents. The insoluble material is pelleted by centrifugation at 10,000 ⁇ g for 15 minutes. The supernatant is applied to an appropriate affinity column, e.g. His-tagged proteins are separated using a pre-packed chelating sepharose column (Pharmacia) or GST-tagged proteins are separated using a glutathione sepharose column (Pharmacia).
  • affinity column e.g. His-tagged proteins are separated using a pre-packed chelating sepharose column (Pharmacia) or GST-tagged proteins are separated using a glutathione sepharose column (Pharmacia).
  • proteins are further separated using various techniques, such as ion exchange chromatography (columns from Pharmacia) to separate on the basis of electrical charge or size exclusion chromatography (columns from Tosohaas) to separate on the basis of molecular weight, size and shape.
  • ion exchange chromatography columnumns from Pharmacia
  • size exclusion chromatography columnumns from Tosohaas
  • the pUB6/V5-His vector system (Invitrogen, CA) is used to express GSCC in CHO cells.
  • the vector contains the selectable bsd gene, multiple cloning sites, the promoter/enhancer sequence from the human ubiquitin C gene, a C-terminal V5 epitope for antibody detection with anti-V5 antibodies, and a C-terminal polyhistidine (6.times.His) sequence for rapid purification on PROBOND resin (Invitrogen, CA).
  • Transformed cells are selected on media containing blasticidin.
  • Spodoptera frugiperda (Sf9) insect cells are infected with recombinant Autographica californica nuclear polyhedrosis virus (baculovirus).
  • the polyhedrin gene is replaced with the cDNA by homologous recombination and the polyhedrin promoter drives cDNA transcription.
  • the protein is synthesized as a fusion protein with 6 ⁇ his which enables purification as described above. Purified protein is used in the following activity and to make antibodies
  • Proteins or portions thereof may be produced not only by recombinant methods, but also by using chemical methods well known in the art.
  • Solid phase peptide synthesis may be carried out in a batchwise or continuous flow process which sequentially adds .alpha.-amino- and side chain-protected amino acid residues to an insoluble polymeric support via a linker group.
  • a linker group such as methylamine-derivatized polyethylene glycol is attached to poly(styrene-co-divinylbenzene) to form the support resin.
  • the amino acid residues are N-a-protected by acid labile Boc (t-butyloxycarbonyl) or base-labile Fmoc (9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl).
  • the carboxyl group of the protected amino acid is coupled to the amine of the linker group to anchor the residue to the solid phase support resin.
  • Trifluoroacetic acid or piperidine are used to remove the protecting group in the case of Boc or Fmoc, respectively.
  • Each additional amino acid is added to the anchored residue using a coupling agent or pre-activated amino acid derivative, and the resin is washed.
  • the full length peptide is synthesized by sequential deprotection, coupling of derivitized amino acids, and washing with dichloromethane and/or N,N-dimethylformamide. The peptide is cleaved between the peptide carboxy terminus and the linker group to yield a peptide acid or amide.
  • a protein or portion thereof may be purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography and its composition confirmed by amino acid analysis or by sequencing (Creighton (1984) Proteins, Structures and Molecular Properties, W H Freeman, New York N.Y.).
  • Polyclonal antibodies against recombinant proteins are raised in rabbits (Green Mountain Antibodies, Burlington, Vt.). Briefly, two New Zealand rabbits are immunized with 0.1 mg of antigen in complete Freund's adjuvant. Subsequent immunizations are carried out using 0.05 mg of antigen in incomplete Freund's adjuvant at days 14, 21 and 49. Bleeds are collected and screened for recognition of the antigen by solid phase ELISA and western blot analysis. The IgG fraction is separated by centrifugation at 20,000 ⁇ g for 20 minutes followed by a 50% ammonium sulfate cut. The pelleted protein is resuspended in 5 mM Tris and separated by ion exchange chromatography. Fractions are pooled based on IgG content. Antigen-specific antibody is affinity purified using Pierce AminoLink resin coupled to the appropriate antigen.
  • Naturally occurring V-genes isolated from human PBLs are constructed into a library of antibody fragments which contain reactivities against LCAT to which the donor may or may not have been exposed (see e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,793 incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
  • a library of scFvs is constructed from the RNA of human PBLs as described in PCT publication WO 92/01047.
  • To rescue phage displaying antibody fragments approximately 109 E. coli harboring the phagemid are used to inoculate 50 ml of 2 ⁇ TY containing 1% glucose and 100 .mu.g/ml of ampicillin (2.times.TY-AMP-GLU) and grown to an O.D. of 0.8 with shaking.
  • M13 delta gene III is prepared as follows: M13 delta gene III helper phage does not encode gene III protein, hence the phage(mid) displaying antibody fragments have a greater avidity of binding to antigen. Infectious M13 delta gene III particles are made by growing the helper phage in cells harboring a pUC19 derivative supplying the wild type gene III protein during phage morphogenesis. The culture is incubated for 1 hour at 37° C. without shaking and then for a further hour at 37° C. with shaking. Cells are spun down (IEC-Centra 8,400 r.p.m.
  • Immunotubes (Nunc) are coated overnight in PBS with 4 ml of either 100 .mu.g/ml or 10 .mu.g/ml of a polypeptide of the present invention. Tubes are blocked with 2% Marvel-PBS for 2 hours at 37° C. and then washed 3 times in PBS. Approximately 1013 TU of phage is applied to the tube and incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature tumbling on an over and under turntable and then left to stand for another 1.5 hours. Tubes are washed 10 times with PBS 0.1% Tween-20 and 10 times with PBS.
  • Phage are eluted by adding 1 ml of 100 mM triethylamine and rotating 15 minutes on an under and over turntable after which the solution is immediately neutralized with 0.5 ml of 1.0M Tris-HCl, pH 7.4. Phages are then used to infect 10 ml of mid-log E. coli TG1 by incubating eluted phage with bacteria for 30 minutes at 37° C. The E. coli are then plated on TYE plates containing 1% glucose and 100 .mu.g/ml ampicillin. The resulting bacterial library is then rescued with delta gene 3 helper phage as described above to prepare phage for a subsequent round of selection. This process is then repeated for a total of 4 rounds of affinity purification with tube-washing increased to 20 times with PBS, 0.1% Tween-20 and 20 times with PBS for rounds 3 and 4.
  • Binders Eluted phage from the 3rd and 4th rounds of selection are used to infect E. coli HB 2151 and soluble scFv is produced (Marks, et al., 1991) from single colonies for assay.
  • ELISAs are performed with microtitre plates coated with either 10 .mu.g/ml of the polypeptide of the present invention in 50 mM bicarbonate pH 9.6. Clones positive in ELISA are further characterized by PCR fingerprinting (see, e.g., PCT publication WO 92/01047) and then by sequencing.
  • CMNS Complete Media No Sera
  • BD Hybridoma medium CM-HAT ⁇ Cell Mab
  • FBS or HS
  • Origen HCF hybridoma cloning factor
  • Hybridoma medium CM-HT (NO AMINOPTERIN) (Cell Mab (BD), 10% FBS 5% Origen HCF containing 4 mM L-glutamine and antibiotics) to be used for fusion maintenance are stored in the refrigerator at 4-6° C. The fusions are fed on days 4, 8, and 12, and subsequent passages. Inactivated and pre-filtered commercial Fetal Bovine serum (FBS) or Horse Serum (HS) are thawed and stored in the refrigerator at 4° C. and must be pretested for myeloma growth from single cells.
  • FBS Fetal Bovine serum
  • HS Horse Serum
  • L-glutamine 200 mM, 100 ⁇ solution
  • the L-glntamin is dispensed into media to supplement growth.
  • L-glntamin is added to 2 mM for myelomas, and 4 mM for hybridoma media.
  • Penicillin, Streptomycin, Amphotericin is thawed and added to Cell Mab Media to 1%.
  • Myeloma growth media is Cell Mab Media (Cell Mab Media, Quantum Yield from BD is stored in the refrigerator at 4° C. in the dark) which are added L-glutamine to 2 mM and antibiotic/antimycotic solution to 1% and is called CMNS.
  • 8-Azaguanine is stored as the dried powder supplied by SIGMA at ⁇ 700° C. until needed. Reconstitute 1 vial/500 ml of media and add entire contents to 500 ml media (eg. 2 vials/litre).
  • Myeloma Media is CM which has 10% FBS (or HS) and 8-Aza (1 ⁇ ) stored in the refrigerator at 4° C.
  • Clonal cell medium D (Stemcell, Vancouver) contains HAT and methyl cellulose for semi-solid direct cloning from the fusion. This comes in 90 ml bottles with a CoA and must be “melted at 37° C. in a waterbath in the morning of the day of the fusion. Loosen the cap and leave in CO2 incubator to sufficiently gas the medium D and bring the pH down.
  • Hybridoma supplements HT hyperxanthine, thymidine are to be used in medium for the section of hybridomas and maintenance of hybridomas through the cloning stages respectively.
  • Origen HCF can be obtained directly from Igen and is a cell supernatant produced from a macrophage-like cell-line. It can be thawed and aliquoted to 15 ml tubes at 5 ml per tube and stored frozen at ⁇ 20° C. Positive Hybridomas are fed HCF through the first subcloning and are gradually weaned. It is not necessary to continue to supplement unless you have a particularly difficult hybridoma clone. This and other additives have been shown to be more effective in promoting new hybridoma growth than conventional feeder layers.
  • mice are immunized with 5-50 ug of antigen either intra-peritoneally (i.p.) or by intravenous injection in the tail vein (i.v.).
  • the antigen used is a recombinant protein that is generated as described above.
  • the primary immunization takes place 2 months prior to the harvesting of splenocytes from the mouse and the immunization is typically boosted by i.v. injection of 5-50 ug of antigen every two weeks. At least one week prior to expected fusion date, a fresh vial of myeloma cells is thawed and cultured.
  • the optimum density is determined to be 3-6 ⁇ 10 5 cells/ml.
  • a final immunization is administered of ⁇ 5 ug of antigen in PBS i.p. or i.v.
  • Myeloma cells are washed with 30 ml serum free media by centrifugation at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes. Viable cell density is determined in resuspended cells using hemocytometry and vital stains. Cells resuspended in complete growth medium are stored at 37° C. during the preparation of splenocytes. Meanwhile, to test aminopterin sensitivity, 1 ⁇ 10 6 myeloma cells are transferred to a 15 ml conical tube and centrifuged at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes. The resulting pellet is resuspended in 15 ml of HAT media and cells plated at 2 drops/well on a 96 well plate.
  • splenocytes from immunized mice, the animals are euthanised and submerged in 70% ETOH. Under sterile conditions, the spleen is surgically removed and placed in 10 ml of RPMI medium supplemented with 20% fetal calf serum in a Petri dish. Cells are extricated from the spleen by infusing the organ with medium >50 times using a 21 g syringe.
  • Cells are harvested and washed by centrifugation (at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes) with 30 ml of medium. Cells are resuspended in 10 ml of medium and the density of viable cells determined by hemocytometry using vital stains. The splenocytes are mixed with myeloma cells at a ratio of 5:1 (spleen cells: myeloma cells). Both the myeloma and spleen cells are washed 2 more times with 30 ml of RPMI-CMNS. Spin at 800 rpm for 12 minutes.
  • RPMI-CMNS to the PEG cells and RPMI-CMNS are added to slowly dilute out the PEG.
  • Cells are centrifuged and diluted in 5 ml of Complete media and 95 ml of Clonacell Medium D (HAT) media (with 5 ml of HCF).
  • HAT Clonacell Medium D
  • the cells are plated out 10 ml per small petri plate.
  • Myeloma/HAT control. P is prepared as follows: dilute about 1000 P3X63 Ag8.653 myeloma cells into 1 ml of medium D and transfer into a single well of a 24 well plate. Plates are placed in incubator, with two plates inside of a large petri plate, with an additional petri plate full of distilled water, for 10-18 days under 5% CO2 overlay at 37° C. Clones are picked from semisolid agarose into 96 well plates containing 150-200 ul of CM-HT. Supernatants are screened 4 days later in ELISA, and positive clones are moved up to 24 well plates. Heavy growth will require changing of the media at day 8 (+/ ⁇ 150 ml). One should further decrease the HCF to 0.5% (gradually—2%, then 1%, then 0.5%) in the cloning plates.
  • mRNA is quantitated by RT-PCR using TaqMan® technology.
  • the Taqman system couples a 5′ fluorogenic nuclease assay with PCR for real time quantitation.
  • a probe is used to monitor the formation of the amplification product.
  • RNA Total RNA is isolated from cancer model cell lines using the RNEasy Kit® (Qiagen) per manufacturer's instructions and included DNase treatment. Normal human tissue RNAs are acquired from commercial vendors (Ambion, Austin, Tex.; Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif., BioChain Institute, Newington, N.H.) as were RNAs from matched disease/normal tissues.
  • Target transcript sequences are identified for the differentially expressed peptides by searching the BlastP database.
  • TaqMan assays PCR primer/probe set
  • CDS Celera Discovery SystemTM
  • the TaqMan primers and probe sequences are as designed by Applied Biosystems (AB) as part of the Assays on DemandTM product line or by custom design through the AB Assays by Design SM service.
  • AB Applied Biosystems
  • RT-PCR is accomplished using AmpliTaqGold and MultiScribe reverse transcriptase in the One Step RT-PCR Master Mix reagent kit (AB) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Probe and primer concentrations are 250 nM and 900 nM, respectively, in a 15 ⁇ l reaction. For each experiment, a master mix of the above components is made and aliquoted into each optical reaction well. Eight nanograms of total RNA is the template. Each sample is assayed in triplicate. Quantitative RT-PCR is performed using the ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System (SDS). Cycling parameters follow: 48° C. for 30 min. for one cycle; 95° C. for 10 min for one cycle; 95° C. for 15 sec, 60° C. for 1 min. for 40 cycles.
  • SDS ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System
  • the SDS software calculates the threshold cycle (C T ) for each reaction, and C T values are used to quantitate the relative amount of starting template in the reaction.
  • C T values for each set of three reactions are averaged for all subsequent calculations
  • Data are analyzed for fold difference in expression using an endogenous control for normalization and is expressed relative to a normal tissue or normal cell line reference.
  • the choice of endogenous control is determined empirically by testing various candidates against the cell line and tissue RNA panels and selecting the one with the least variation in expression. Relative changes in expression are quantitated using the 2 ⁇ CT Method. Livak, K. J. and Schmittgen, T. D. (2001) Methods 25: 402-408; User bulletin #2: ABI Prism 7700 Sequence Detection System.
  • cells are sorted by flow cytometry known in the art to enrich for epithelial cells.
  • cells isolated from lung tissue are stained directly with EpCAM (for epithelial cells) and the specific antibody to LCAT.
  • Cell numbers and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA) for cells isolated from both normal and tumor lung tissue.
  • GAVA PI exclusion
  • a minimum of 0.5 ⁇ 10 6 cells are used for each analysis.
  • Cells are washed once with Flow Staining Buffer (0.5% BSA, 0.05% NaN 3 in D-PBS).
  • 20 ul of each antibody for LCAT are added.
  • An additional 5 ul of EpCAM antibody conjugated to APC were added when unsorted cells are used in the experiment. Cells are incubated with antibodies for 30 minutes at 4° C.
  • LCAT cells are washed once with Flow Staining Buffer and either analyzed immediately on the LSR flow cytometry apparatus or fixed in 1% formaldehyde and store at 4° C. until LSR analysis.
  • the antibodies used to detect LCAT targets are all purchased by BD Biosciences and PE-conjugated.
  • the isotype control antibody used for these experiments is PE-conjugated mouse IgG1k.
  • the proteins from cells can be prepared by reduction, alkylation and cysteine-containing peptide enrichment of concentrated conditioned media.
  • the differential expression of proteins in disease and healthy samples are quantitated using Liquid Chromatography Mass Spectrometry.
  • the LC/MS spectra from disease and healthy (control) samples are collected and processed using the following steps:
  • the raw scans from the LC/MS instrument are subjected to peak detection and noise reduction software. Filtered peak lists are then used to detect ‘features’ corresponding to specific peptides from the original sample(s).
  • Features are characterized by their mass/charge, charge, retention time, isotope pattern and intensity.
  • Statistical tests are performed to assess the robustness of the data and select statistically significant differentials. To assess general quality of the data, a) ensured that similar features are detected in all replicates of the experiment; b) number of matched ions between replicates; c) calculated the overall pair wise intensity correlations between LC/MS maps of process replicates to ensure that the expression ratios for peptides are reproducible across the multiple replicates; d) aggregated multiple experiments in order to compare the expression ratio of a peptide in multiple diseases or disease samples.
  • Paraffin embedded, fixed tissue sections are obtained from a panel of normal tissues (Adrenal, Bladder, Lymphocytes, Bone Marrow, Breast, Cerebellum, Cerebral cortex, Colon, Endothelium, Eye, Fallopian tube, Small Intestine, Heart, Kidney [glomerulus, tubule], Liver, Lung, Testes and Thyroid) as well as 30 tumor samples with matched normal adjacent tissues from pancreas, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian and breast.
  • other tissues are selected for testing such as bladder renal, hepatocellular, pharyngeal and gastric tumor tissues.
  • Replicate sections are also obtained from numerous tumor types (Bladder Cancer, Lung Cancer, Breast Cancer, Melanoma, Colon Cancer, Non-Hodgkins Lymphoma, Endometrial Cancer, Ovarian Cancer, Head and Neck Cancer, Prostate Cancer, Leukemia [ALL and CML] and Rectal Cancer). Sections are stained with hemotoxylin and eosin and histologically examined to ensure adequate representation of cell types in each tissue section.
  • Sections are deparaffinized in 3 changes of xylene or xylene substitute for 2-5 minutes each. Sections are rinsed in 2 changes of absolute alcohol for 1-2 minutes each, in 95% alcohol for 1 minute, followed by 80% alcohol for 1 minute. Slides are washed well in running water and stained in Gill solution 3 hemotoxylin for 3 to 5 minutes. Following a vigorous wash in running water for 1 minute, sections are stained in Scott's solution for 2 minutes. Sections are washed for 1 min in running water then counterstained in Eosin solution for 2-3 minutes depending upon development of desired staining intensity. Following a brief wash in 95% alcohol, sections are dehydrated in three changes of absolute alcohol for 1 minute each and three changes of xylene or xylene substitute for 1-2 minutes each. Slides are coverslipped and stored for analysis.
  • a positive and negative control sample are generated using data from the ICAT analysis of the lung cancer cell lines/tissues.
  • Cells are selected that are known to express low levels of a particular target as determined from the ICAT data. This cell line is the reference normal control.
  • a lung tumor line is selected that is determined to overexpress the target is selected.
  • Sections are deparaffinized and rehydrated by washing 3 times for 5 minutes in xylene; two times for 5 minutes in 100% ethanol; two times for 5 minutes in 95% ethanol; and once for 5 minutes in 80% ethanol. Sections are then placed in endogenous blocking solution (methanol+2% hydrogen peroxide) and incubated for 20 minutes at room temperature. Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes each in deionized water and twice for 5 minutes in phosphate buffered saline (PBS), pH 7.4.
  • PBS phosphate buffered saline
  • sections are deparrafinized by High Energy Antigen Retrieval as follows: sections are washed three times for 5 minutes in xylene; two times for 5 minutes in 100% ethanol; two times for 5 minutes in 95% ethanol; and once for 5 minutes in 80% ethanol. Sections are placed in a Coplin jar with dilute antigen retrieval solution (10 mM citrate acid, pH 6). The Coplin jar containing slides is placed in a vessel filled with water and microwaved on high for 2-3 minutes (700 watt oven). Following cooling for 2-3 minutes, steps 3 and 4 are repeated four times (depending on tissue), followed by cooling for 20 minutes at room temperature. Sections are then rinsed in deionized water, two times for 5 minutes, placed in modified endogenous oxidation blocking solution (PBS+2% hydrogen peroxide).and rinsed for 5 minutes in PBS.
  • PBS+2% hydrogen peroxide modified endogenous oxidation blocking solution
  • Sections are blocked with PBS/1% bovine serum albumin (PBA) for 1 hour at room temperature followed by incubation in normal serum diluted in PBA (2%) for 30 minutes at room temperature to reduce non-specific binding of antibody. Incubations are performed in a sealed humidity chamber to prevent air-drying of the tissue sections.
  • PBA bovine serum albumin
  • the choice of blocking serum is the same as the species of the biotinylated secondary antibody.
  • Excess antibody is gently removed by shaking and sections covered with primary antibody diluted in PBA and incubated either at room temperature for 1 hour or overnight at 4° C. (Care is taken that the sections do not touch during incubation).Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently. Excess PBS is removed by gently shaking.
  • the sections are covered with diluted biotinylated secondary antibody in PBA and incubated for 30 minutes to 1 hour at room temperature in the humidity chamber. If using a monoclonal primary antibody, addition of 2% rat serum is used to decrease the background on rat tissue sections. Following incubation, sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently. Excess PBS is removed and sections incubated for 1 hour at room temperature in Vectastain ABC reagent (as per kit instructions). The lid of the humidity chamber is secured during all incunations to ensure a moist environment. Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently.
  • Slides are rinsed three times for 5 minutes with deionized water and dehydrated two times for 2 minutes in 95% ethanol; two times for 2 minutes in 100% ethanol; and two times for 2 minutes in xylene. Stained slides are mounted for visualization by microscopy.
  • Fresh tissues are embedded carefully in OCT in plastic mold, without trapping air bubbles surrounding the tissue. Tissues are frozen by setting the mold on top of liquid nitrogen until 70-80% of the block turns white at which point the mold is placed on dry ice. The frozen blocks were stored at ⁇ 80° C. Blocks are sectioned with a cryostat with care taken to avoid warming to greater than ⁇ 10° C. Initially, the block is equilibrated in the cryostat for about 5 minutes and 6-10 mm sections are cut sequentially. Sections are allowed to dry for at least 30 minutes at room temperature. Following drying, tissues are stored at 4° C. for short term and ⁇ 80° C. for long term storage.)
  • Sections are fixed by immersing in acetone jar for 1-2 minutes at room temperature, followed by drying at room temp.
  • Primary antibody is added (diluted in 0.05 M Tris-saline [0.05 M Tris, 0.15 M NaCl, pH 7.4], 2.5% serum) directly to the sections by covering the section dropwise to cover the tissue entirely. Binding is carried out by incubation a chamber for 1 hour at room temperature. Without letting the sections dry out, the secondary antibody (diluted in Tris-saline/2.5% serum) is added in a similar manner to the primary and incubated as before (at least 45 minutes).
  • Cultured tumor cells are labeled with 100 ⁇ Ci 51Cr for 1 hour; Livingston, P. O., Zhang, S., Adluri, S., Yao, T.-J., Graeber, L., Ragupathi, G., Helling, F., & Fleischer, M. (1997). Cancer Immunol. Immunother. 43, 324-330.
  • cells After being washed three times with culture medium, cells are resuspended at 10 5 /ml, and 100 ⁇ l/well are plated onto 96-well round-bottom plates.
  • a range of antibody concentrations are applied to the wells, including an isotype control together with donor peripheral blood mononuclear cells that are plated at a 100:1 and 50:1 ratio.
  • Chromium release assays to assess complement-mediated cytotoxicity are performed for each patient at various time points; Dickler, M. N., Ragupathi, G., Liu, N. X., Musselli, C., Martino, D. J., Miller, V. A., Kris, M. G., Brezicka, F. T., Livingston, P. O. & Grant, S.C. (1999) Clin. Cancer Res. 5, 2773-2779. Cultured tumor cells are washed in FCS-free media two times, resuspended in 500 ⁇ l of media, and incubated with 100 ⁇ Ci 51 Cr per 10 million cells for 2 h at 37° C.
  • the cells are then shaken every 15 min for 2 h, washed 3 times in media to achieve a concentration of approximately 20,000 cells/well, and then plated in round-bottom plates.
  • the plates contain either 50 ⁇ l cells plus 50 ⁇ l monoclonal antibody, 50 ⁇ l cells plus serum (pre- and posttherapy), or 50 ⁇ l cells plus mouse serum as a control.
  • the plates are incubated in a cold room on a shaker for 45 min. Human complement of a 1:5 dilution (resuspended in 1 ml of ice-cold water and diluted with 3% human serum albumin) is added to each well at a volume of 100 ⁇ l.
  • Control wells include those for maximum release of isotope in 10% Triton X-100 (Sigma) and for spontaneous release in the absence of complement with medium alone.
  • the plates are incubated for 2 h at 37° C., centrifuged for 3 min, and then 100 ⁇ l of supernatant is removed for radioactivity counting.
  • Lipofectamine is purchased from Invitrogen (Carlsbad, Calif.) and GeneSilencer from Gene Therapy Systems (San Diego, Calif.). Synthetic siRNA oligonucleotides are from Dharmacon (Lafayette, Colo.), Qiagen (Valencia, Califoria) or Ambion (Austin, Tex.) RNeasy 96 Kit is purchased from Qiagen (Valencia, Calif.). Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay are both purchased from Promega (Madison, Wis.). Alamar Blue proliferation assay can be purchased from Biosource (Camarillo, Calif.).
  • Function blocking antibodies are purchased from Chemicon (Temecula, Calif.), Biotrend (Cologne, Germany) or Alexis Corporation (San Diego, Calif.).
  • Cell invasion assay kits from purchased from Chemicon (Temecula, Calif.).
  • RiboGreen RNA Quantitation Kit is purchased from Molecular probes (Eugene, Oreg.).
  • RNAi is performed by using Smartpools (Dharmacon), 4—for Silencing siRNA duplexes (Qiagen) or scrambled negative control siRNA (Ambion). Transient transfections are carried out in triplicate by using either Lipofectamine 2000 from Invitrogen (Carlsbad, Calif.) or by using GeneSilencer from Gene Therapy Systems (San Diego, Calif.) in methods described below. 1 to 4 days after transfections, total RNA is isolated by using the RNeasy 96 Kit (Qiagen) according to manufacturer's instructions and expression of mRNA is quantitated by using TaqMan technology.
  • Protein expression levels are examined by flow cytometry and apoptosis and proliferation assays are performed daily using Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay (see protocols below).
  • Transient transfections are carried out on sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines as previously described. Elbashir, S. M. et al. (2001) Nature 411: 494-498; Caplen, N. J. et al. (2001) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 98: 9742-9747; Sharp, P. A. (2001) Genes and Development 15: 485-490.
  • Synthetic RNA to gene of interest or scrambled negative control siRNA is transfected using lipofectamine according to manufacturer's instructions. Cells are plated in 96 well plates in antibiotics free medium.
  • the transfection reagent and siRNA are prepared for transfections as follows: Each 0.1-1 ul of lipofectamine 2000 and 10-150 mM siRNA are resuspended 25 ul serum-free media and incubated at room temperature for 5 minutes. After incubation, the diluted siRNA and the lipofectamine 2000 are combined and incubated for 20 minutes at room temperature. The cells are then washed and the combined siRNA-Lipofectamine 2000 reagent added. After further 4 hours incubation, 50 ul serum containing medium added to each well. 1 and 4 days after transfection, expression of mRNA is quantitated by RT-PCR using TaqMan technology and protein expression levels are examined by flow cytometry. Apoptosis and proliferation assays are performed daily using Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay (see protocols below).
  • Transient transfections are carried out on sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines as previously described. Elbashir, S. M. et al. (2001) Nature 411: 494-498; Caplen, N. J. et al. (2001) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 98: 9742-9747; Sharp, P. A. (2001) Genes and Development 15: 485-490.
  • Synthetic RNA to gene of interest or scrambled negative control siRNA is transfected using GeneSilencer according to manufacturer's instructions. Cells are plated in 96 well plates in antibiotics free medium.
  • the transfection reagent and the synthetic siRNA are prepared for transfections as follows: predetermined amount of Gene Silencer is diluted in serum-free media to a final volume of 20 ul per well. After resuspending 10-150 mM siRNA in 20 ul serum-free media, the reagents are combined and incubated at room temperature for 5-20 minutes. After incubation, the siRNA-Gene Silencer reagent is added to each well and incubated in a 37° C. incubator for 4 hours before an equal volume of serum containing media is added back to the cultured cells. The cells are then incubated for 1 to 4 days before mRNA, protein expression and effects on apoptosis and proliferation are examined.
  • Sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines are serum-staved overnight. The next day, serum-containing media is added back to the cells in the presence of 5-50 ng/ml of function blocking antibodies. After 2 or 5 days incubation at 37° C. 5% CO 2 , antibody binding is examined by flow cytometry and apoptosis and proliferation are examined by using protocols described below.
  • Apoptosis assay is performed by using the Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit from Promega. Briefly, the caspase-3/7 substrate is thawed to room temperature and diluted 1:100 with buffer. The diluted substrate is then added 1:1 to cells, control or blank. The plates are then placed on a plate shaker for 30 minutes to 18 hours at 300-500 rpm. The fluorescence of each well is then measured at using an excitation wavelength of 485+/ ⁇ 20 nm and an emission wavelength of 530+/ ⁇ 25 nm.
  • Proliferation assay is performed by using the CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay kit from Promega. 20 ul of CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution is added to 100 ul of culture medium. The plates are then incubated for 1-4 hours at 37° C. in a humidified 5% CO 2 incubator. After incubation, the change in absorbance is read at 490 nm.
  • Proliferation assay is performed by using the Alamar Blue assay from Biosource. 10 ul of Alamar Blue reagent is added to 100 ul of cells in culture medium. The plates are then incubated for 1-4 hours at 37° C. in a humidified 5% CO 2 incubator. After incubation, the change in fluorescence is measured at using an excitation wavelength of 530 nm and an emission wavelength of 595 nm.
  • Cell invasion assay is performed by using the 96 well cell invasion assay kit available from Chemicon. After the cell invasion chamber plates are adjusted to room temperature, 100 ul serum-free media is added to the interior of the inserts. 1-2 hours later, cell suspensions of 1 ⁇ 10 6 cells/ml are prepared. Media is then carefully removed from the inserts and 100 ul of prepared cells are added into the insert +/ ⁇ 0 to 50 ng function blocking antibodies. The cells are pre-incubated for 15 minutes at 37° C. before 150 ul of media containing 10% FBS is added to the lower chamber. The cells are then incubated for 48 hours at 37° C.
  • the invasion chamber plates are then placed on a new 96-well feeder tray containing 150 ul of pre-warmed cell detachment solution in the wells.
  • the plates are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C. and are periodically shaken.
  • Lysis buffer/dye solution (4 ul CyQuant Dye/300 ul 4 ⁇ X lysis buffer) is prepared and added to each well of dissociation buffer/cells on feeder tray.
  • the plates are incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature before 150 ul is transferred to a new 96-well plate. Fluorescence of invading cells is then read at 480 excitation and 520 emission.
  • ELISA assays are performed essentially as described by Daunt et al. Daunt, D. A., Hurtz, C., Hein, L., Kallio, J., Feng, F., and Kobilka, B. K. (1997) Mol. Pharmacol. 51, 711-720.
  • the cell lines are plated at 6 ⁇ 10 5 cells per in a 24-well tissue culture dishes that have previously been coated with 0.1 mg/ml poly-L-lysine. The next day, the cells are washed once with PBS and incubated in DMEM at 37° C. for several minutes. Agonist to the cell surface target of interest is then added at a pre-determined concentration in prewarmed DMEM to the wells.
  • the cells are then incubated for various times at 37° C. and reactions are stopped by removing the media and fixing the cells in 3.7% formaldehyde/TBS for 5 min at room temperature.
  • the cells are then washed three times with TBS and nonspecific binding blocked with TBS containing 1% BSA for 45 min at room temperature.
  • the first antibody is added at a pre-determined dilution in TBS/BSA for 1 h at room temperature. Three washes with TBS followed, and cells are briefly reblocked for 15 min at room temperature.
  • Incubation with goat anti-mouse conjugated alkaline phosphatase (Bio-Rad) diluted 1:1000 in TBS/BSA is carried out for 1 h at room temperature.
  • the cells are washed three times with TBS and a colorimetric alkaline phosphatase substrate is added. When the adequate color change is reached, 100-ul samples are taken for colorimetric readings.
  • RNA is isolated from cancer model cell lines using the RNEasy 96 kit (Qiagen) per manufacturer's instructions and included DNase treatment.
  • Target transcript sequences are identified for the differentially expressed peptides by searching the BlastP database.
  • TaqMan assays PCR primer/probe set
  • CDS Celera Discovery SystemTM
  • the assays are designed to span exon-exon borders and do not amplify genomic DNA.
  • the TaqMan primers and probe sequences are as designed by Applied Biosystems (AB) as part of the Assays on DemandTM product line or by custom design through the AB Assays by Design SM service.
  • RT-PCR is accomplished using AmpliTaqGold and MultiScribe reverse transcriptase in the One Step RT-PCR Master Mix reagent kit (AB) according to the manufacturers instructions. Probe and primer concentrations are 900 nM and 250 nM, respectively, in a 250 ⁇ l reaction. For each experiment, a master mix of the above components is made and aliquoted into each optical reaction well. 5 ul of total RNA is the template. Each sample is assayed in triplicate. Quantitative RT-PCR is performed using the ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System (SDS). Cycling parameters follow: 48° C. for 30 min. for one cycle; 95° C. for 10 min for one cycle; 95° C. for 15 sec, 60° C. for 1 min. for 40 cycles.
  • SDS ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System
  • the SDS software calculates the threshold cycle (C T ) for each reaction, and C T values are used to quantitate the relative amount of starting template in the reaction.
  • C T values for each set of three reactions are averaged for all subsequent calculations.
  • Total RNA is quantitated by using RiboGreen RNA Quantitation Kit according to manufacturer's instructions and the % mRNA expression is calculated using total RNA for normalization. % knockdown is then calculated relative to the no addition control.
  • Lung cancer cells are seeded at a density of 4 ⁇ 10 4 cells per well in 96-well microtiter plates and allowed to adhere for 2 hours. The cells are then treated with different concentrations of anti-LCAT monoclonal antibody (Mab) or irrelevant isotype matched (anti-rHuIFN-. gamma. Mab) at 0.05, 0.5 or 5.0 mug/ml. After a 72 hour incubation, the cell monolayers are stained with crystal violet dye for determination of relative percent viability (RPV) compared to control (untreated) cells. Each treatment group consists of replicates. Cell growth inhibition is monitored.
  • Mab anti-LCAT monoclonal antibody
  • irrelevant isotype matched anti-rHuIFN-. gamma. Mab
  • NIH 3T3 expressing LCAT protein are treated with different concentrations of anti-LCAT MAbs. Cell growth inhibition is monitored.
  • NIH 3T3 cells transfected with either a LCAT expression plasmidor the neo-DHFR vector are injected into nu/nu (athymic) mice subcutaneously at a dose of 10 6 cells in 0.1 ml of phosphate-buffered saline.
  • 100 mug (0.1 ml in PBS) of either an irrelevant or anti-LCAT monoclonal antibody of the IG2A subclass is injected intraperitoneally. Tumor occurrence and size are monitored for 1 month period of treatment.
  • Protein Peptide Sample Ratio SEQ ID NO: 250 gi
  • Chromosome Chr3 OMIM Information: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MFI2 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 251) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1376) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2182) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 474-495) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2283) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 390-400) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2307) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 215-227) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2386) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 239-257) Protein Number: 715 Celera Protein: hCP1882999 Protein Name: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MAP97, MGC4856, MTF1 Celera Transcript: hCT2287953 Celera Gene: hCG41190 Gene
  • Chromosome Chr3 OMIM Information: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MFI2 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 715) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1736) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2307) (SEQ ID NO: 715, 215-227) Protein Number: 776 Celera Protein: hCP1882038 Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein Celera Transcript: hCT2279247.1 Celera Gene: hCG1997600 Gene Symbol: KIAA1324 Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr1 OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein;KIAA1324 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 776) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1792) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 776, 649-661) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 776, 694-708) Protein Number: 777 Celera Protein: hCP1882041 Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein Celera Transcript: hCT2279248.1 Celera Gene: hCG1997600 Gene Symbol: KIAA1324 Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr1 OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein;KIAA1324 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 777) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1793) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 777, 299-311) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 777, 344-358) Protein Number: 778 Celera Protein: hCP1882040 Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein Celera Transcript: hCT2279250.1 Celera Gene: hCG1997600 Gene Symbol: KIAA1324 Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr1 OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein; KIAA1324 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 778) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1794) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 778, 339-351) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 778, 384-398) Protein Number: 779 Celera Protein: hCP1907105 Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein Celera Transcript: hCT2340521 Celera Gene: hCG1997600 Gene Symbol: KIAA1324 Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr1 OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein; KIAA1324 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 779) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1795) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 779, 649-661) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 779, 694-708) Protein Number: 780 Celera Protein: hCP1882039 Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein Celera Transcript: hCT2279248.1 Celera Gene: hCG1997600 Gene Symbol: KIAA1324 Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr21 OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 915) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1916) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 915, 31-41) Protein Number: 916 Celera Protein: hCP1813431 Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR,HCAR Celera Transcript: hCT2296276 Celera Gene: hCG2008096 Gene Symbol: CXADR Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr21 OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 916) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1917) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 916, 31-41) Protein Number: 917 Public Protein Accession: XP_496028.1 Protein Name: PREDICTED: similar to coxsackie-adenovirus-receptor isoform CAR4/7 [Homo sapiens] Public Transcript Accession: XM_496028 Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 917) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1918) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 917, 4-14) Protein Number: 918 Celera Protein: hCP1813429 Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR,HCAR Celera Transcript: hCT2296275 Celera Gene:
  • Chromosome Chr21 OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor
  • CXADR Protein Sequence SEQ ID NO: 918) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1919) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 918, 31-41) Protein Number: 919 Celera Protein: hCP1813430 Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor
  • CAR, HCAR Celera Transcript hCT2296274 Celera Gene: hCG2008096 Gene Symbol: CXADR Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . .
  • Chromosome Chr21 OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 919) Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1920) Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 919, 31-41)

Abstract

The present invention provides a method for diagnosing and detecting diseases associated with lung. The present invention provides one or more proteins or fragments thereof, peptides or nucleic acid molecules differentially expressed in lung diseases (LCAT) and antibodies binds to LCATs. The present invention provides that LCATs are used as targets for screening agents that modulates the LCAT activities. Further the present invention provides methods for treating diseases associated with lung.

Description

    FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention relates to the fields of molecular biology and oncology. Specifically, the invention provides a molecular marker and a therapeutic agent for use in the diagnosis and treatment of lung diseases.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • Lung cancer is the second most prevalent type of cancer for both men and women in the United States and is the most common cause of cancer death in both sexes. Lung cancer can result from a primary tumor originating in the lung or a secondary tumor which has spread from another organ such as the bowel or breast. The five-year survival rate for lung cancer continues to be poor at 8-15% survival indicating a large unmet need with regard to more effective treatments and better diagnosis. The estimated total lung cancer deaths in the U.S. in 2003 are 157,200 and the total estimated new cases in 2003 are 171,900. Primary lung cancer is divided into three main types; small cell lung cancer; non-small cell lung cancer; and mesothelioma. Small cell lung cancer is also called “Oat Cell” lung cancer because the cancer cells are a distinctive oat shape. There are three types of non-small cell lung cancer. These are grouped together because they behave in a similar way and respond to treatment differently to small cell lung cancer. The three types are squamous cell carcinoma, adenocarcinoma, and large cell carcinoma. Squamous cell cancer develops from the cells that line the airways. Adenocarcinoma also develops from the cells that line the airways. However, adenocarcinoma develops from a particular type of cell that produces mucus (phlegm). Large cell lung cancer has been thus named because the cells look large and rounded when they are viewed under a microscope. Mesothelioma is a rare type of cancer which affects the covering of the lung called the pleura. Mesothelioma is often caused by exposure to asbestos.
  • Secondary lung cancer is cancer that has started somewhere else in the body (for example, the breast or bowel) and spread to the lungs. Choice of treatment for secondary lung cancer depends on where the cancer started. In other words, cancer that has spread from the breast should respond to breast cancer treatments and cancer that has spread from the bowel should respond to bowel cancer treatments.
  • The stage of a cancer indicates how far a cancer has spread. Staging is important because treatment is often decided according to the stage of a cancer. The staging is different for non-small cell and for small cell cancers of the lung.
  • Non-small cell cancer can be divided into four stages. Stage I is very localized cancer with no cancer in the lymph nodes. Stage II cancer has spread to the lymph nodes at the top of the affected lung. Stage III cancer has spread near to where the cancer started. This can be to the chest wall, the covering of the lung (pleura), the middle of the chest (mediastinum) or other lymph nodes. Stage IV cancer has spread to another part of the body.
  • Since small cell lung cancer can spread quite early in development of the disease, small cell lung cancers are divided into only two groups. These are: limited disease, that is cancer that can only be seen in one lung and in nearby lymph nodes; and extensive disease, that is cancer that has spread outside the lung to the chest or to other parts of the body. Further, even if spreading is not apparent on the scans, it is likely that some cancer cells will have broken away and traveled through the bloodstream or lymph system. To be safe, it is therefore preferred to treat small cell lung cancers as if they have spread, whether or not secondary cancer is visible. Because surgery is not typically used to treat small cell cancer, except in very early cases, the staging is not as critical as it is with some other types of cancer. Chemotherapy with or without radiotherapy is often employed. The scans and tests done at first will be used later to see how well a patient is responding to treatment.
  • Procedures used for detecting, diagnosing, monitoring, staging, and prognosticating lung cancer are of critical importance to the outcome of the patient. For example, patients diagnosed with early lung cancer generally have a much greater five-year survival rate as compared to the survival rate for patients diagnosed with distant metastasized lung cancer. New diagnostic methods which are more sensitive and specific for detecting early lung cancer are clearly needed.
  • Lung cancer patients are closely monitored following initial therapy and during adjuvant therapy to determine response to therapy and to detect persistent or recurrent disease of metastasis. There is clearly a need for a lung cancer marker which is more sensitive and specific in detecting lung cancer, its recurrence, and progression.
  • Another important step in managing lung cancer is to determine the stage of the patient's disease. Stage determination has potential prognostic value and provides criteria for designing optimal therapy. Generally, pathological staging of lung cancer is preferable over clinical staging because the former gives a more accurate prognosis. However, clinical staging would be preferred were it at least as accurate as pathological staging because it does not depend on an invasive procedure to obtain tissue for pathological evaluation. Staging of lung cancer would be improved by detecting new markers in cells, tissues, or bodily fluids which could differentiate between different stages of invasion.
  • One promising method for early diagnosis of various forms of cancer is the identification of specific biochemical moieties, termed targets expressed differentially in the cancerous cells. The targets are either cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, and/or secreted proteins. Antibodies which will specifically recognize and bind to the targets in the cancerous cells potentially provide powerful tools for the diagnosis and treatment of the particular malignancy.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention is based on the identification of certain cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, and/or secreted proteins that are differentially expressed in lung disease. A malignant cell often differs from a normal cell by a differential expression of one or more proteins. These differentially expressed proteins, and the fragments thereof, are important markers for the diagnosis of lung disease. The differentially expressed proteins of the present invention and the nucleic acids encoding said proteins and the fragments of said proteins are referred to herein as lung cancer associated target, LCAT proteins or LCAT nucleic acids or LCAT peptides, respectively.
  • The present invention provides peptides and protein differentially expressed in lung diseases (hereinafter LCAT). Based on the site of protein localization, e.g., surface or cytosolic, and protein characterization, e.g. receptor or enzyme, specific uses of these LCATs are provided. Some of the LCATs of the present invention serve as targets for one or more classes of therapeutic agents, while others may be suitable for antibody therapeutics.
  • Accordingly, the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung disease in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins, or any fragment(s) thereof, in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154; wherein a differential level of said LCAT protein(s) or fragment(s) in said sample relative to the level of said protein(s) or fragment(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • The present invention also provides a method for detecting lung cancer in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT peptide(s) comprising a peptide sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 in a test sample from said subject, wherein a differential level of said LCAT peptide(s) in said sample to the level of said LCAT peptide(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level of said LCAT peptide(s) established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • The present invention further provides a method for detecting lung disease in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid(s), or any fragment(s) thereof, in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT nucleic acid(s) encode a LCAT protein sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154; wherein a differential level of said LCAT nucleic acids or fragment(s) in said sample relative to the level of said protein(s) or fragment(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung disease.
  • The invention also provides methods for detecting the LCAT peptides, gene or mRNA in a test sample for use in diagnosing the presence, absence or progression of a disease. The test sample includes but is not limited to a biological sample such as tissue, blood, serum or biological fluid.
  • The present invention further provides a purified antibody that binds specifically to a protein molecule, or any fragment thereof, selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • The present invention further provides a composition comprising an antibody that binds to a protein selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, and an acceptable carrier.
  • The present invention further provides a method for treating lung disease, comprising administering to a patient in need of said treatment a therapeutically effective amount of one or more antibody(ies) of this invention.
  • The present invention further provides a method for treating lung disease comprising (i) identifying a subject having lung disease and (ii) administering to a said patient a therapeutically effective amount of one or more antibody(ies) of this invention.
  • The present invention further provides a method to screen for agents that modulate LCAT protein activity, comprising the steps of (i) contacting a test agent with a LCAT protein and (ii) assaying for LCAT protein activity, wherein a change in said activity in the presence of said agent relative to LCAT protein activity in the absence of said agent indicates said agent modulates said LCAT protein activity.
  • The present invention further provides a method to screen for agents that bind to LCAT protein, comprising the steps of (i) contacting a test agent with a LCAT protein and (ii) measuring the level of binding of agent to said LCAT protein.
  • The invention also provides diagnostic methods for human disease, in particular for lung diseases, its metastatic stage, and therapeutic potential.
  • The invention also provides a method for monitoring the disease progression and the treatment progress.
  • The invention further provide a method of diagnosis by an array, wherein the array is immobilized with two or more LCAT proteins, peptides or nucleic acid molecules. The proteins, peptides or nucleic acid molecules include but are not limited to the SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • The invention also provides monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies and composition thereof reactive with antigenic portion of LCAT protein, peptides or fragments thereof in a form for use in lung diseases diagnosis.
  • The invention further provides an immunogenic antibody for treating lung diseases disease or diseases associated with lung diseases.
  • The present invention provides a method for screening agents that modulate LCAT activity, comprising the steps of (a) contacting a sample comprising LCAT with an agent; and (b) assaying for LCAT activity, wherein a change in said LCAT activity in the presence of said agent relative to LCAT activity in the absence of said compound indicates said agent modulates LCAT. The agents include but are not limited to protein, peptide, antibody, nucleic acid such as antisense RNA, RNAi fragments, small molecules.
  • The present invention further provides a method for treating lung diseases, comprising: administering to a patient with one or more agents in a therapeutically effective amount to treat lung diseases.
  • The present invention provides a method for treating lung diseases, comprising: identifying a subject having lung diseases; and administering to a patient to one or more antibodies in a therapeutically effective amount to treat lung diseases.
  • Description of the Files Contained on the CD-R Named CL001617CDR
  • The CD-R named CL001617CDR contains the following three text (ASCII) files:
  • 1) File SEQLIST1617 txt provides the Sequence Listing. The Sequence Listing provides the protein sequences (SEQ ID NOS:1-1154); transcript sequences (SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120) and peptide sequences (SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525) as shown in Table 2. File SEQLIST1617.txt is 9,126 KB in size.
    2) File TABLE11617.txt provides Table 1. File TABLE11617.is 9 KB in size.
    3) File TABLE21617.txt provides Table 2. File TABLE21617 is 9 KB in size.
    4) File TABLE31617.txt provides Table 2. File TABLE31617 is 4 KB in size.
  • The material contained on the CD-R labeled CL001617CDR is hereby incorporated by reference pursuant to 37 CFR 1.77(b)(4).
  • TABLES
    The patent application contains table(s) that have been included at the end of the specification.
  • Description of Table 1 and Table 2
  • Table 1 (provided on the CD-R) discloses the peptides which correspond to the protein, the lung cancer cell lines and lung tumor tissues (“source”), the expression information, the ratio compare to the control sample. The expression is based on measuring the level of the peptides. Numerical representation of overexpression is indicated by more than two, whereas numerical representation of underexpression is indicated by less than 0.5. Over expressed singleton indicates that the peptide peak in diseased sample was detected and there was no peak detected in control samples. Under expressed singleton indicates that the peptide peak was detected in the control sample and there was no peak in the diseased sample.
  • Table 2 (provided on the CD-R) discloses the LCAT proteins, transcripts, and peptides sequences that correlated to the Table 1.
  • The transcript/protein information includes:
  • a protein number (1 through 1154)
  • a Celera protein internal identification number for the protein encoded by the Celera transcript (hCP and/or UID)
  • a public protein accession number (Genbank e.g., RefSeq NP number, Swiss-prot, or Derwent) for the protein
  • an art-known gene/protein name
  • a Celera transcript internal identification number (hCT and/or UID)
  • a public transcript accession number (Genbank e.g., RefSeq NM number, or Derwent)
  • a Celera hCG and UID internal identification numbers for the gene
  • an art-known gene symbol
  • Celera genomic axis position (indicating start nucleotide position-stop nucleotide position)
  • the chromosome number of the chromosome on which the gene is located
  • an OMIM (Online Mendelian Inheritance in Man; Johns Hopkins University/NCBI) public reference number for obtaining further information regarding the medical significance of each gene
  • alternative gene/protein name(s) and/or symbol(s) in the OMIM entry
  • Description of Table 3
  • Table 3 discloses tumor staging information as follows (all tumor staging designations in Table 3 are those which are typically used in the art): Sample ID Number, sample type (labeled “Sample”), cancer type (labeled “Type”), Lymph Nodes (the “N” in the TNM staging system, for Node, which designates the spread of a tumor to the lymph nodes), Distant Metastasis (the “M” in the TNM staging system, for Metastasis, which designates the extent of tumor metastasis), Extent of Invasion (the “T” in the TNM staging system, for Tumor, which designates the size and location of a primary tumor), and AJCC Stage (which is assigned based on a combination of the T, N, and M classifications).
  • The Lymph Nodes (“N”) stages are as follows: “NX”=the regional lymph nodes cannot be assessed, “N0”=cancer has not spread to the lymph nodes, “N1”=cancer has spread to lymph nodes within the lung and/or hilar lymph nodes and only lymph nodes on the same side of the body as the cancerous lung are affected by the cancer, “N2”=cancer has spread to lymph nodes around the point where the windpipe branches into the left and right bronchi or in the mediastinum and only lymph nodes on the same side of the body as the cancerous lung are affected by the cancer, and “N3”=cancer has spread to lymph nodes near the collarbone on either side, to hilar or mediastinal lymph nodes on the side opposite the cancerous lung.
  • The Distant Metastasis (“M”) stages are as follows: “MX”=distant spread cannot be assessed, “M0”=the disease has not metastasized to distant organs or areas, and “M1”=there is metastasis to another part of the body beyond the lung area.
  • The Extent of Invasion (“T”) stages are as follows: “TX”=the primary tumor cannot be evaluated, “T0”=there is no evidence of a primary tumor in the lung(s), “Tis”=cancer is found only in the layer of cells lining the air passages and has not invaded other lung tissues (carcinoma in situ), “T1”=the cancer is no larger than 3 cm and has not spread to the visceral pleura and does not affect the main branches of the bronchi, “T2”=The cancer has one or more of the following features: it is larger than 3 cm, it involves a main bronchus but is not closer than 2 cm to the point where the trachea branches into the left and right main bronchi (carina), it has spread to the pleura, and/or the cancer may partially clog the airways but this has not caused the entire lung to collapse or develop pneumonia, “T3”=the cancer has one or more of the following features: the cancer has spread to the chest wall, the diaphragm, the mediastinal pleura, or parietal pericardium, the cancer affects a main bronchus and is closer than 2 cm to the carina but the cancer does not affect this area, and/or the cancer has affected the airways enough to cause an entire lung to collapse or to cause pneumonia in the entire lung, and “T4”=the cancer has one or more of the following features: the cancer has spread to the mediastinum, the heart, the trachea, the esophagus, the backbone, or the carina, two or more separate tumor nodules are present in the same lobe, and/or fluid containing cancer cells is present in the space surrounding the lung.
  • The AJCC Stages are as follows: “0”=the cancer is found only in the layer of cells lining the air passages and it has not invaded other lung tissues nor spread to lymph nodes or distant sites (Tis, N0, M0), “IA”=the cancer is no larger than 3 cm, has not spread to the membranes that surround the lungs, does not affect the main branches of the bronchi and has not spread to lymph nodes or distant sites(T1, N0, M0), “IB”=the cancer is larger than 3 cm, or involves a main bronchus but is not near the carina, or it has spread to the pleura, or the cancer is partially clogging the airways but the cancer has not spread to lymph nodes or distant sites (T2, N0, M0), “IIA”=the cancer is no larger than 3 cm, has not spread to the membranes that surround the lungs, does not affect the main branches of the bronchi, and it has spread to nearby or hilar lymph nodes but not to distant sites (T1, N1, M0), “IIB”=the cancer is larger than 3 cm or involves a main bronchus but is not near the carina, or the cancer has spread to the pleura or is partially clogging the airways. The cancer has spread to nearby or hilar lymph nodes but not to distant sites, or the cancer has spread to the chest wall or the diaphragm, the mediastinal pleura, or membranes surrounding the heart, or it affects a main bronchus and is close to the carina or has grown into the airways enough to cause an entire lung to collapse or to cause pneumonia in the entire lung, but it has not spread to lymph nodes or distant sites (T2, N1, M0 or T3, N0, M0), “IIIA”=the cancer can be any size or involves a main bronchus but is not near the carina or it has spread to the pleura or the cancer is partially clogging the airways. The cancer has spread to nodes in the mediastinum, but not to distant sites, or the cancer has spread to the chest wall or the diaphragm, the mediastinal pleura, or membranes surrounding the heart, or it invades a main bronchus and is close to the carina or it has grown into the airways enough to cause an entire lung to collapse or to cause pneumonia in the entire lung, and it has spread to lymph nodes anywhere in the chest on the same side as the cancer but not to distant sites (T1 or 2, N2, M0 or T3, N1 or 2, M0), “IIIB”=the cancer can be of any size. The cancer has spread to lymph nodes around the collarbone on either side, or to hilar or mediastinal lymph nodes on the side opposite the cancerous lung, or the cancer has spread to the mediastinum, the heart, the trachea, the esophagus, the backbone, or the carina, or two or more separate tumor nodules are present in the same lobe, or fluid containing cancer cells is present in the space surrounding the lung. The cancer may or may not have spread to lymph nodes and it has not spread to distant sites (T1, 2 or 3, N3, M0 or T4, N0, 1, 2 or 3, M0), and “IV”=the cancer has spread to distant sites (any T, any N, M1).
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE PREFERRED EMBODIMENTS General Description
  • While the broadest definition of this invention is set forth in the Summary of the Invention, certain nucleic acids, peptides or proteins are preferred. For example a preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT protein(s) or any fragment(s) thereof is wherein the level of LCAT protein(s) are determined by contacting one or more antibody(ies) that specifically bind to the antigenic regions of the LCAT protein(s). Further preferred is a method wherein the level of two or more proteins are determined, more preferred wherein the level of four or more proteins are determined and most preferred wherein the level of eight or more proteins are determined.
  • A preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT peptide(s) is wherein the level of LCAT peptides(s) are determined by contacting one or more antibody(ies) that specifically bind to the antigenic regions of the LCAT peptide(s). Further preferred is a method wherein the level of five or more peptides are determined, more preferred wherein the level of ten or more peptides are determined and most preferred wherein the level of fifteen or more peptides are determined.
  • A preferred method for detecting lung disease by determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid(s) is wherein the level of said LCAT nucleic acid(s) is determined by contacting one or more probes that specifically hybridize to said nucleic acid(s). Further preferred is a method wherein the level of two or more nucleic acids are determined, more preferred wherein the level of four or more nucleic acids are determined and most preferred wherein the level of eight or more nucleic acids are determined.
  • The methods for detecting lung disease provided by the present invention may be used for diagnosing the presence of disease in a patent, monitoring the presence of lung disease in patients undergoing treatment and testing for the reoccurrence of lung disease in patients that were successfully treated for lung disease; preferably wherein the lung disease is lung cancer. The test sample may be, but is not limited to, a biological sample such as tissue, blood, serum or biological fluid.
  • The present invention is based on the discovery of protein(s) and peptide(s) that are differentially expressed in lung diseases cancer samples versus normal lung diseases samples. These proteins and peptide, and the encoding nucleic acid molecules are associated with lung diseases, hereinafter the LCAT protein, peptide or nucleic acids.
  • The discovery of disease specific target proteins is base on discoveries made using proteomics techniques. The method uses on MALDI-TOF TOF LC/MS analyses platform to generate protein expression profiles from lung diseases tissues or cell lines in an effort to discover and identify novel molecules associated with the disease.
  • Based on these discoveries, the present invention provides proteins, peptides, nucleic acids that are differential in lung diseases, as well as antibodies binds to the proteins or peptides. The present invention also provides methods for detection, monitoring, diagnosis, prognosis, preventive and treatment of lung diseases. The present invention provides a detection reagent, markers for lung diseases at various stages, comprises LCAT sequences isolated from human lung diseases tissue, sera, cell lines, blood or biological fluids.
  • The present invention provides a method for treating lung diseases targeting at LCAT. The treatment includes administration of a therapeutically effective amount of composition comprising, but not limit to, an antibody, an immunogenic peptide which induces T cell response, a small molecule, a protein or a nucleic acid molecule. The composition further comprises an agonist or antagonist to LCAT.
  • The present invention may further provide a diagnostic or therapeutic potential for epithelial-cell related cancers, which include but are not limited to pancreas, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian, breast, bladder renal, hepatocellular, pharyngeal and gastric cancers
  • The present invention further provides the target for screening an agent for LCAT, wherein the agent is compounds of small molecules, proteins, peptides, nucleic acids, antibodies or other agonists or antagonists.
  • LCAT Peptide/Proteins and Peptides
  • The present invention provides isolated LCAT peptide and protein molecules that consisting of, consisting essentially of, or comprising the amino acid sequences of the LCAT peptides and proteins disclosed in the Tables 1 and 2, (encoded by the nucleic acid molecule shown in Table 2), as well as all obvious variants of these peptides that are within the art to make and use. Some of these variants are described in detail below.
  • In one embodiment LCAT peptides include, but are not limited to, the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and variants thereof. A LCAT protein includes, but is not limited to, the amino acid sequences of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 and variants thereof. LCAT proteins may be differentially expressed in lung cell line, blood, tissue, serum or body fluids.
  • The peptide or protein or fragment thereof, to which the invention pertains, however, are not to be construed as encompassing peptide, protein or fragment that may be disclosed publicly prior to the present invention.
  • The LCAT proteins and peptides of the present invention can be purified to homogeneity or other degrees of purity. The level of purification will be based on the intended use. The critical feature is that the preparation allows for the desired function of the peptide, even if in the presence of considerable amounts of other components (the features of an isolated nucleic acid molecule is discussed below).
  • As used herein, a “peptide” is defined as amino acid sequences between 5-20 amino acids derived from LCAT proteins such as SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 or variants thereof. The peptide differentially expressed in either lung diseases cell line, blood, tissue, serum or body fluids. In one embodiment peptides include, but are not limited to, the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525, or variants thereof.
  • As used herein, a “protein” is full-length protein differentially expressed in lung diseases cell line, tissue, blood, serum or body fluids. A protein includes, but is not limited to, the amino acid sequences of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • A peptide is said to be “isolated” or “purified” when it is substantially free of cellular material or free of chemical precursors or other chemicals. The peptides of the present invention can be purified to homogeneity or other degrees of purity. The level of purification will be based on the intended use. The critical feature is that the preparation allows for the desired function of the peptide, even if in the presence of considerable amounts of other components (the features of an isolated nucleic acid molecule are discussed below).
  • In some uses, “substantially free of cellular material” includes preparations of the peptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) other proteins (i.e., contaminating protein), less than about 20% other proteins, less than about 10% other proteins, or less than about 5% other proteins. When the peptide is recombinantly produced, it can also be substantially free of culture medium, i.e., culture medium represents less than about 20% of the volume of the protein preparation.
  • The language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of the peptide in which it is separated from chemical precursors or other chemicals that are involved in its synthesis. In one embodiment, the language “substantially free of chemical precursors or other chemicals” includes preparations of the LCAT peptide having less than about 30% (by dry weight) chemical precursors or other chemicals, less than about 20% chemical precursors or other chemicals, less than about 10% chemical precursors or other chemicals, or less than about 5% chemical precursors or other chemicals.
  • The isolated LCAT proteins and peptide can be purified from cells that naturally express it, purified from cells that have been altered to express it (recombinant), or synthesized using known protein synthesis methods. Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001). Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. For example, a nucleic acid molecule encoding the LCAT protein or peptide is cloned into an expression vector, the expression vector introduced into a host cell and the protein expressed in the host cell. The protein or peptide can then be isolated from the cells by an appropriate purification scheme using standard protein purification techniques. Many of these techniques are described in detail below.
  • A LCAT peptide or protein can be attached to heterologous sequences to form chimeric or fusion proteins. Such Schimeric and fusion proteins comprise a peptide operatively linked to a heterologous protein having an amino acid sequence not substantially homologous to the peptide. “Operatively linked” indicates that the peptide and the heterologous protein are fused in-frame. The heterologous protein can be fused to the N-terminus or C-terminus of the peptide.
  • In some uses, the fusion protein does not affect the activity of the peptide or protein per se. For example, the fusion protein can include, but is not limited to, fusion proteins, for example beta-galactosidase fusions, yeast two-hybrid GAL fusions, poly-His fusions, MYC-tagged, HI-tagged and Ig fusions. Such fusion proteins, particularly poly-His fusions, can facilitate the purification of recombinant LCAT proteins or peptides. In certain host cells (e.g., mammalian host cells), expression and/or secretion of a protein can be increased by using a heterologous signal sequence.
  • A chimeric or fusion LCAT protein or peptide can be produced by standard recombinant DNA techniques. For example, DNA fragments coding for the different protein sequences are ligated together in-frame in accordance with conventional techniques. In another embodiment, the fusion gene can be synthesized by conventional techniques including automated DNA synthesizers. Alternatively, PCR amplification of gene fragments can be carried out using anchor primers which give rise to complementary overhangs between two consecutive gene fragments which can subsequently be annealed and re-amplified to generate a chimeric gene sequence (see Ausubel et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, 1992). Moreover, many expression vectors are commercially available that already encode a fusion moiety (e.g., a GST protein). A LCAT-encoding nucleic acid can be cloned into such an expression vector such that the fusion moiety is linked in-frame to the LCAT protein or peptide.
  • As mentioned above, the LCAT peptide or the LCAT protein has obvious variants of the amino acid sequence, such as naturally occurring mature forms of the LCAT, allelic/sequence variants of the LCAT, non-naturally occurring recombinantly derived variants of the LCATs, and orthologs and paralogs of the LCAT proteins or peptides. Such variants can readily be generated using art-known techniques in the fields of recombinant nucleic acid technology and protein biochemistry.
  • It is understood, however, that LCAT and variants exclude any amino acid sequences disclosed prior to the invention.
  • Such variants can readily be identified/made using molecular techniques and the sequence information disclosed herein. Further, such variants can readily be distinguished from other peptides based on sequence and/or structural homology to the LCAT peptides of the present invention. The degree of homology/identity present will be based primarily on whether the peptide is a functional variant or non-functional variant, the amount of divergence present in the paralog family and the evolutionary distance between the orthologs.
  • To determine the percent identity of two amino acid sequences or two nucleic acid sequences, the sequences are aligned for optimal comparison purposes (e.g., gaps can be introduced in one or both of a first and a second amino acid or nucleic acid sequence for optimal alignment and non-homologous sequences can be disregarded for comparison purposes). In a preferred embodiment, at least 30%, 40%, 50%, 60%, 70%, 80%, or 90% or more of the length of a reference sequence is aligned for comparison purposes. The amino acid residues or nucleotides at corresponding amino acid positions or nucleotide positions are then compared. When a position in the first sequence is occupied by the same amino acid residue or nucleotide as the corresponding position in the second sequence, then the molecules are identical at that position (as used herein amino acid or nucleic acid “identity” is equivalent to amino acid or nucleic acid “homology”). The percent identity between the two sequences is a function of the number of identical positions shared by the sequences, taking into account the number of gaps, and the length of each gap, which need to be introduced for optimal alignment of the two sequences.
  • The comparison of sequences and determination of percent identity and similarity between two sequences can be accomplished using a mathematical algorithm. (Computational Molecular Biology, Lesk, A. M., ed., Oxford University Press, New York, 1988; Biocomputing: Informatics and Genome Projects, Smith, D. W., ed., Academic Press, New York, 1993; Computer Analysis of Sequence Data, Part 1, Griffin, A. M., and Griffin, H. G., eds., Humana Press, New Jersey, 1994; Sequence Analysis in Molecular Biology, von Heinje, G., Academic Press, 1987; and Sequence Analysis Primer, Gribskov, M. and Devereux, J., eds., M Stockton Press, New York, 1991). In a preferred embodiment, the percent identity between two amino acid sequences is determined using the Needleman and Wunsch (J. Mol. Biol. (48):444-453 (1970)) algorithm which has been incorporated into the GAP program in the GCG software package, using either a Blossom 62 matrix or a PAM250 matrix, and a gap weight of 16, 14, 12, 10, 8, 6, or 4 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6. In yet another preferred embodiment, the percent identity between two nucleotide sequences is determined using the GAP program in the GCG software package (Devereux, J., et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 12(1):387 (1984)), using a NWSgapdna.CMP matrix and a gap weight of 40, 50, 60, 70, or 80 and a length weight of 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, or 6. In another embodiment, the percent identity between two amino acid or nucleotide sequences is determined using the algorithm of E. Myers and W. Miller (CABIOS, 4:11-17 (1989)) which has been incorporated into the ALIGN program (version 2.0), using a PAM120 weight residue table, a gap length penalty of 12 and a gap penalty of 4.
  • The nucleic acid and protein sequences of the present invention can further be used as a “query sequence” to perform a search against sequence databases to, for example, identify other family members or related sequences. Such searches can be performed using the NBLAST and XBLAST programs (version 2.0) of Altschul, et al. (J. Mol. Biol. 215:403-10 (1990)). BLAST nucleotide searches can be performed with the NBLAST program, score=100, wordlength=12 to obtain nucleotide sequences homologous to the nucleic acid molecules of the invention. BLAST protein searches can be performed with the XBLAST program, score=50, wordlength=3 to obtain amino acid sequences homologous to the proteins of the invention. To obtain gapped alignments for comparison purposes, Gapped BLAST can be utilized as described in Altschul et al. (Nucleic Acids Res. 25(17):3389-3402 (1997)). When utilizing BLAST and gapped BLAST programs, the default parameters of the respective programs (e.g., XBLAST and NBLAST) can be used.
  • Full-length pre-processed forms, as well as mature processed forms, of proteins that comprise one of the peptides of the present invention can readily be identified as having complete sequence identity to one of the LCAT peptides of the present invention as well as being encoded by the same genetic locus as the LCAT peptide provided herein (See Table 2).
  • Allelic variants of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as being a human protein having a high degree (significant) of sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide as well as being encoded by the same genetic locus as the LCAT peptide provided herein. Genetic locus can readily be determined based on the genomic information provided in Table 2, such as the genomic sequence mapped to the reference human. As used herein, two proteins (or a region of the proteins) have significant homology when the amino acid sequences are typically at least about 70-80%, 80-90%, and more typically at least about 90-95% or more homologous. A significantly homologous amino acid sequence, according to the present invention, will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under stringent conditions as more fully described below.
  • Paralogs of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as having some degree of significant sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide, as being encoded by a gene from humans, and as having similar activity or function. Two proteins will typically be considered paralogs when the amino acid sequences are typically at least about 60% or greater, and more typically at least about 70% or greater homology through a given region or domain. Such paralogs will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under moderate to stringent conditions as more fully described below.
  • Orthologs of a LCAT peptide can readily be identified as having some degree of significant sequence homology/identity to at least a portion of the LCAT peptide as well as being encoded by a gene from another organism. Preferred orthologs will be isolated from mammals, preferably primates, for the development of human therapeutic targets and agents. Such orthologs will be encoded by a nucleic acid sequence that will hybridize to a LCAT peptide encoding nucleic acid molecule under moderate to stringent conditions, as more fully described below, depending on the degree of relatedness of the two organisms yielding the proteins.
  • Non-naturally occurring variants of the LCAT peptides of the present invention can readily be generated using recombinant techniques. Such variants include, but are not limited to deletions, additions and substitutions in the amino acid sequence of the LCAT peptide. For example, one class of substitutions is conserved amino acid substitution. Such substitutions are those that substitute a given amino acid in a LCAT peptide by another amino acid of like characteristics. Typically seen as conservative substitutions are the replacements, one for another, among the aliphatic amino acids Ala, Val, Leu, and Ile; interchange of the hydroxyl residues Ser and Thr; exchange of the acidic residues Asp and Glu; substitution between the amide residues Asn and Gln; exchange of the basic residues Lys and Arg; and replacements among the aromatic residues Phe and Tyr. Guidance concerning which amino acid changes are likely to be phenotypically silent are found in Bowie et al., Science 247:1306-1310 (1990).
  • Variant LCAT peptides can be fully functional or can lack function in one or more activities, e.g. ability to bind substrate, ability to phosphorylate substrate, ability to mediate signaling, etc. Fully functional variants typically contain only conservative variation or variation in non-critical residues or in non-critical regions.
  • Non-functional variants typically contain one or more non-conservative amino acid substitutions, deletions, insertions, inversions, or truncation or a substitution, insertion, inversion, or deletion in a critical residue or critical region.
  • Amino acids that are essential for function can be identified by methods known in the art, such as site-directed mutagenesis or alanine-scanning mutagenesis (Cunningham et al., Science 244:1081-1085 (1989)). The latter procedure introduces single alanine mutations at every residue in the molecule. The resulting mutant molecules are then tested for biological activity such as LCAT activity or in assays such as an in vitro proliferative activity. Sites that are critical for binding partner/substrate binding can also be determined by structural analysis such as crystallization, nuclear magnetic resonance or photoaffinity labeling (Smith et al., J. Mol. Biol. 224:899-904 (1992); de Vos et al. Science 255:306-312 (1992)).
  • The present invention further provides fragments of the LCATs, in addition to proteins and peptides that comprise and consist of such fragments, particularly those comprising the residues identified in Tables 1 and 2. As used herein, a fragment comprises at least 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 18, 20 or more contiguous amino acid residues from a LCAT. Such fragments can be chosen based on the ability to retain one or more of the biological activities of the LCAT or could be chosen for the ability to perform a function, e.g. bind a substrate or act as an immunogen. Particularly important fragments are biologically active fragments, peptides that are, for example, about 8 or more amino acids in length. Such fragments will typically comprise a domain or motif of the LCAT, e.g., active site, a transmembrane domain or a substrate-binding domain. Further, possible fragments include, but are not limited to, domain or motif containing fragments, soluble peptide fragments, and fragments containing immunogenic structures. Predicted domains and functional sites are readily identifiable by computer programs well known and readily available to those of skill in the art (e.g., PROSITE analysis).
  • Polypeptides often contain amino acids other than the 20 amino acids commonly referred to as the 20 naturally occurring amino acids. Further, many amino acids, including the terminal amino acids, may be modified by natural processes, such as processing and other post-translational modifications, or by chemical modification techniques well known in the art. Common modifications that occur naturally in LCATs are described in basic texts, detailed monographs, and the research literature, and they are well known to those of skill in the art.
  • Known modifications include, but are not limited to, acetylation, acylation, ADP-ribosylation, amidation, covalent attachment of flavin, covalent attachment of a heme moiety, covalent attachment of a nucleotide or nucleotide derivative, covalent attachment of a lipid or lipid derivative, covalent attachment of phosphotidylinositol, cross-linking, cyclization, disulfide bond formation, demethylation, formation of covalent crosslinks, formation of cystine, formation of pyroglutamate, formylation, gamma carboxylation, glycosylation, GPI anchor formation, hydroxylation, iodination, methylation, myristoylation, oxidation, proteolytic processing, phosphorylation, prenylation, racemization, selenoylation, sulfation, transfer-RNA mediated addition of amino acids to proteins such as arginylation, and ubiquitination.
  • Such modifications are well known to those of skill in the art and have been described in great detail in the scientific literature. Several particularly common modifications, glycosylation, lipid attachment, sulfation, gamma-carboxylation of glutamic acid residues, hydroxylation and ADP-ribosylation, for instance, are described in most basic texts, such as Proteins—Structure and Molecular Properties, 2nd Ed., T. E. Creighton, W. H. Freeman and Company, New York (1993). Many detailed reviews are available on this subject, such as by Wold, F., Posttranslational Covalent Modification of Proteins, B. C. Johnson, Ed., Academic Press, New York 1-12 (1983); Seifter et al. (Meth. Enzymol. 182: 626-646 (1990)) and Rattan et al. (Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sci. 663:48-62 (1992)).
  • Accordingly, the LCATs of the present invention also encompass derivatives or analogs in which a substituted amino acid residue is not one encoded by the genetic code, in which a substituent group is included, in which the mature LCAT is fused with another compound, such as a compound to increase the half-life of the LCAT (for example, polyethylene glycol), or in which the additional amino acids are fused to the mature LCAT, such as a leader or secretory sequence or a sequence for purification of the mature LCAT or a pro-protein sequence.
  • Protein/Peptide Uses
  • The proteins of the present invention can be used in substantial and specific assays related to the functional information provided in the Tables; to raise antibodies or to elicit another immune response; as a reagent (including the labeled reagent) in assays designed to quantitatively determine levels of the protein (or its binding partner or ligand) in biological fluids; and as markers for tissues in which the corresponding protein is preferentially expressed (either constitutively or at a particular stage of tissue differentiation or development or in a disease state). Where the protein binds or potentially binds to another protein or ligand (such as, for example, in a LCAT-effector protein interaction or LCAT-ligand interaction), the protein can be used to identify the binding partner/ligand so as to develop a system to identify inhibitors of the binding interaction. Any or all of these uses are capable of being developed into reagent grade or kit format for commercialization as commercial products.
  • Methods for performing the uses listed above are well known to those skilled in the art. References disclosing such methods include “Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual”, Sambrook, J., E. F. Fritsch and T. Maniatis eds., 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001), and “Methods in Enzymology: Guide to Molecular Cloning Techniques”, Academic Press, Berger, S. L. and A. R. Kimmel eds., 1987.
  • The potential uses of the peptides of the present invention are based primarily on the source of the protein as well as the class/action of the protein. For example, LCATs isolated from humans and their human/mammalian orthologs serve as targets for identifying agents for use in mammalian therapeutic applications, e.g. a human drug, particularly in modulating a biological or pathological response in a cell or tissue that expresses the LCAT. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • A large percentage of pharmaceutical agents are being developed that modulate the activity of LCAT proteins, particularly members of the LCAT subfamily (see Background of the Invention). The structural and functional information provided in the Background and Tables provide specific and substantial uses for the molecules of the present invention, particularly in combination with the expression information provided in Table 1. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. Such uses can readily be determined using the information provided herein, that which is known in the art, and routine experimentation. The proteins of the present invention (including variants and fragments that may have been disclosed prior to the present invention) are useful for biological assays related to LCATs that are related to members of the LCAT subfamily. Such assays involve any of the known LCAT functions or activities or properties useful for diagnosis and treatment of LCAT-related conditions that are specific for the subfamily of LCATs that the one of the present invention belongs to, particularly in cells and tissues that express the LCAT. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • The proteins of the present invention are also useful in drug screening assays, in cell-based or cell-free systems. Cell-based systems can be native, i.e., cells that normally express the LCAT, as a biopsy or expanded in cell culture. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. In an alternate embodiment, cell-based assays involve recombinant host cells expressing the LCAT protein.
  • The polypeptides can be used to identify compounds or agents that modulate LCAT activity of the protein in its natural state or an altered form that causes a specific disease or pathology associated with the LCAT. Both the LCATs of the present invention and appropriate variants and fragments can be used in high-throughput screens to assay candidate compounds for the ability to bind to the LCAT. These compounds can be further screened against a functional LCAT to determine the effect of the compound on the LCAT activity. Further, these compounds can be tested in animal or invertebrate systems to determine activity/effectiveness. Compounds can be identified that activate (agonist) or inactivate (antagonist) the LCAT to a desired degree.
  • Further, the proteins of the present invention can be used to screen a compound or an agent for the ability to stimulate or inhibit interaction between the LCAT protein and a molecule that normally interacts with the LCAT protein, e.g. a substrate or or an extracellular binding ligand or a component of the signal pathway that the LCAT protein normally interacts (for example, a cytosolic signal protein or another LCAT). Such assays typically include the steps of combining the LCAT protein with a candidate compound under conditions that allow the LCAT protein, or fragment, to interact with the target molecule, and to detect the formation of a complex between the protein and the target or to detect the biochemical consequence of the interaction with the LCAT protein and the target, such as any of the associated effects of signal transduction such as protein phosphorylation, cAMP turnover, and adenylate cyclase activation, etc.
  • Candidate compounds or agents include, for example, 1) peptides such as soluble peptides, including Ig-tailed fusion peptides and members of random peptide libraries (see, e.g., Lam et al., Nature 354:82-84 (1991); Houghten et al., Nature 354:84-86 (1991)) and combinatorial chemistry-derived molecular libraries made of D- and/or L-configuration amino acids; 2) phosphopeptides (e.g., members of random and partially degenerate, directed phosphopeptide libraries, see, e.g., Songyang et al., Cell 72:767-778 (1993)); 3) antibodies (e.g., polyclonal, monoclonal, humanized, anti-idiotypic, chimeric, and single chain antibodies as well as Fab, F(ab′)2, Fab expression library fragments, and epitope-binding fragments of antibodies); and 4) small organic and inorganic molecules (e.g., molecules obtained from combinatorial and natural product libraries).
  • One candidate compound or agent is a soluble fragment of the LCAT that competes for substrate binding. Other candidate compounds include mutant LCATs or appropriate fragments containing mutations that affect LCAT function and thus compete for substrate. Accordingly, a fragment that competes for substrate, for example with a higher affinity, or a fragment that binds substrate but does not allow release, is encompassed by the invention.
  • The invention further includes other end point assays to identify compounds that modulate (stimulate or inhibit) LCAT activity. The assays typically involve an assay of events in the signal transduction pathway that indicate LCAT activity. Thus, the phosphorylation of a substrate, activation of a protein, a change in the expression of genes that are up- or down-regulated in response to the LCAT protein dependent signal cascade can be assayed. Any of the biological or biochemical functions mediated by the LCAT can be used as an endpoint assay. These include all of the biochemical or biochemical/biological events described herein, in the references cited herein, incorporated by reference for these endpoint assay targets, and other functions known to those of ordinary skill in the art or that can be readily identified using the information provided in the Tables, particularly Table 1. Specifically, a biological function of a cell or tissues that expresses the LCAT can be assayed. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154.
  • Binding and/or activating compounds can also be screened by using chimeric LCAT proteins in which the amino terminal extracellular domain, or parts thereof, the entire transmembrane domain or subregions, such as any of the seven transmembrane segments or any of the intracellular or extracellular loops and the carboxy terminal intracellular domain, or parts thereof, can be replaced by heterologous domains or subregions. For example, a substrate-binding region can be used that interacts with a different substrate then that which is recognized by the native LCAT. Accordingly, a different set of signal transduction components is available as an end-point assay for activation. This allows for assays to be performed in other than the specific host cell from which the LCAT is derived.
  • The proteins of the present invention are also useful in competition binding assays in methods designed to discover compounds that interact with the LCAT (e.g. binding partners and/or ligands). Thus, a compound is exposed to a LCAT polypeptide under conditions that allow the compound to bind or to otherwise interact with the polypeptide. Soluble LCAT polypeptide is also added to the mixture. If the test compound interacts with the soluble LCAT polypeptide, it decreases the amount of complex formed or activity from the LCAT. This type of assay is particularly useful in cases in which compounds are sought that interact with specific regions of the LCAT. Thus, the soluble polypeptide that competes with the target LCAT region is designed to contain peptide sequences corresponding to the region of interest.
  • To perform cell free drug screening assays, it is sometimes desirable to immobilize either the LCAT protein, or fragment, or its target molecule to facilitate separation of complexes from uncomplexed forms of one or both of the proteins, as well as to accommodate automation of the assay.
  • Techniques for immobilizing proteins on matrices can be used in the drug screening assays. In one embodiment, a fusion protein can be provided which adds a domain that allows the protein to be bound to a matrix. For example, glutathione-S-transferase fusion proteins can be adsorbed onto glutathione sepharose beads (Sigma Chemical, St. Louis, Mo.) or glutathione derivatized microtitre plates, which are then combined with the cell lysates (e.g., 35S-labeled) and the candidate compound, and the mixture incubated under conditions conducive to complex formation (e.g., at physiological conditions for salt and pH). Following incubation, the beads are washed to remove any unbound label, and the matrix immobilized and radiolabel determined directly, or in the supernatant after the complexes are dissociated. Alternatively, the complexes can be dissociated from the matrix, separated by SDS-PAGE, and the level of LCAT-binding protein found in the bead fraction quantitated from the gel using standard electrophoretic techniques. For example, either the polypeptide or its target molecule can be immobilized utilizing conjugation of biotin and streptavidin using techniques well known in the art. Alternatively, antibodies reactive with the protein but which do not interfere with binding of the protein to its target molecule can be derivatized to the wells of the plate, and the protein trapped in the wells by antibody conjugation. Preparations of a LCAT-binding protein and a candidate compound are incubated in the LCAT protein-presenting wells and the amount of complex trapped in the well can be quantitated. Methods for detecting such complexes, in addition to those described above for the GST-immobilized complexes, include immunodetection of complexes using antibodies reactive with the LCAT protein target molecule, or which are reactive with LCAT protein and compete with the target molecule, as well as LCAT-linked assays which rely on detecting an enzymatic activity associated with the target molecule.
  • Agents that modulate one of the LCATs of the present invention can be identified using one or more of the above assays, alone or in combination. It is generally preferable to use a cell-based or cell free system first and then confirm activity in an animal or other model system. Such model systems are well known in the art and can readily be employed in this context.
  • Modulators of LCAT protein activity identified according to these drug screening assays can be used to treat a subject with a disorder mediated by the LCAT pathway, by treating cells or tissues that express the LCAT. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. These methods of treatment include the steps of administering a modulator of LCAT activity in a pharmaceutical composition to a subject in need of such treatment, the modulator being identified as described herein.
  • In yet another aspect of the invention, the LCAT proteins can be used as “bait proteins” in a two-hybrid assay or three-hybrid assay (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,283,317; Zervos et al. (1993) Cell 72:223-232; Madura et al. (1993) J. Biol. Chem. 268:12046-12054; Bartel et al. (1993) Biotechniques 14:920-924; Iwabuchi et al. (1993) Oncogene 8:1693-1696; and Brent WO94/10300), to identify other proteins, which bind to or interact with the LCAT and are involved in LCAT activity. Such LCAT-binding proteins are also likely to be involved in the propagation of signals by the LCAT proteins or LCAT targets as, for example, downstream elements of a LCAT-mediated signaling pathway. Alternatively, such LCAT-binding proteins are likely to be LCAT inhibitors.
  • The two-hybrid system is based on the modular nature of most transcription factors, which consist of separable DNA-binding and activation domains. Briefly, the assay utilizes two different DNA constructs. In one construct, the gene that codes for a LCAT protein is fused to a gene encoding the DNA binding domain of a known transcription factor (e.g., GAL-4). In the other construct, a DNA sequence, from a library of DNA sequences that encode an unidentified protein (“prey” or “sample”) is fused to a gene that codes for the activation domain of the known transcription factor. If the “bait” and the “prey” proteins are able to interact, in vivo, forming a LCAT-dependent complex, the DNA-binding and activation domains of the transcription factor are brought into close proximity. This proximity allows transcription of a reporter gene (e.g., LacZ) which is operably linked to a transcriptional regulatory site responsive to the transcription factor. Expression of the reporter gene can be detected and cell colonies containing the functional transcription factor can be isolated and used to obtain the cloned gene which encodes the protein which interacts with the LCAT protein.
  • This invention further pertains to novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays. Accordingly, it is within the scope of this invention to further use an agent identified as described herein in an appropriate animal model. For example, an agent identified as described herein (e.g., a LCAT-modulating agent, an antisense LCAT nucleic acid molecule, an LCAT-RNAi fragment, a LCAT-specific antibody, or a LCAT-binding partner) can be used in an animal or other model to determine the efficacy, toxicity, or side effects of treatment with such an agent. Alternatively, an agent identified as described herein can be used in an animal or other model to determine the mechanism of action of such an agent. Furthermore, this invention pertains to uses of novel agents identified by the above-described screening assays for treatments as described herein.
  • The LCAT proteins of the present invention are also useful to provide a target for diagnosing a disease or predisposition to disease mediated by the peptide. Accordingly, the invention provides methods for detecting the presence, or levels of, the protein (or encoding mRNA) in a cell, tissue, or organism. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. The method involves contacting a biological sample with a compound capable of interacting with the LCAT protein such that the interaction can be detected. Such an assay can be provided in a single detection format or a multi-detection format such as an antibody chip array.
  • One agent for detecting a protein in a sample is an antibody capable of selectively binding to protein. A biological sample includes tissues, cells and biological fluids isolated from a subject, as well as tissues, cells and fluids present within a subject.
  • The peptides of the present invention also provide targets for diagnosing active protein activity, disease, or predisposition to disease, in a patient having a variant peptide, particularly activities and conditions that are known for other members of the family of proteins to which the present one belongs. Thus, the peptide can be isolated from a biological sample and assayed for the presence of a genetic mutation that results in aberrant peptide. This includes amino acid substitution, deletion, insertion, rearrangement, (as the result of aberrant splicing events), and inappropriate post-translational modification. Analytic methods include altered electrophoretic mobility, altered tryptic peptide digest, altered LCAT activity in cell-based or cell-free assay, alteration in substrate or antibody-binding pattern, altered isoelectric point, direct amino acid sequencing, and any other of the known assay techniques useful for detecting mutations in a protein. Such an assay can be provided in a single detection format or a multi-detection format such as an antibody chip array.
  • In vitro techniques for detection of peptide include enzyme linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), Western blots, immunoprecipitations and immunofluorescence using a detection reagent, such as an antibody or protein binding agent. Alternatively, the peptide can be detected in vivo in a subject by introducing into the subject a labeled anti-peptide antibody or other types of detection agent. For example, the antibody can be labeled with a radioactive marker whose presence and location in a subject can be detected by standard imaging techniques. Particularly useful are methods that detect the allelic variant of a peptide expressed in a subject and methods which detect fragments of a peptide in a sample.
  • The peptides are also useful in pharmacogenomic analysis. Pharmacogenomics deal with clinically significant hereditary variations in the response to drugs due to altered drug disposition and abnormal action in affected persons. See, e.g., Eichelbaum, M. (Clin. Exp. Pharmacol. Physiol. 23(10-11):983-985 (1996)), and Linder, M. W. (Clin. Chem. 43(2):254-266 (1997)). The clinical outcomes of these variations result in severe toxicity of therapeutic drugs in certain individuals or therapeutic failure of drugs in certain individuals as a result of individual variation in metabolism. Thus, the genotype of the individual can determine the way a therapeutic compound acts on the body or the way the body metabolizes the compound. Further, the activity of drug metabolizing enzymes affects both the intensity and duration of drug action. Thus, the pharmacogenomics of the individual permit the selection of effective compounds and effective dosages of such compounds for prophylactic or therapeutic treatment based on the individual's genotype. The discovery of genetic polymorphisms in some drug metabolizing enzymes has explained why some patients do not obtain the expected drug effects, show an exaggerated drug effect, or experience serious toxicity from standard drug dosages. Polymorphisms can be expressed in the phenotype of the extensive metabolizer and the phenotype of the poor metabolizer. Accordingly, genetic polymorphism may lead to allelic protein variants of the LCAT protein in which one or more of the LCAT functions in one population are different from those in another population. The peptides thus allow a target to ascertain a genetic predisposition that can affect treatment modality. Thus, in a ligand-based treatment, polymorphism may give rise to amino terminal extracellular domains and/or other substrate-binding regions that are more or less active in substrate binding, and LCAT activation. Accordingly, substrate dosage would necessarily be modified to maximize the therapeutic effect within a given population containing a polymorphism. As an alternative to genotyping, specific polymorphic peptides could be identified.
  • The peptides are also useful for treating a disorder characterized by an absence of, inappropriate, or unwanted expression of the protein. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. Accordingly, methods for treatment include the use of the LCAT protein or fragments.
  • Antibodies
  • The present invention provides antibodies specifically bind to LCAT proteins or fragments thereof, peptides, or antigenic portion thereof.
  • The invention also provides antibodies that selectively bind to one of the peptides of the present invention, a protein comprising such a peptide, as well as variants and fragments thereof as describe above.
  • The antibody of present invention selectively binds a target LCAT when it binds the target domain and does not significantly bind to unrelated proteins. An antibody is still considered to selectively bind a peptide even if it also binds to other proteins that are not substantially homologous with the target peptide so long as such proteins share homology with a fragment or domain of the peptide target of the antibody. In this case, it would be understood that antibody binding to the peptide is still selective despite some degree of cross-reactivity.
  • The term “antibody” is used in the broadest sense, and specifically covers monoclonal antibodies (including full length monoclonal antibodies), polyclonal antibodies, multispecific antibodies (e.g., bispecific antibodies), humanized antibody and antibody fragments (e.g., Fab, F(ab′).sub.2 and Fv) so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity. Antibodies (Abs) and immunoglobulins (Igs) are glycoproteins having the same structural characteristics. While antibodies exhibit binding specificity to a specific antigen, immunoglobulins include both antibodies and other antibody-like molecules that lack antigen specificity.
  • As used herein, antibodies are usually heterotetrameric glycoproteins of about 150,000 daltons, composed of two identical light (L) chains and two identical heavy (H) chains. Each light chain is linked to a heavy chain by one covalent disulfide bond, while the number of disulfide linkages varies between the heavy chains of different immunoglobulin isotypes. Each heavy and light chain also has regularly spaced intrachain disulfide bridges. Each heavy chain has at one end a variable domain (VH) followed by a number of constant domains. Each light chain has a variable domain at one end (VL) and a constant domain at its other end. The constant domain of the light chain is aligned with the first constant domain of the heavy chain, and the light chain variable domain is aligned with the variable domain of the heavy chain. Particular amino acid residues are believed to form an interface between the light and heavy chain variable domains. Chothia et al., J. Mol. Biol. 186, 651-63 (1985); Novotny and Haber, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 82 4592-4596 (1985).
  • An “isolated” antibody is one which has been identified and separated and/or recovered from a component of the environment in which is produced. Contaminant components of its production environment are materials that would interfere with diagnostic or therapeutic uses for the antibody, and may include enzymes, hormones, and other proteinaceous or nonproteinaceous solutes. In preferred embodiments, the antibody will be purified as measurable by at least three different methods: 1) to greater than 95% by weight of antibody as determined by the Lowry method, and most preferably more than 99% by weight; 2) to a degree sufficient to obtain at least 15 residues of N-terminal or internal amino acid sequence by use of a spinning cup sequentator; or 3) to homogeneity by SDS-PAGE under reducing or non-reducing conditions using Coomasie blue or, preferably, silver stain. Isolated antibody includes the antibody in situ within recombinant cells since at least one component of the antibody's natural environment will not be present. Ordinarily, however, isolated antibody will be prepared by at least one purification step.
  • An “antigenic region” or “antigenic determinant” or an “epitope” includes any protein determinant capable of specific binding to an antibody. This is the site on an antigen to which each distinct antibody molecule binds. Epitopic determinants usually consist of active surface groupings of molecules such as amino acids or sugar side chains and usually have specific three-dimensional structural characteristics, as well as charge characteristics.
  • “Antibody specificity,” is an antibody, which has a stronger binding affinity for an antigen from a first subject species than it has for a homologue of that antigen from a second subject species. Normally, the antibody “bind specifically” to a human antigen (i.e., has a binding affinity (Kd) value of no more than about 1×10−7 M, preferably no more than about 1×10−8 and most preferably no more than about 1×10−9 M) but has a binding affinity for a homologue of the antigen from a second subject species which is at least about 50 fold, or at least about 500 fold, or at least about 1000 fold, weaker than its binding affinity for the human antigen. The antibody can be of any of the various types of antibodies as defined above, but preferably is a humanized or human antibody (Queen et al., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,530,101, 5,585,089; 5,693,762; and 6,180,370).
  • The present invention provides an “antibody variant,” which refers to an amino acid sequence variant of an antibody wherein one or more of the amino acid residues have been modified. Such variant necessarily have less than 100% sequence identity or similarity with the amino acid sequence having at least 75% amino acid sequence identity or similarity with the amino acid sequence of either the heavy or light chain variable domain of the antibody, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 85%, more preferably at least 90%, and most preferably at least 95%. Since the method of the invention applies equally to both polypeptides, antibodies and fragments thereof, these terms are sometimes employed interchangeably.
  • The term “variable” in the context of variable domain of antibodies refers to the fact that certain portions of the variable domains differ extensively in sequence among antibodies and are used in the binding and specificity of each particular antibody for its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed through the variable domains of antibodies. It is concentrated in three segments called complementarity determining regions (CDRs) also known as hypervariable regions both in the light chain and the heavy chain variable domains. There are at least two techniques for determining CDRs: (1) an approach based on cross-species sequence variability (i.e., Kabat et al., Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest (National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md. 1987); and (2) an approach based on crystallographic studies of antigen-antibody complexes (Chothia, C. et al. (1989), Nature 342: 877). The more highly conserved portions of variable domains are called the framework (FR). The variable domains of native heavy and light chains each comprise four FR regions, largely adopting a .beta.-Sheet configuration, connected by three CDRs, which form loops connecting, and in some cases forming part of, the .beta.-sheet structure. The CDRs in each chain are held together in close proximity by the FR regions and, with the CDRs from the other chain, contribute to the formation of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (see Kabat et al.) The constant domains are not involved directly in binding an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various effector functions, such as participation of the antibody in antibody-dependent cellular toxicity.
  • The term “antibody fragment” refers to a portion of a full-length antibody, generally the antigen binding or variable region. Examples of antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′)2 and Fv fragments. Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen binding fragments, called the Fab fragment, each with a single antigen binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, so-called for its ability to crystallize readily. Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′)2 fragment that has two antigen binding fragments which are capable of crosslinking antigen, and a residual other fragment (which is termed pFc′). Additional fragments can include diabodies, linear antibodies, single-chain antibody molecules, and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments. As used herein, “functional fragment” with respect to antibodies, refers to Fv, F(ab) and F(ab′)2 fragments.
  • An “Fv” fragment is the minimum antibody fragment that contains a complete antigen recognition and binding site. This region consists of a dimer of one heavy and one light chain variable domain in a tight, non-covalent association (VH-VL dimer). It is in this configuration that the three CDRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the VH-VL dimer. Collectively, the six CDRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three CDRs specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
  • The Fab fragment [also designated as F(ab)] also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain. Fab′ fragments differ from Fab fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxyl terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region. Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains have a free thiol group. F(ab′) fragments are produced by cleavage of the disulfide bond at the hinge cysteines of the F(ab′)2 pepsin digestion product. Additional chemical couplings of antibody fragments are known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • The present invention further provides monoclonal antibody, polyclonal antibody as well as humanized antibody. In general, to generate antibodies, an isolated peptide is used as an immunogen and is administered to a mammalian organism, such as a rat, rabbit or mouse. The full-length protein, an antigenic peptide fragment or a fusion protein of the LCAT protein can be used. Particularly important fragments are those covering functional domains, some but not all the examples of the domains are identified in Tables. Many methods are known for generating and/or identifying antibodies to a given target peptide. Several such methods are described by Harlow, Antibodies, Cold Spring Harbor Press, (1989).
  • The term “monoclonal antibody” as used herein refers to an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, i.e., the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible naturally occurring mutations that may be present in minor amounts. Monoclonal antibodies are highly specific, being directed against a single antigenic site. Furthermore, in contrast to conventional (polyclonal) antibody preparations which typically include different antibodies directed against different determinants (epitopes), each monoclonal antibody is directed against a single determinant on the antigen. In additional to their specificity, the monoclonal antibodies are advantageous in that they are synthesized by the hybridoma culture, uncontaminated by other immunoglobulins. The modifier “monoclonal” antibody indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method. For example, the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the present invention may be made by the hybridoma method first described by Kohler and Milstein, Nature 256, 495 (1975), or may be made by recombinant methods, e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567. The monoclonal antibodies for use with the present invention may also be isolated from phage antibody libraries using the techniques described in Clackson et al. Nature 352: 624-628 (1991), as well as in Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol. 222: 581-597 (1991). For detailed procedure for making a monoclonal antibody, see the Example below.
  • “Humanized” forms of non-human (e.g. murine or rabbit) antibodies are chimeric immunoglobulins, immunoglobulin chains or fragments thereof (such as Fv, Fab, Fab′, F(ab′).sub.2 or other antigen-binding subsequences of antibodies) which contain minimal sequence derived from non-human immunoglobulin. For the most part, humanized antibodies are human immunoglobulins (recipient antibody) in which residues from a complementary determining region (CDR) of the recipient are replaced by residues from a CDR of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat or rabbit having the desired specificity, affinity and capacity. In some instances, Fv framework residues of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues. Furthermore, humanized antibody may comprise residues, which are found neither in the recipient antibody nor in the imported CDR or framework sequences. These modifications are made to further refine and optimize antibody performance. In general, the humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the CDR regions correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin and all or substantially all of the FR regions are those of a human immunoglobulin consensus sequence. The humanized antibody optimally also will comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin. For further details, see: Jones et al., Nature 321, 522-525 (1986); Reichmann et al., Nature 332, 323-327 (1988) and Presta, Curr. Op. Struct. Biol. 2, 593-596 (1992).
  • Polyclonal antibodies may be prepared by any known method or modifications of these methods including obtaining antibodies from patients. For example, a complex of an immunogen such as LCAT protein, peptides or fragments thereof and a carrier protein is prepared and an animal is immunized by the complex according to the same manner as that described with respect to the above monoclonal antibody preparation and the description in the Example. A serum or plasma containing the antibody against the protein is recovered from the immunized animal and the antibody is separated and purified. The gamma globulin fraction or the IgG antibodies can be obtained, for example, by use of saturated ammonium sulfate or DEAE Sephadex, or other techniques known to those skilled in the art.
  • The antibody titer in the antiserum can be measured according to the same manner as that described above with respect to the supernatant of the hybridoma culture. Separation and purification of the antibody can be carried out according to the same separation and purification method of antibody as that described with respect to the above monoclonal antibody and in the Example.
  • The protein used here in as the immunogen is not limited to any particular type of immunogen. In one aspect, antibodies are preferably prepared from regions or discrete fragments of the LCAT proteins. Antibodies can be prepared from any region of the peptide as described herein. In particular, they are selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and fragments of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. An antigenic fragment will typically comprise at least 8 contiguous amino acid residues. The antigenic peptide can comprise, however, at least 10, 12, 14, 16 or more amino acid residues. Such fragments can be selected on a physical property, such as fragments correspond to regions that are located on the surface of the protein, e.g., hydrophilic regions or can be selected based on sequence uniqueness.
  • Antibodies may also be produced by inducing production in the lymphocyte population or by screening antibody libraries or panels of highly specific binding reagents as disclosed in Orlandi et al. (1989; Proc Natl Acad Sci 86:3833-3837) or Winter et al. (1991; Nature 349:293-299). A protein may be used in screening assays of phagemid or B-lymphocyte immunoglobulin libraries to identify antibodies having a desired specificity. Numerous protocols for competitive binding or immunoassays using either polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies with established specificities are well known in the art. Smith G. P., 1991, Curr. Opin. Biotechnol. 2: 668-673.
  • The antibodies of the present invention can also be generated using various phage display methods known in the art. In phage display methods, functional antibody domains are displayed on the surface of phage particles which carry the polynucleotide sequences encoding them. In a particular, such phage can be utilized to display antigen-binding domains expressed from a repertoire or combinatorial antibody library (e.g., human or murine). Phage expressing an antigen binding domain that binds the antigen of interest can be selected or identified with antigen, e.g., using labeled antigen or antigen bound or captured to a solid surface or bead. Phage used in these methods are typically filamentous phage including fd and M13 binding domains expressed from phage with Fab, Fv or disulfide stabilized Fv antibody domains recombinantly fused to either the phage gene III or gene VIII protein. Examples of phage display methods that can be used to make the antibodies of the present invention include those disclosed in Brinkman et al., J. Immunol. Methods 182:41-50 (1995); Ames et al., J. Immunol. Methods 184:177-186 (1995); Kettleborough et al., Eur. J. Immunol. 24:952-958 (1994); Persic et al., Gene 187 9-18 (1997); Burton et al., Advances in Immunology 57:191-280 (1994); PCT application No. PCT/GB91/01134; PCT publications WO 90/02809; WO 91/10737; WO 92/01047; WO 92/18619; WO 93/11236; WO 95/15982; WO 95/20401; and U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,698,426; 5,223,409; 5,403,484; 5,580,717; 5,427,908; 5,750,753; 5,821,047; 5,571,698; 5,427,908; 5,516,637; 5,780,225; 5,658,727; 5,733,743 and 5,969,108; each of which is incorporated herein by reference in its entirety.
  • Antibody can be also made recombinantly. When using recombinant techniques, the antibody variant can be produced intracellularly, in the periplasmic space, or directly secreted into the medium. If the antibody variant is produced intracellularly, as a first step, the particulate debris, either host cells or lysed fragments, is removed, for example, by centrifugation or ultrafiltration. Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10: 163-167 (1992) describe a procedure for isolating antibodies which are secreted to the periplasmic space of E. coli. Briefly, cell paste is thawed in the presence of sodium acetate (pH 3.5), EDTA, and phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride (PMSF) over about 30 minutes. Cell debris can be removed by centrifugation. Where the antibody variant is secreted into the medium, supernatants from such expression systems are generally first concentrated using a commercially available protein concentration filter, for example, an Amicon or Millipore Pellicon ultrafiltration unit. A protease inhibitor such as PMSF may be included in any of the foregoing steps to inhibit proteolysis and antibiotics may be included to prevent the growth of adventitious contaminants.
  • The antibodies or antigen binding fragments may also be produced by genetic engineering. The technology for expression of both heavy and light cain genes in E. coli is the subject the following PCT patent applications; publication number WO 901443, WO901443, and WO 9014424 and in Huse et al., 1989 Science 246:1275-1281. The general recombinant methods are well known in the art.
  • The antibody composition prepared from the cells can be purified using, for example, hydroxylapatite chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, and affinity chromatography, with affinity chromatography being the preferred purification technique. The suitability of protein A as an affinity ligand depends on the species and isotype of any immunoglobulin Fc domain that is present in the antibody. Protein A can be used to purify antibodies that are based on human .delta.1, .delta.2 or .delta.4 heavy chains (Lindmark et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 62: 1-13 (1983)). Protein G is recommended for all mouse isotypes and for human .delta.3 (Guss et al., EMBO J. 5: 1567-1575 (1986)). The matrix to which the affinity ligand is attached is most often agarose, but other matrices are available. Mechanically stable matrices such as controlled pore glass or poly(styrenedivinyl)benzene allow for faster flow rates and shorter processing times than can be achieved with agarose. Where the antibody comprises a CH3 domain, the Bakerbond ABXTM resin (J. T. Baker, Phillipsburg, N.J.) is useful for purification. Other techniques for protein purification such as fractionation on an ion-exchange column, ethanol precipitation, Reverse Phase HPLC, chromatography on silica, chromatography on heparin SEPHAROSE™ chromatography on an anion or cation exchange resin (such as a polyaspartic acid column), chromatofocusing, SDS-PAGE, and ammonium sulfate precipitation are also available depending on the antibody to be recovered.
  • Following any preliminary purification step(s), the mixture comprising the antibody of interest and contaminants may be subjected to low pH hydrophobic interaction chromatography using an elution buffer at a pH between about 2.5-4.5, preferably performed at low salt concentrations (e.g., from about 0-0.25M salt).
  • Antibody Uses
  • The antibodies can be used to isolate one of the proteins of the present invention by standard techniques, such as affinity chromatography or immunoprecipitation. The antibodies can facilitate the purification of the natural protein from cells and recombinantly produced protein expressed in host cells. In addition, such antibodies are useful to detect the presence of one of the proteins of the present invention in cells or tissues to determine the pattern of expression of the protein among various tissues in an organism and over the course of normal development. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. Further, such antibodies can be used to detect protein in situ, in vitro, or in a cell lysate or supernatant in order to evaluate the abundance and pattern of expression. Also, such antibodies can be used to assess abnormal tissue distribution or abnormal expression during development or progression of a biological condition. Antibody detection of circulating fragments of the full length protein can be used to identify turnover.
  • Further, the antibodies can be used to assess expression in disease states such as in active stages of the disease or in an individual with a predisposition toward disease related to the protein's function. When a disorder is caused by an inappropriate tissue distribution, developmental expression, level of expression of the protein, or expressed/processed form, the antibody can be prepared against the normal protein. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. If a disorder is characterized by a specific mutation in the protein, antibodies specific for this mutant protein can be used to assay for the presence of the specific mutant protein.
  • The antibodies can also be used to assess normal and aberrant subcellular localization of cells in the various tissues in an organism. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. The diagnostic uses can be applied, not only in genetic testing, but also in monitoring a treatment modality. Accordingly, where treatment is ultimately aimed at correcting expression level or the presence of aberrant sequence and aberrant tissue distribution or developmental expression, antibodies directed against the protein or relevant fragments can be used to monitor therapeutic efficacy. More detection and diagnosis methods are described in detail below.
  • Additionally, antibodies are useful in pharmacogenomic analysis. Thus, antibodies prepared against polymorphic proteins can be used to identify individuals that require modified treatment modalities. The antibodies are also useful as diagnostic tools as an immunological marker for aberrant protein analyzed by electrophoretic mobility, isoelectric point, tryptic peptide digest, and other physical assays known to those in the art.
  • The antibodies are also useful for tissue typing. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. Thus, where a specific protein has been correlated with expression in a specific tissue, antibodies that are specific for this protein can be used to identify a tissue type.
  • The antibodies are also useful for inhibiting protein function, for example, blocking the binding of the LCAT peptide to a binding partner such as a substrate. These uses can also be applied in a therapeutic context in which treatment involves inhibiting the protein's function. An antibody can be used, for example, to block binding, thus modulating (agonizing or antagonizing) the peptides activity. Antibodies can be prepared against specific fragments containing sites required for function or against intact protein that is associated with a cell or cell membrane. More therapeutics methods are described in detail below.
  • The invention also encompasses kits for using antibodies to detect the presence of a protein in a biological sample. The kit can comprise antibodies such as a labeled or labelable antibody and a compound or agent for detecting protein in a biological sample; means for determining the amount of protein in the sample; means for comparing the amount of protein in the sample with a standard; and instructions for use. Such a kit can be supplied to detect a single protein or epitope or can be configured to detect one of a multitude of epitopes, such as in an antibody detection array. Arrays are described in detail below for nucleic acid arrays and similar methods have been developed for antibody arrays.
  • Nucleic Acid Molecules
  • The present invention further provides isolated nucleic acid molecules that encode a LCAT peptide or protein of the present invention. Such nucleic acid molecules will consist of, consist essentially of, or comprise a nucleotide sequence that encodes one of the LCAT peptides of the present invention, an allelic variant thereof, or an ortholog or paralog thereof. The nucleic acid molecules and the fragments thereof of the present invention pertains, however, are not to be construed as encompassing fragments that may be disclosed publicly prior to the present invention.
  • As used herein, an “isolated” nucleic acid molecule is one that is separated from other nucleic acid present in the natural source of the nucleic acid. Preferably, an “isolated” nucleic acid is free of sequences which naturally flank the nucleic acid (i.e., sequences located at the 5′ and 3′ ends of the nucleic acid) in the genomic DNA of the organism from which the nucleic acid is derived. However, there can be some flanking nucleotide sequences, for example up to about 5 KB, 4 KB, 3 KB, 2 KB, or 1 KB or less, particularly contiguous peptide encoding sequences and peptide encoding sequences within the same gene but separated by introns in the genomic sequence. The important point is that the nucleic acid is isolated from remote and unimportant flanking sequences such that it can be subjected to the specific manipulations described herein such as recombinant expression, preparation of probes and primers, and other uses specific to the nucleic acid sequences.
  • Moreover, an “isolated” nucleic acid molecule, such as a transcript/cDNA molecule, can be substantially free of other cellular material, or culture medium when produced by recombinant techniques, or chemical precursors or other chemicals when chemically synthesized. However, the nucleic acid molecule can be fused to other coding or regulatory sequences and still be considered isolated.
  • For example, recombinant DNA molecules contained in a vector are considered isolated. Further examples of isolated DNA molecules include recombinant DNA molecules maintained in heterologous host cells or purified (partially or substantially) DNA molecules in solution. Isolated RNA molecules include in vivo or in vitro RNA transcripts of the isolated DNA molecules of the present invention. Isolated nucleic acid molecules according to the present invention further include such molecules produced synthetically.
  • The present invention further provides nucleic acid molecules that comprise the nucleotide sequences shown in Table 2, (SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120), or any nucleic acid molecule that encodes the protein provided in Table 2, (SEQ ID NOS:1-1154). A nucleic acid molecule comprises a nucleotide sequence when the nucleotide sequence is at least part of the final nucleotide sequence of the nucleic acid molecule. In such a fashion, the nucleic acid molecule can be only the nucleotide sequence or have additional nucleic acid residues, such as nucleic acid residues that are naturally associated with it or heterologous nucleotide sequences. Such a nucleic acid molecule can have a few additional nucleotides or can comprise several hundred or more additional nucleotides. A brief description of how various types of these nucleic acid molecules can be readily made/isolated is provided below.
  • In Table 2, human transcript sequences are provided. As discussed below, some of the non-coding regions, particularly gene regulatory elements such as promoters, are useful for a variety of purposes, e.g. control of heterologous gene expression, target for identifying gene activity modulating compounds, and are particularly claimed as fragments of the genomic sequence provided herein.
  • The isolated nucleic acid molecules can encode the mature protein plus additional amino or carboxyl-terminal amino acids, or amino acids interior to the mature peptide (when the mature form has more than one peptide chain, for instance). Such sequences may play a role in processing of a protein from precursor to a mature form, facilitate protein trafficking, prolong or shorten protein half-life or facilitate manipulation of a protein for assay or production, among other things. As generally is the case in situ, the additional amino acids may be processed away from the mature protein by cellular enzymes.
  • As mentioned above, the isolated nucleic acid molecules include, but are not limited to, the sequence encoding the LCAT peptide alone, the sequence encoding the mature peptide and additional coding sequences, such as a leader or secretory sequence (e.g., a pre-pro or pro-protein sequence), the sequence encoding the mature peptide, with or without the additional coding sequences, plus additional non-coding sequences, for example introns and non-coding 5′ and 3′ sequences such as transcribed but non-translated sequences that play a role in transcription, mRNA processing (including splicing and polyadenylation signals), ribosome binding and stability of mRNA. In addition, the nucleic acid molecule may be fused to a marker sequence encoding, for example, a peptide that facilitates purification.
  • Isolated nucleic acid molecules can be in the form of RNA, such as mRNA, or in the form DNA, including cDNA and genomic DNA obtained by cloning or produced by chemical synthetic techniques or by a combination thereof. The nucleic acid, especially DNA, can be double-stranded or single-stranded. Single-stranded nucleic acid can be the coding strand (sense strand) or the non-coding strand (anti-sense strand).
  • The invention further provides nucleic acid molecules that encode fragments of the peptides of the present invention as well as nucleic acid molecules that encode obvious variants of the LCAT proteins of the present invention that are described above. Such nucleic acid molecules may be naturally occurring, such as allelic variants (same locus), paralogs (different locus), and orthologs (different organism), or may be constructed by recombinant DNA methods or by chemical synthesis. Such non-naturally occurring variants may be made by mutagenesis techniques, including those applied to nucleic acid molecules, cells, or organisms. Accordingly, as discussed above, the variants can contain nucleotide substitutions, deletions, inversions and insertions. Variation can occur in either or both the coding and non-coding regions. The variations can produce both conservative and non-conservative amino acid substitutions.
  • The present invention further provides non-coding fragments of the nucleic acid molecules provided in Tables 1 and 2. Preferred non-coding fragments include, but are not limited to, promoter sequences, enhancer sequences, gene modulating sequences and gene termination sequences. Such fragments are useful in controlling heterologous gene expression and in developing screens to identify gene-modulating agents. A promoter can readily be identified as being 5′ to the ATG start site in the genomic sequence.
  • A fragment comprises a contiguous nucleotide sequence greater than 12 or more nucleotides. Further, a fragment could at least 30, 40, 50, 100, 250 or 500 nucleotides in length. The length of the fragment will be based on its intended use. For example, the fragment can encode epitope bearing regions of the peptide, or can be useful as DNA probes and primers. Such fragments can be isolated using the known nucleotide sequence to synthesize an oligonucleotide probe. A labeled probe can then be used to screen a cDNA library, genomic DNA library, or mRNA to isolate nucleic acid corresponding to the coding region. Further, primers can be used in PCR reactions to clone specific regions of gene.
  • A probe/primer typically comprises substantially a purified oligonucleotide or oligonucleotide pair. The oligonucleotide typically comprises a region of nucleotide sequence that hybridizes under stringent conditions to at least about 12, 20, 25, 40, 50 or more consecutive nucleotides.
  • Orthologs, homologs, and allelic variants can be identified using methods well known in the art. As described in the Peptide Section, these variants comprise a nucleotide sequence encoding a peptide that is typically 60-70%, 70-80%, 80-90%, and more typically at least about 90-95% or more homologous to the nucleotide sequence shown in the Table 2 or a fragment of this sequence. Such nucleic acid molecules can readily be identified as being able to hybridize under moderate to stringent conditions, to the nucleotide sequence shown in the Figure sheets or a fragment of the sequence. Allelic variants can readily be determined by genetic locus of the encoding gene.
  • As used herein, the term “hybridizes under stringent conditions” is intended to describe conditions for hybridization and washing under which nucleotide sequences encoding a peptide at least 60-70% homologous to each other typically remain hybridized to each other. The conditions can be such that sequences at least about 60%, at least about 70%, or at least about 80% or more homologous to each other typically remain hybridized to each other. Such stringent conditions are known to those skilled in the art and can be found in Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, John Wiley & Sons, N.Y. (1989), 6.3.1-6.3.6. One example of stringent hybridization conditions are hybridization in 6× sodium chloride/sodium citrate (SSC) at about 45 C, followed by one or more washes in 0.2×SSC, 0.1% SDS at 50-65 C. Examples of moderate to low stringency hybridization conditions are well known in the art.
  • Nucleic Acid Molecule Uses
  • The nucleic acid molecules of the present invention are useful for probes, primers, chemical intermediates, and in biological assays. The nucleic acid molecules are useful as a hybridization probe for messenger RNA, transcript/cDNA and genomic DNA to isolate full-length cDNA and genomic clones encoding the peptide described in Tables 1 and 2 and to isolate cDNA and genomic clones that correspond to variants (alleles, orthologs, etc.) producing the same or related peptides shown in Tables 1 and 2.
  • The probe can correspond to any sequence along the entire length of the nucleic acid molecules provided in the Tables. Accordingly, it could be derived from 5′ noncoding regions, the coding region, and 3′ noncoding regions. However, as discussed, fragments are not to be construed as encompassing fragments disclosed prior to the present invention.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful as primers for PCR to amplify any given region of a nucleic acid molecule and are useful to synthesize antisense molecules of desired length and sequence.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing recombinant vectors. Such vectors include expression vectors that express a portion of, or all of, the peptide sequences. Vectors also include insertion vectors, used to integrate into another nucleic acid molecule sequence, such as into the cellular genome, to alter in situ expression of a gene and/or gene product. For example, an endogenous coding sequence can be replaced via homologous recombination with all or part of the coding region containing one or more specifically introduced mutations.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for expressing antigenic portions of the proteins.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful as probes for determining the chromosomal positions of the nucleic acid molecules by means of in situ hybridization methods.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful in making vectors containing the gene regulatory regions of the nucleic acid molecules of the present invention.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for designing ribozymes corresponding to all, or a part, of the mRNA produced from the nucleic acid molecules described herein. The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for making vectors that express part, or all, of the peptides.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing host cells expressing a part, or all, of the nucleic acid molecules and peptides.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for constructing transgenic animals expressing all, or a part, of the nucleic acid molecules and peptides.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful as hybridization probes for determining the presence, level, form and distribution of nucleic acid expression. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. Accordingly, the probes can be used to detect the presence of, or to determine levels of, a specific nucleic acid molecule in cells, tissues, and in organisms. The nucleic acid whose level is determined can be DNA or RNA. Accordingly, probes corresponding to the peptides described herein can be used to assess expression and/or gene copy number in a given cell, tissue, or organism. These uses are relevant for diagnosis of disorders involving an increase or decrease in LCAT protein expression relative to normal results.
  • In vitro techniques for detection of mRNA include Northern hybridizations and in situ hybridizations. In vitro techniques for detecting DNA include Southern hybridizations and in situ hybridization.
  • Probes can be used as a part of a diagnostic test kit for identifying cells or tissues that express a LCAT protein, such as by measuring a level of a LCAT-encoding nucleic acid in a sample of cells from a subject e.g., mRNA or genomic DNA, or determining if a LCAT gene has been mutated. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. More detection and diagnosis methods are described in detail below.
  • Nucleic acid expression assays are useful for drug screening to identify compounds that modulate LCAT nucleic acid expression.
  • The invention thus provides a method for identifying a compound that can be used to treat a disorder associated with nucleic acid expression of the LCAT gene, particularly biological and pathological processes that are mediated by the LCAT in cells and tissues that express it. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues. The method typically includes assaying the ability of the compound to modulate the expression of the LCAT nucleic acid and thus identifying a compound that can be used to treat a disorder characterized by undesired LCAT nucleic acid expression. The assays can be performed in cell-based and cell-free systems. Cell-based assays include cells naturally expressing the LCAT nucleic acid or recombinant cells genetically engineered to express specific nucleic acid sequences.
  • The assay for LCAT nucleic acid expression can involve direct assay of nucleic acid levels, such as mRNA levels, or on collateral compounds involved in the signal pathway. Further, the expression of genes that are up- or down-regulated in response to the LCAT protein signal pathway can also be assayed. In this embodiment the regulatory regions of these genes can be operably linked to a reporter gene such as luciferase.
  • Thus, modulators of LCAT gene expression can be identified in a method wherein a cell is contacted with a candidate compound or agent and the expression of mRNA determined. The level of expression of LCAT mRNA in the presence of the candidate compound or agent is compared to the level of expression of LCAT mRNA in the absence of the candidate compound or agent. The candidate compound can then be identified as a modulator of nucleic acid expression based on this comparison and be used, for example to treat a disorder characterized by aberrant nucleic acid expression. When expression of mRNA is statistically significantly greater in the presence of the candidate compound than in its absence, the candidate compound is identified as a stimulator of nucleic acid expression. When nucleic acid expression is statistically significantly less in the presence of the candidate compound than in its absence, the candidate compound is identified as an inhibitor of nucleic acid expression.
  • The invention further provides methods of treatment, with the nucleic acid as a target, using a compound or an agent identified through drug screening as a gene modulator to modulate LCAT nucleic acid expression in cells and tissues that express the LCAT. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. Modulation includes both up-regulation (i.e. activation or agonization) or down-regulation (suppression or antagonization) or nucleic acid expression.
  • Alternatively, a modulator for nucleic acid expression can be a small molecule or drug identified using the screening assays described herein as long as the drug or small molecule inhibits the LCAT nucleic acid expression in the cells and tissues that express the protein. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicates expression in human lung cell lines and/or lung tumor tissues.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for monitoring the effectiveness of modulating compounds or agents on the expression or activity of the LCAT gene in clinical trials or in a treatment regimen. Thus, the gene expression pattern can serve as a barometer for the continuing effectiveness of treatment with the compound, particularly with compounds to which a patient can develop resistance. The gene expression pattern can also serve as a marker indicative of a physiological response of the affected cells to the compound. Accordingly, such monitoring would allow either increased administration of the compound or the administration of alternative compounds to which the patient has not become resistant. Similarly, if the level of nucleic acid expression falls below a desirable level, administration of the compound could be commensurately decreased.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful in diagnostic assays for qualitative changes in LCAT nucleic acid expression, and particularly in qualitative changes that lead to pathology. The nucleic acid molecules can be used to detect mutations in LCAT genes and gene expression products such as mRNA. The nucleic acid molecules can be used as hybridization probes to detect naturally occurring genetic mutations in the LCAT gene and thereby to determine whether a subject with the mutation is at risk for a disorder caused by the mutation. Mutations include deletion, addition, or substitution of one or more nucleotides in the gene, chromosomal rearrangement, such as inversion or transposition, modification of genomic DNA, such as aberrant methylation patterns or changes in gene copy number, such as amplification. Detection of a mutated form of the LCAT gene associated with a dysfunction provides a diagnostic tool for an active disease or susceptibility to disease when the disease results from overexpression, underexpression, or altered expression of a LCAT protein.
  • Individuals carrying mutations in the LCAT gene can be detected at the nucleic acid level by a variety of techniques. Genomic DNA can be analyzed directly or can be amplified by using PCR prior to analysis. RNA or cDNA can be used in the same way. In some uses, detection of the mutation involves the use of a probe/primer in a polymerase chain reaction (PCR) (see, e.g. U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,683,195 and 4,683,202), such as anchor PCR or RACE PCR, or, alternatively, in a ligation chain reaction (LCR) (see, e.g., Landegran et al., Science 241:1077-1080 (1988); and Nakazawa et al., PNAS 91:360-364 (1994)), the latter of which can be particularly useful for detecting point mutations in the gene (see Abravaya et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 23:675-682 (1995)). This method can include the steps of collecting a sample of cells from a patient, isolating nucleic acid (e.g., genomic, mRNA or both) from the cells of the sample, contacting the nucleic acid sample with one or more primers which specifically hybridize to a gene under conditions such that hybridization and amplification of the gene (if present) occurs, and detecting the presence or absence of an amplification product, or detecting the size of the amplification product and comparing the length to a control sample. Deletions and insertions can be detected by a change in size of the amplified product compared to the normal genotype. Point mutations can be identified by hybridizing amplified DNA to normal RNA or antisense DNA sequences.
  • Alternatively, mutations in a LCAT gene can be directly identified, for example, by alterations in restriction enzyme digestion patterns determined by gel electrophoresis.
  • Further, sequence-specific ribozymes (U.S. Pat. No. 5,498,531) can be used to score for the presence of specific mutations by development or loss of a ribozyme cleavage site. Perfectly matched sequences can be distinguished from mismatched sequences by nuclease cleavage digestion assays or by differences in melting temperature.
  • Sequence changes at specific locations can also be assessed by nuclease protection assays such as RNase and S1 protection or the chemical cleavage method. Furthermore, sequence differences between a mutant LCAT gene and a wild-type gene can be determined by direct DNA sequencing. A variety of automated sequencing procedures can be utilized when performing the diagnostic assays (Naeve, C. W., (1995) Biotechniques 19:448), including sequencing by mass spectrometry (see, e.g., PCT International Publication No. WO 94/16101; Cohen et al., Adv. Chromatogr. 36:127-162 (1996); and Griffin et al., Appl. Biochem. Biotechnol. 38:147-159 (1993)).
  • Other methods for detecting mutations in the gene include methods in which protection from cleavage agents is used to detect mismatched bases in RNA/RNA or RNA/DNA duplexes (Myers et al., Science 230:1242 (1985)); Cotton et al., PNAS 85:4397 (1988); Saleeba et al., Meth. Enzymol. 217:286-295 (1992)), electrophoretic mobility of mutant and wild type nucleic acid is compared (Orita et al., PNAS 86:2766 (1989); Cotton et al., Mutat. Res. 285:125-144 (1993); and Hayashi et al., Genet. Anal. Tech. Appl. 9:73-79 (1992)), and movement of mutant or wild-type fragments in polyacrylamide gels containing a gradient of denaturant is assayed using denaturing gradient gel electrophoresis (Myers et al., Nature 313:495 (1985)). Examples of other techniques for detecting point mutations include selective oligonucleotide hybridization, selective amplification, and selective primer extension.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are also useful for testing an individual for a genotype that while not necessarily causing the disease, nevertheless affects the treatment modality. Thus, the nucleic acid molecules can be used to study the relationship between an individual's genotype and the individual's response to a compound used for treatment (pharmacogenomic relationship). Accordingly, the nucleic acid molecules described herein can be used to assess the mutation content of the LCAT gene in an individual in order to select an appropriate compound or dosage regimen for treatment.
  • Thus nucleic acid molecules displaying genetic variations that affect treatment provide a diagnostic target that can be used to tailor treatment in an individual. Accordingly, the production of recombinant cells and animals containing these polymorphisms allow effective clinical design of treatment compounds and dosage regimens.
  • The nucleic acid molecules are thus useful as antisense constructs to control LCAT gene expression in cells, tissues, and organisms. A DNA antisense nucleic acid molecule is designed to be complementary to a region of the gene involved in transcription, preventing transcription and hence production of LCAT protein. An antisense RNA or DNA nucleic acid molecule would hybridize to the mRNA and thus block translation of mRNA into LCAT protein.
  • The nucleic acid of the present invention may also be used to specifically suppress gene expression by methods such as RNA interference (RNAi), which may also include cosuppression and quelling. This and antisense RNA or DNA of gene suppression are well known in the art. A review of this technique is found in Science 288:1370-1372, 2000. RNAi also operates on a post-transcriptional level and is sequence specific, but suppresses gene expression far more efficiently than antisense RNA. RNAi fragments, particularly double-stranded (ds) RNAi, can be also used to generate loss-of-function phenotypes.
  • The present invention relates to isolated RNA molecules (double-stranded; single-stranded) of from about 21 to about 25 nucleotides which mediate RNAi. As used herein, about 21 to about 25 nt includes nucleotides 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28 and 29 nucleotides in length. The isolated RNAs of the present invention mediate degradation of mRNA, the transcriptional product of a gene. Such mRNA is also referred to herein as mRNA to be degraded. As used herein, the terms RNA, RNA molecule(s), RNA segment(s) and RNA fragment(s) are used interchangeably to refer to RNA that mediates RNA interference. These terms include double-stranded RNA, single-stranded RNA, isolated RNA (partially purified RNA, essentially pure RNA, synthetic RNA, recombinantly produced RNA), as well as altered RNA that differs from naturally occurring RNA by the addition, deletion, substitution and/or alteration of one or more nucleotides. Such alterations can include addition of non-nucleotide material, such as to the end(s) of the 21-25 nt RNA or internally (at one or more nucleotides of the RNA). Nucleotides in the RNA molecules of the present invention can also comprise non-standard nucleotides, including non-naturally occurring nucleotides or deoxyribonucleotides. Collectively, all such altered RNAs are referred to as analogs or analogs of naturally-occurring RNA. RNA of 21-25 nucleotides of the present invention need only be sufficiently similar to natural RNA that it has the ability to mediate RNAi. As used herein the phrase “mediates RNAi” refers to the ability to distinguish which RNAs are to be degraded by the RNAi machinery or process. RNA that mediates RNAi interacts with the RNAi machinery such that it directs the degradation of particular mRNAs. Such RNA may include RNAs of various structure, including short hairpin RNA.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention relates to RNA molecules of about 21 to about 25 nucleotides that direct cleavage of specific mRNA to which their sequence corresponds. It is not necessary that there be perfect correspondence of the sequences, but the correspondence must be sufficient to enable the RNA to direct RNAi cleavage of the target mRNA (Holen et al. (2005) Nucleic Acids Res. 33, 4704-4710). In a particular embodiment, the 21-25 nt RNA molecules of the present invention comprise a 3′ hydroxyl group.
  • The present invention relates to 21-25 nt RNAs of specific genes, produced by chemical synthesis or recombinant DNA techniques, that mediate RNAi. As used herein, the term isolated RNA includes RNA obtained by any means, including processing or cleavage of dsRNA; production by chemical synthetic methods; and production by recombinant DNA techniques. The invention further relates to uses of the 21-25 nt RNAs, such as for therapeutic or prophylactic treatment and compositions comprising 21-25 nt RNAs that mediate RNAi, such as pharmaceutical compositions comprising 21-25 nt RNAs and an appropriate carrier.
  • The present invention also relates to a method of mediating RNA interference of genes of a patient. In one embodiment, RNA of about 21 to about 25 nt which targets the specific mRNA to be degraded is introduced into a patient's cells. The cells are maintained under conditions allowing degradation of the mRNA, resulting in RNA-mediated interference of the mRNA of the gene in the cells of the patient. Treatment of patients with cancer with the RNAi will inhibit the growth and spread of the cancer and reduce the tumor. Treatment of patients using RNAi can also be in combination with other anti-cancer compounds. The RNAi may be used in combination with other treatment modalities, such as chemotherapy, cryotherapy, hyperthermia, radiation therapy, and other similar treatments. In one embodiment, a chemotherapy agent was combined with the RNAi. In another embodiment, a chemotherapy named Gemzar was used.
  • Treatment of cancer or tumors in patients requires introduction of the RNA into the cancer or tumor cells. RNA may be directly introduced into the cell, or introduced extracellularly into a cavity, interstitial space, into the circulation of a patient, or introduced orally. Methods for oral introduction include direct mixing of the RNA with food, as well as engineered approaches in which a species that is used as food is engineered to express the RNA and then ingested. Physical methods of introducing nucleic acids, for example, injection directly into the cell or extracellular injection into the patient, may also be used. Vascular or extravascular circulation, the blood or lymph system, and the cerebrospinal fluid are sites where the RNA may be introduced. RNA may be introduced into an embryonic stem cell, or another multipotent cell derived from the patient. Physical methods of introducing nucleic acids include injection of a solution containing the RNA, bombardment by particles covered by the RNA, soaking cells or tissue in a solution of the RNA, or electroporation of cell membranes in the presence of the RNA. A viral construct packaged into a viral particle may be used to introduce an expression construct into the cell, with the construct expressing RNA. Other methods known in the art for introducing nucleic acids to cells may be used, such as lipid-mediated carrier transport, chemical-mediated transport, and the like. Thus the RNA may be introduced along with components that perform one or more of the following activities: enhance RNA uptake by the cell, promote annealing of the duplex strands, stabilize the annealed strands, or otherwise increase inhibition of the target gene. The RNAi may be used in combination with other treatment modalities, such as chemotherapy, cryotherapy, hyperthermia, radiation therapy, and the like.
  • The present invention may be used alone or as a component of a kit having at least one of the reagents necessary to carry out the in vitro or in vivo introduction of RNA to tissue or patients. Preferred components are the dsRNA and a vehicle that promotes introduction of the dsRNA. Such a kit may also include instructions to allow a user of the kit to practice the invention.
  • Alternatively, a class of antisense molecules can be used to inactivate mRNA in order to decrease expression of LCAT nucleic acid. Accordingly, these molecules can treat a disorder characterized by abnormal or undesired LCAT nucleic acid expression. This technique involves cleavage by means of ribozymes containing nucleotide sequences complementary to one or more regions in the mRNA that attenuate the ability of the mRNA to be translated. Possible regions include coding regions and particularly coding regions corresponding to the catalytic and other functional activities of the LCAT protein, such as substrate binding.
  • The nucleic acid molecules also provide vectors for gene therapy in patients containing cells that are aberrant in LCAT gene expression. Thus, recombinant cells, which include the patient's cells that have been engineered ex vivo and returned to the patient, are introduced into an individual where the cells produce the desired LCAT protein to treat the individual.
  • The invention also encompasses kits for detecting the presence of a LCAT nucleic acid in a biological sample. Experimental data as provided in Table 1 indicate that the LCATs of the present invention are expressed at differential level in various lung cell lines and/or lung tissues, for example, SEQ ID NOS:1-1154. For example, the kit can comprise reagents such as a labeled or labelable nucleic acid or agent capable of detecting LCAT nucleic acid in a biological sample; means for determining the amount of LCAT nucleic acid in the sample; and means for comparing the amount of LCAT nucleic acid in the sample with a standard. The compound or agent can be packaged in a suitable container. The kit can further comprise instructions for using the kit to detect LCAT protein mRNA or DNA.
  • Vectors/Host Cells
  • The invention also provides vectors containing the nucleic acid molecules described herein. The term “vector” refers to a vehicle, preferably a nucleic acid molecule, which can transport the nucleic acid molecules. When the vector is a nucleic acid molecule, the nucleic acid molecules are covalently linked to the vector nucleic acid. With this aspect of the invention, the vector includes a plasmid, single or double stranded phage, a single or double stranded RNA or DNA viral vector, or artificial chromosome, such as a BAC, PAC, YAC, OR MAC.
  • A vector can be maintained in the host cell as an extrachromosomal element where it replicates and produces additional copies of the nucleic acid molecules. Alternatively, the vector may integrate into the host cell genome and produce additional copies of the nucleic acid molecules when the host cell replicates.
  • The invention provides vectors for the maintenance (cloning vectors) or vectors for expression (expression vectors) of the nucleic acid molecules. The vectors can function in prokaryotic or eukaryotic cells or in both (shuttle vectors).
  • Expression vectors contain cis-acting regulatory regions that are operably linked in the vector to the nucleic acid molecules such that transcription of the nucleic acid molecules is allowed in a host cell. The nucleic acid molecules can be introduced into the host cell with a separate nucleic acid molecule capable of affecting transcription. Thus, the second nucleic acid molecule may provide a trans-acting factor interacting with the cis-regulatory control region to allow transcription of the nucleic acid molecules from the vector. Alternatively, a trans-acting factor may be supplied by the host cell. Finally, a trans-acting factor can be produced from the vector itself. It is understood, however, that in some embodiments, transcription and/or translation of the nucleic acid molecules can occur in a cell-free system.
  • The regulatory sequences to which the nucleic acid molecules described herein can be operably linked include promoters for directing mRNA transcription. These include, but are not limited to, the left promoter from bacteriophage, the lac, TRP, and TAC promoters from E. coli, the early and late promoters from SV40, the CMV immediate early promoter, the adenovirus early and late promoters, and retrovirus long-terminal repeats.
  • In addition to control regions that promote transcription, expression vectors may also include regions that modulate transcription, such as repressor binding sites and enhancers. Examples include the SV40 enhancer, the cytomegalovirus immediate early enhancer, polyoma enhancer, adenovirus enhancers, and retrovirus LTR enhancers.
  • In addition to containing sites for transcription initiation and control, expression vectors can also contain sequences necessary for transcription termination and, in the transcribed region a ribosome binding site for translation. Other regulatory control elements for expression include initiation and termination codons as well as polyadenylation signals. The person of ordinary skill in the art would be aware of the numerous regulatory sequences that are useful in expression vectors. Such regulatory sequences are described, for example, in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • A variety of expression vectors can be used to express a nucleic acid molecule. Such vectors include chromosomal, episomal, and virus-derived vectors, for example vectors derived from bacterial plasmids, from bacteriophage, from yeast episomes, from yeast chromosomal elements, including yeast artificial chromosomes, from viruses such as baculoviruses, papovaviruses such as SV40, Vaccinia viruses, adenoviruses, poxviruses, pseudorabies viruses, and retroviruses. Vectors may also be derived from combinations of these sources such as those derived from plasmid and bacteriophage genetic elements, e.g. cosmids and phagemids. Appropriate cloning and expression vectors for prokaryotic and eukaryotic hosts are described in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • The regulatory sequence may provide constitutive expression in one or more host cells (i.e. tissue specific) or may provide for inducible expression in one or more cell types such as by temperature, nutrient additive, or exogenous factor such as a hormone or other ligand. A variety of vectors providing for constitutive and inducible expression in prokaryotic and eukaryotic hosts are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • The nucleic acid molecules can be inserted into the vector nucleic acid by well-known methodology. Generally, the DNA sequence that will ultimately be expressed is joined to an expression vector by cleaving the DNA sequence and the expression vector with one or more restriction enzymes and then ligating the fragments together. Procedures for restriction enzyme digestion and ligation are well known to those of ordinary skill in the art.
  • The vector containing the appropriate nucleic acid molecule can be introduced into an appropriate host cell for propagation or expression using well-known techniques. Bacterial cells include, but are not limited to, E. coli, Streptomyces, and Salmonella typhimurium. Eukaryotic cells include, but are not limited to, yeast, insect cells such as Drosophila, animal cells such as COS and CHO cells, and plant cells.
  • As described herein, it may be desirable to express the peptide as a fusion protein. Accordingly, the invention provides fusion vectors that allow for the production of the peptides. Fusion vectors can increase the expression of a recombinant protein; increase the solubility of the recombinant protein, and aid in the purification of the protein by acting for example as a ligand for affinity purification. A proteolytic cleavage site may be introduced at the junction of the fusion moiety so that the desired peptide can ultimately be separated from the fusion moiety. Proteolytic enzymes include, but are not limited to, factor Xa, thrombin, and enteroenzyme. Typical fusion expression vectors include pGEX (Smith et al., Gene 67:31-40 (1988)), pMAL (New England Biolabs, Beverly, Mass.) and pRIT5 (Pharmacia, Piscataway, N.J.) which fuse glutathione S-transferase (GST), maltose E binding protein, or protein A, respectively, to the target recombinant protein. Examples of suitable inducible non-fusion E. coli expression vectors include pTrc (Amann et al., Gene 69:301-315 (1988)) and pET 11d (Studier et al., Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185:60-89 (1990)). Recombinant protein expression can be maximized in host bacteria by providing a genetic background wherein the host cell has an impaired capacity to proteolytically cleave the recombinant protein. (Gottesman, S., Gene Expression Technology: Methods in Enzymology 185, Academic Press, San Diego, Calif. (1990) 119-128). Alternatively, the sequence of the nucleic acid molecule of interest can be altered to provide preferential codon usage for a specific host cell, for example E. coli. (Wada et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 20:2111-2118 (1992)).
  • The nucleic acid molecules can also be expressed by expression vectors that are operative in yeast. Examples of vectors for expression in yeast e.g., S. cerevisiae include pYepSec1 (Baldari, et al., EMBO J. 6:229-234 (1987)), pMFa (Kurjan et al., Cell 30:933-943 (1982)), pJRY88 (Schultz et al., Gene 54:113-123 (1987)), and pYES2 (Invitrogen Corporation, San Diego, Calif.).
  • The nucleic acid molecules can also be expressed in insect cells using, for example, baculovirus expression vectors. Baculovirus vectors available for expression of proteins in cultured insect cells (e.g., Sf 9 cells) include the pAc series (Smith et al., Mol. Cell. Biol. 3:2156-2165 (1983)) and the pVL series (Lucklow et al., Virology 170:31-39 (1989)).
  • In certain embodiments of the invention, the nucleic acid molecules described herein are expressed in mammalian cells using mammalian expression vectors. Examples of mammalian expression vectors include pCDM8 (Seed, B. Nature 329:840 (1987)) and pMT2PC (Kaufman et al., EMBO J. 6:187-195 (1987)).
  • The expression vectors listed herein are provided by way of example only of the well-known vectors available to those of ordinary skill in the art that would be useful to express the nucleic acid molecules. The person of ordinary skill in the art would be aware of other vectors suitable for maintenance propagation or expression of the nucleic acid molecules described herein. These are found for example in Sambrook, J., Fritsh, E. F., and Maniatis, T. Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • The invention also encompasses vectors in which the nucleic acid sequences described herein are cloned into the vector in reverse orientation, but operably linked to a regulatory sequence that permits transcription of antisense RNA. Thus, an antisense transcript can be produced to all, or to a portion, of the nucleic acid molecule sequences described herein, including both coding and non-coding regions. Expression of this antisense RNA is subject to each of the parameters described above in relation to expression of the sense RNA (regulatory sequences, constitutive or inducible expression, tissue-specific expression).
  • The invention also relates to recombinant host cells containing the vectors described herein. Host cells therefore include prokaryotic cells, lower eukaryotic cells such as yeast, other eukaryotic cells such as insect cells, and higher eukaryotic cells such as mammalian cells.
  • The recombinant host cells are prepared by introducing the vector constructs described herein into the cells by techniques readily available to the person of ordinary skill in the art. These include, but are not limited to, calcium phosphate transfection, DEAE-dextran-mediated transfection, cationic lipid-mediated transfection, electroporation, transduction, infection, lipofection, and other techniques such as those found in Sambrook, et al. (Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual. 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • Host cells can contain more than one vector. Thus, different nucleotide sequences can be introduced on different vectors of the same cell. Similarly, the nucleic acid molecules can be introduced either alone or with other nucleic acid molecules that are not related to the nucleic acid molecules such as those providing trans-acting factors for expression vectors. When more than one vector is introduced into a cell, the vectors can be introduced independently, co-introduced or joined to the nucleic acid molecule vector.
  • In the case of bacteriophage and viral vectors, these can be introduced into cells as packaged or encapsulated virus by standard procedures for infection and transduction. Viral vectors can be replication-competent or replication-defective. In the case in which viral replication is defective, replication will occur in host cells providing functions that complement the defects.
  • Vectors generally include selectable markers that enable the selection of the subpopulation of cells that contain the recombinant vector constructs. The marker can be contained in the same vector that contains the nucleic acid molecules described herein or may be on a separate vector. Markers include tetracycline or ampicillin-resistance genes for prokaryotic host cells and dihydrofolate reductase or neomycin resistance for eukaryotic host cells. However, any marker that provides selection for a phenotypic trait will be effective.
  • While the mature proteins can be produced in bacteria, yeast, mammalian cells, and other cells under the control of the appropriate regulatory sequences, cell-free transcription and translation systems can also be used to produce these proteins using RNA derived from the DNA constructs described herein.
  • Where secretion of the peptide is desired, which is difficult to achieve with multi-transmembrane domain containing proteins such as LCATs, appropriate secretion signals are incorporated into the vector. The signal sequence can be endogenous to the peptides or heterologous to these peptides.
  • Where the peptide is not secreted into the medium, which is typically the case with LCATs, the protein can be isolated from the host cell by standard disruption procedures, including freeze thaw, sonication, mechanical disruption, use of lysing agents and the like. The peptide can then be recovered and purified by well-known purification methods including ammonium sulfate precipitation, acid extraction, anion or cationic exchange chromatography, phosphocellulose chromatography, hydrophobic-interaction chromatography, affinity chromatography, hydroxylapatite chromatography, lectin chromatography, or high performance liquid chromatography.
  • It is also understood that depending upon the host cell in recombinant production of the peptides described herein, the peptides can have various glycosylation patterns, depending upon the cell, or maybe non-glycosylated as when produced in bacteria. In addition, the peptides may include an initial modified methionine in some cases as a result of a host-mediated process.
  • Uses of Vectors and Host Cells
  • The recombinant host cells expressing the peptides described herein have a variety of uses. First, the cells are useful for producing a LCAT protein or peptide that can be further purified to produce desired amounts of LCAT protein or fragments. Thus, host cells containing expression vectors are useful for peptide production.
  • Host cells are also useful for conducting cell-based assays involving the LCAT protein or LCAT protein fragments, such as those described above as well as other formats known in the art. Thus, a recombinant host cell expressing a native LCAT protein is useful for assaying compounds that stimulate or inhibit LCAT protein function.
  • Host cells are also useful for identifying LCAT protein mutants in which these functions are affected. If the mutants naturally occur and give rise to a pathology, host cells containing the mutations are useful to assay compounds that have a desired effect on the mutant LCAT protein (for example, stimulating or inhibiting function) which may not be indicated by their effect on the native LCAT protein.
  • Genetically engineered host cells can be further used to produce non-human transgenic animals. A transgenic animal is preferably a mammal, for example a rodent, such as a rat or mouse, in which one or more of the cells of the animal include a transgene. A transgene is exogenous DNA which is integrated into the genome of a cell from which a transgenic animal develops and which remains in the genome of the mature animal in one or more cell types or tissues of the transgenic animal. These animals are useful for studying the function of a LCAT protein and identifying and evaluating modulators of LCAT protein activity. Other examples of transgenic animals include non-human primates, sheep, dogs, cows, goats, chickens, and amphibians.
  • A transgenic animal can be produced by introducing nucleic acid into the male pronuclei of a fertilized oocyte, e.g., by microinjection, retroviral infection, and allowing the oocyte to develop in a pseudopregnant female foster animal. Any of the LCAT protein nucleotide sequences can be introduced as a transgene into the genome of a non-human animal, such as a mouse.
  • Any of the regulatory or other sequences useful in expression vectors can form part of the transgenic sequence. This includes intronic sequences and polyadenylation signals, if not already included. A tissue-specific regulatory sequence(s) can be operably linked to the transgene to direct expression of the LCAT protein to particular cells.
  • Methods for generating transgenic animals via embryo manipulation and microinjection, particularly animals such as mice, have become conventional in the art and are described, for example, in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,736,866 and 4,870,009, both by Leder et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,873,191 by Wagner et al. and in Hogan, B., Manipulating the Mouse Embryo, (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., 1986). Similar methods are used for production of other transgenic animals. A transgenic founder animal can be identified based upon the presence of the transgene in its genome and/or expression of transgenic mRNA in tissues or cells of the animals. A transgenic founder animal can then be used to breed additional animals carrying the transgene. Moreover, transgenic animals carrying a transgene can further be bred to other transgenic animals carrying other transgenes. A transgenic animal also includes animals in which the entire animal or tissues in the animal have been produced using the homologously recombinant host cells described herein.
  • In another embodiment, transgenic non-human animals can be produced which contain selected systems that allow for regulated expression of the transgene. One example of such a system is the cre/loxP recombinase system of bacteriophage P1. For a description of the cre/loxP recombinase system, see, e.g., Lakso et al. PNAS 89:6232-6236 (1992). Another example of a recombinase system is the FLP recombinase system of S. cerevisiae (O'Gorman et al. Science 251:1351-1355 (1991). If a cre/loxP recombinase system is used to regulate expression of the transgene, animals containing transgenes encoding both the Cre recombinase and a selected protein is required. Such animals can be provided through the construction of “double” transgenic animals, e.g., by mating two transgenic animals, one containing a transgene encoding a selected protein and the other containing a transgene encoding a recombinase.
  • Clones of the non-human transgenic animals described herein can also be produced according to the methods described in Wilmut, I. et al. Nature 385:810-813 (1997) and PCT International Publication Nos. WO 97/07668 and WO 97/07669. In brief, a cell, e.g., a somatic cell, from the transgenic animal can be isolated and induced to exit the growth cycle and enter Go phase. The quiescent cell can then be fused, e.g., through the use of electrical pulses, to an enucleated oocyte from an animal of the same species from which the quiescent cell is isolated. The reconstructed oocyte is then cultured such that it develops to morula or blastocyst and then transferred to pseudopregnant female foster animal. The offspring born of this female foster animal will be a clone of the animal from which the cell, e.g., the somatic cell, is isolated.
  • Transgenic animals containing recombinant cells that express the peptides described herein are useful to conduct the assays described herein in an in vivo context. Accordingly, the various physiological factors that are present in vivo and that could effect substrate binding, LCAT protein activation, and signal transduction, may not be evident from in vitro cell-free or cell-based assays. Accordingly, it is useful to provide non-human transgenic animals to assay in vivo LCAT protein function, including substrate interaction, the effect of specific mutant LCAT proteins on LCAT protein function and substrate interaction, and the effect of chimeric LCAT proteins. It is also possible to assess the effect of null mutations, that is, mutations that substantially or completely eliminate one or more LCAT protein functions.
  • Detection and Diagnosis
  • The present invention provides a method for detecting LCAT nucleic acids, proteins, peptides and fragments thereof that are differentially expressed in lung diseases in a test sample, preferably in a biological sample.
  • The present invention further provides a method for diagnosing the lung diseases, by detecting the nucleic acids, proteins, peptides and fragments thereof. The further embodiment includes but is not limited to, monitoring the disease prognosis (recurrence), diagnosing disease stage, preventing the disease and treating the disease. While the protein is overexpressed, the expression of LCAT is preferably greater than about 20%, or preferably greater than about 30%, and most preferably greater than about 50% or more of lung disease sample, at a level that is at least two fold, and preferably at least five fold, greater than the level of expression in control samples, as determined using a representative assay provided herein. While the protein is underexpressed, the expression of LCAT is preferably less than about 20%, or preferably less than 30%, and most preferably less than about 50% or more of the lung disease sample, at a level that is at least 0.5 fold, and preferably at least 0.2 fold less than the level of the expression in control samples, as determined using a representative assay provided herein.
  • As used herein, a “biological sample” can be collected from tissues, blood, sera, cell lines or biological fluids such as, plasma, interstitial fluid, urine, cerebrospinal fluid, and the like, containing cells. In preferred embodiments, a biological sample comprises cells or tissues suspected of having diseases (e.g., cells obtained from a biopsy).
  • As used herein, a “differential level” is defined as the level of LCAT protein or nucleic acids in a test sample either above or below the level of the ones in control samples, wherein the level of control samples is obtained either from a control cell line, a normal tissue or body fluids, or combination thereof, from a healthy subject.
  • As used herein, a “subject” can be a mammalian subject or non mammalian subject, preferably, a mammalian subject. A mammalian subject can be human or non-human, preferably human. A healthy subject is defined as a subject without detectable lung diseases or lung associated diseases by using conventional diagnostic methods.
  • As used herein the “diseases” include lung diseases and lung associated disease.
  • As used herein, “cancer” includes epithelial-cell related cancers, for example pancreatic, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian, breast as well as bladder and renal cancer.
  • Nucleic Acid Detections
  • the present invention is not limited to the detection methods described above. Any suitable detection method that allows for the specific detection of lung diseases cells, tissues or organs may be utilized. For example, in some embodiments, the expression of RNA corresponding to a LCAT gene is detected by hybridization to an antisense oligonucleotide (described below). In other embodiments, RNA expression is detected by hybridization assays such as Northern blots, RNase assays, reverse transcriptase PCR amplification, and the like. One preferred detection method is using RT PCR by using TaqMan technology (ABI, Foster City, Calif.).
  • In another embodiment, the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung diseases in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT nucleic acid molecules or any fragment(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT nucleic acid molecule(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 and a combination thereof; wherein a differential level of said LCAT nucleic acid molecule(s) relative to the level of said nucleic acid molecule(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung diseases.
  • In another embodiment, the detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 2, 4, 8, 10, 20 or more nucleic acid molecules, preferably, the nucleic acid molecules comprise or consists of a sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 and combination thereof.
  • In further embodiments of the present invention, the presence of particular sequences in the genome of a subject is detected. Such sequences include LCAT sequences associated with abnormal expression of LCAT (e.g., overexpression or expression at a physiological inappropriate time). These sequences include polymorphisms, including polymorphisms in the transcribed sequence (e.g., that effect LCAT processing and/or translation) and regulatory sequences such as promoters, enhances, repressors, and the like. These sequences may also include polymorphisms in genes or control sequences associated with factors that affect expression such as transcription factors, and the like. Any suitable method for detecting and/or identifying these sequences is within the scope of the present invention including, but not limited to, nucleic acid sequencing, hybridization assays (e.g., Southern blotting), single nucleotide polymorphism assays (See e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,994,069, herein incorporated by reference in its entirety), and the like.
  • Protein Detections
  • The present invention provides methods for diagnosing or detecting the differential presence of LCAT protein. In some embodiments (e.g., where LCATs are overexpressed in diseased cells), LCAT proteins are detected directly. In other embodiments (e.g., where the presence of a LCATs are underexpressed), LCAT to the disease antigens are detected non-existence.
  • The diagnostic methods of the present invention find utility in the diagnosis and characterization of diseases. For example, the presence of an antibody to a specific protein may be indicative of a cancer or disease. In addition, certain LCAT may be indicative of a specific stage or sub-type of the same cancer or disease.
  • The information obtained is also used to determine prognosis and appropriate course of treatment. For example, it is contemplated that individuals with a specific LCAT expression or stage of lung diseases may respond differently to a given treatment that individuals lacking the LCAT expression. The information obtained from the diagnostic methods of the present invention thus provides for the personalization of diagnosis and treatment.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides a method for monitoring lung diseases treatment in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptide(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and a combination thereof; wherein an level of said LCAT protein(s) similar to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of successful treatment.
  • In another embodiment, the present invention provides a method for diagnosing recurrence of lung diseases following successful treatment in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptide(s) thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 or a combination thereof; wherein a changed level of said LCAT protein(s) relative to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of recurrence of lung diseases.
  • In yet another embodiment, the present invention provides a method for diagnosing or detecting lung diseases in a subject comprising: determining the level of one or more LCAT proteins or any fragment(s) or peptides thereof in a test sample from said subject, wherein said LCAT protein(s) comprises a sequence selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154, SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and a combination thereof; wherein a differential level of said LCAT protein(s) relative to the level of said protein(s) in a test sample from a healthy subject, or the level established for a healthy subject, is indicative of lung diseases.
  • The detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 2, 4, 8, 10, 20 or more proteins, preferably, the proteins are selected from a group consisting of SEQ ID NOS: 1-1154 and combination thereof.
  • Further, the detecting or diagnosing method comprises determining level of differential expression of 5, 10, 15, 20, 40, 60, 80, 100 or more LCAT peptides, preferably the peptides are selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525 and combination thereof.
  • These methods are also useful for diagnosing diseases that show differential protein expression. As describe earlier, normal, control or standard values or level established from a healthy subject for protein expression are established by combining body fluids or tissue, cell extracts taken from a normal healthy mammalian or human subject with specific antibodies to a protein under conditions for complex formation. Standard values for complex formation in normal and diseased tissues are established by various methods, often photometric means. Then complex formation as it is expressed in a subject sample is compared with the standard values. Deviation from the normal standard and toward the diseased standard provides parameters for disease diagnosis or prognosis while deviation away from the diseased and toward the normal standard may be used to evaluate treatment efficacy.
  • In yet another embodiment, the present invention provides a detection or diagnostic method of LCATs by using LC/MS. The proteins from cells are prepared by methods known in the art (R. Aebersold Nature Biotechnology Volume 21 Number 6 Jun. 2003). The differential expression of proteins in disease and healthy samples are quantitated using Mass Spectrometry and ICAT (Isotope Coded Affinity Tag) labeling, which is known in the art. ICAT is an isotope label technique that allows for discrimination between two populations of proteins, such as a healthy and a disease sample. The LC/MS spectra are collected for the labeled samples. The raw scans from the LC/MS instrument are subjected to peak detection and noise reduction software. Filtered peak lists are then used to detect ‘features’ corresponding to specific peptides from the original sample(s). Features are characterized by their mass/charge, charge, retention time, isotope pattern and intensity.
  • The intensity of a peptide present in both healthy and disease samples can be used to calculate the differential expression, or relative abundance, of the peptide. The intensity of a peptide found exclusively in one sample can be used to calculate a theoretical expression ratio for that peptide (singleton). Expression ratios are calculated for each peptide of each replicate of the experiment (Table 1). Thus overexpression or under expression of LCAT protein or peptide are similar to the expression pattern in Table 1 in a test subject indicates the likelihood of having lung diseases or diseases associated with lung.
  • Immunological methods for detecting and measuring complex formation as a measure of protein expression using either specific polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies are known in the art. Examples of such techniques include enzyme-linked immunosorbent assays (ELISAs), radioimmunoassays (RIAs), fluorescence-activated cell sorting (FACS) and antibody arrays. Such immunoassays typically involve the measurement of complex formation between the protein and its specific antibody. These assays and their quantitation against purified, labeled standards are well known in the art (Ausubel, supra, unit 10.1-10.6). A two-site, monoclonal-based immunoassay utilizing antibodies reactive to two non-interfering epitopes is preferred, but a competitive binding assay may be employed (Pound (1998) Immunochemical Protocols, Humana Press, Totowa N.J.). More immunological detections are described in section below.
  • Antibody Detections
  • Antibodies are useful to detect the presence of one of the proteins or fragments thereof, peptides of the present invention in cells or tissues to determine the pattern of expression of the protein among various tissues in an organism and over the course of normal development.
  • Further, as described above, the antibodies can be used to assess expression in disease states such as in active stages of the disease or in an individual with a predisposition toward disease related to the protein's function. The antibodies can also be used to assess normal and aberrant subcellular localization of cells in the various tissues in an organism.
  • Detection on a protein by an antibody can be facilitated by coupling (i.e., physically linking) the antibody to a detectable substance. Examples of detectable substances include various enzymes, prosthetic groups, fluorescent materials, luminescent materials, bioluminescent materials, and radioactive materials (see below). The antibodies may also be useful in diagnostic assays, e.g., for detecting expression of an antigen, for example LCAT protein, peptide or fragment thereof, in specific cells, tissues, blood, serum or body fluids.
  • For diagnostic applications, the antibody or its variant typically will be labeled with a detectable moiety. Numerous labels are available which can be generally grouped into the following categories:
  • (a) Radioisotopes, such as 36S, 14C, 125H, and 131I. The antibody variant can be labeled with the radioisotope using the techniques described in Current Protocols in Immunology, vol 1-2, Coligen et al., Ed., Wiley-Interscience, New York, Pubs. (1991) for example and radioactivity can be measured using scintillation counting.
  • (b) Fluorescent labels such as rare earth chelates (europium chelates) or fluorescein and its derivatives, rhodamine and its derivatives, dansyl, Lissamine, phycoerythrin and Texas Red are available. The fluorescent labels can be conjugated to the antibody variant using the techniques disclosed in Current Protocols in Immunology, supra, for example. Fluorescence can be quantified using a fluorimeter.
  • (c) Various enzyme-substrate labels are available and U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,275,149, 4,318,980 provides a review of some of these. The enzyme generally catalyzes a chemical alteration of the chromogenic substrate which can be measured using various techniques. For example, the enzyme may catalyze a color change in a substrate, which can be measured spectrophotometrically. Alternatively, the enzyme may alter the fluorescence or chemiluminescence of the substrate. Techniques for quantifying a change in fluorescence are described above. The chemiluminescent substrate becomes electronically excited by a chemical reaction and may then emit light which can be measured (using a chemiluminometer, for example) or donates energy to a fluorescent acceptor. Examples of enzymatic labels include luciferases (e.g., firefly luciferase and bacterial luciferase; U.S. Pat. No. 4,737,456), luciferin, 2,3-dihydrophthalazinediones, malate dehydrogenase, urease, peroxidase such as horseradish peroxidase (HRPO), alkaline phosphatase, .beta.-galactosidase, glucoamylase, lysozyme, saccharide oxidases (e.g., glucose oxidase, galactose oxidase, and glucose-6-phosphate dehydrogenase), heterocyclic oxidases (such as uricase and xanthine oxidase), lactoperoxidase, microperoxidase, and the like. Techniques for conjugating enzymes to antibodies are described in O'Sullivan et al., Methods for the Preparation of Enzyme-Antibody Conjugates for Use in Enzyme Immunoassay, in Methods in Enzyme. (Ed. J. Langone & H. Van Vunakis), Academic press, New York, 73: 147-166 (1981).
  • Sometimes, the label is indirectly conjugated with the antibody. The skilled artisan will be aware of various techniques for achieving this. For example, the antibody can be conjugated with biotin and any of the three broad categories of labels mentioned above can be conjugated with avidin, or vice versa. Biotin binds selectively to avidin and thus, the label can be conjugated with the antibody in this indirect manner. Alternatively, to achieve indirect conjugation of the label with the antibody, the antibody is conjugated with a small hapten (e.g. digloxin) and one of the different types of labels mentioned above is conjugated with an anti-hapten antibody (e.g. anti-digloxin antibody). Thus, indirect conjugation of the label with the antibody can be achieved.
  • In another embodiment of the invention, the antibody need not be labeled, and the presence thereof can be detected using a labeled antibody, which binds to the antibody.
  • The antibodies of the present invention may be employed in any known assay method, such as competitive binding assays, direct and indirect sandwich assays, and immunoprecipitation assays. Zola, Monoclonal Antibodies: A Manual of Techniques, pp. 147-158 (CRC Press, Inc. 1987).
  • The biological samples can then be tested directly for the presence of LCAT by assays (e.g., ELISA or radioimmunoassay) and format (e.g., microwells, dipstick (e.g., as described in International Patent Publication WO 93/03367), etc). Alternatively, proteins in the sample can be size separated (e.g., by polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis (PAGE)), in the presence or absence of sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS), and the presence of LCAT detected by immunoblotting (e.g., Western blotting). Immunoblotting techniques are generally more effective with antibodies generated against a peptide corresponding to an epitope of a protein, and hence, are particularly suited to the present invention.
  • Antibody binding is detected by techniques known in the art (e.g., radioimmunoassay, ELISA (enzyme-linked immunosorbant assay), “sandwich” immunoassays, immunoradiometric assays, gel diffusion precipitation reactions, immunodiffusion assays, in situ immunoassays (e.g., using colloidal gold, enzyme or radioisotope labels, for example), Western blots, precipitation reactions, agglutination assays (e.g., gel agglutination assays, hemagglutination assays, etc.), complement fixation assays, immunofluorescence assays, protein A assays, and immunoelectrophoresis assays, etc.
  • In one embodiment, antibody binding is detected by detecting a label on the primary antibody. In another embodiment, the primary antibody is detected by detecting binding of a secondary antibody or reagent to the primary antibody. In a further embodiment, the secondary antibody is labeled. Many means are known in the art for detecting binding in an immunoassay and are within the scope of the present invention. As is well known in the art, the immunogenic peptide should be provided free of the carrier molecule used in any immunization protocol. For example, if the peptide was conjugated to KLH, it may be conjugated to BSA, or used directly, in a screening assay. In some embodiments, an automated detection assay is utilized. Methods for the automation of immunoassays are well known in the art (See e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,885,530, 4,981,785, 6,159,750, and 5,358,691, each of which is herein incorporated by reference). In some embodiments, the analysis and presentation of results is also automated. For example, in some embodiments, software that generates a prognosis based on the presence or absence of a series of antigens is utilized.
  • Competitive binding assays rely on the ability of a labeled standard to compete with the test sample for binding with a limited amount of antibody. The amount of antigen in the test sample is inversely proportional to the amount of standard that becomes bound to the antibodies. To facilitate determining the amount of standard that becomes bound, the antibodies generally are insolubilized before or after the competition. As a result, the standard and test sample that are bound to the antibodies may conveniently be separated from the standard and test sample, which remain unbound.
  • Sandwich assays involve the use of two antibodies, each capable of binding to a different immunogenic portion, or epitope, or the protein to be detected. In a sandwich assay, the test sample to be analyzed is bound by a first antibody, which is immobilized on a solid support, and thereafter a second antibody binds to the test sample, thus forming an insoluble three-part complex. See e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,376,110. The second antibody may itself be labeled with a detectable moiety (direct sandwich assays) or may be measured using an anti-immunoglobulin antibody that is labeled with a detectable moiety (indirect sandwich assay). For example, one type of sandwich assay is an ELISA assay, in which case the detectable moiety is an enzyme.
  • The antibodies may also be used for in vivo diagnostic assays. Generally, the antibody is labeled with a radionucleotide (such as .111In 99Tc, 14C, 131I, 3H, 32P or 35S) so that the tumor can be localized using immunoscintiography. In one embodiment, antibodies or fragments thereof bind to the extracellular domains of two or more LCAT targets and the affinity value(Kd) is less than 1×108 M.
  • Antibodies for diagnostic use may be labeled with probes suitable for detection by various imaging methods. Methods for detection of probes include, but are not limited to, fluorescence, light, confocal and electron microscopy; magnetic resonance imaging and spectroscopy; fluoroscopy, computed tomography and positron emission tomography. Suitable probes include, but are not limited to, fluorescein, rhodamine, eosin and other fluorophores, radioisotopes, gold, gadolinium and other lanthanides, paramagnetic iron, fluorine-18 and other positron-emitting radionuclides. Additionally, probes may be bi- or multi-functional and be detectable by more than one of the methods listed. These antibodies may be directly or indirectly labeled with said probes. Attachment of probes to the antibodies includes covalent attachment of the probe, incorporation of the probe into the antibody, and the covalent attachment of a chelating compound for binding of probe, amongst others well recognized in the art.
  • For immunohistochemistry, the disease tissue sample may be fresh or frozen or may be embedded in paraffin and fixed with a preservative such as formalin (see Example). The fixed or embedded section contains the sample are contacted with a labeled primary antibody and secondary antibody, wherein the antibody is used to detect the LCAT protein express in situ. The detailed procedure is shown in the Example.
  • Array:
  • Array technologies and quantitative PCR provide the means to explore the expression profiles of a large number of related or unrelated genes, and proteins. When an expression profile is examined, arrays provide a platform for examining which genes or proteins are tissue-specific, carrying out housekeeping functions, parts of a signaling cascade, or specifically related to a particular genetic predisposition, condition, disease, or disorder. The potential application of gene or protein expression profiling is particularly relevant to improving diagnosis, prognosis, and treatment of disease. For example, both the sequences and the amount of expression can be compared between tissues from subjects with different types of lung diseases and cytologically normal healthy tissue.
  • “Array” refers to an ordered arrangement of at least two transcripts, proteins or peptides, or antibodies on a substrate. At least one of the transcripts, proteins, or antibodies represents a control or standard, and the other transcript, protein, or antibody is of diagnostic or therapeutic interest. The arrangement of at least two and up to about 40,000 transcripts, proteins, or antibodies on the substrate assures that the size and signal intensity of each labeled complex, formed between each transcript and at least one nucleic acid, each protein and at least one ligand or antibody, or each antibody and at least one protein to which the antibody specifically binds, is individually distinguishable.
  • An “expression profile” is a representation of gene expression in a sample. A nucleic acid expression profile is produced using sequencing, hybridization, or amplification technologies using transcripts from a sample. A protein expression profile, although time delayed, minors the nucleic acid expression profile and is produced using gel electrophoresis, mass spectrometry, or an array and labeling moieties or antibodies which specifically bind the protein. The nucleic acids, proteins, or antibodies specifically binding the protein may be used in solution or attached to a substrate, and their detection is based on methods well known in the art.
  • A substrate includes but not limited to, paper, nylon or other type of membrane, filter, chip, glass slide, or any other suitable solid support.
  • The invention also provides an array with a cDNA or transcript encoding LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof, antibodies which specifically bind LCAT proteins, peptides or fragments thereof. Preferably, two or more of the nucleic acid molecules (e.g., SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120), proteins (e.g., SEQ ID NOS:1-1154) or peptides (e.g., SEQ ID NOS:2121-2525) are immobilized on a substrate.
  • The present invention also provides an antibody array. Antibody arrays have allowed the development of techniques for high-throughput screening of recombinant antibodies. Such methods use robots to pick and grid bacteria containing antibody genes, and a filter-based ELISA to screen and identify clones that express antibody fragments. Because liquid handling is eliminated and the clones are arrayed from master stocks, the same antibodies can be spotted multiple times and screened against multiple antigens simultaneously. For more information, see de Wildt et al. (2000) Nat Biotechnol 18:989-94.
  • The array is prepared and used according to the methods described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,837,832, Chee et al., PCT application WO95/11995 (Chee et al.), Lockhart, D. J. et al. (1996; Nat. Biotech. 14: 1675-1680) and Schena, M. et al. (1996; Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. 93: 10614-10619), U.S. Pat. No. 5,807,522, Brown et al., all of which are incorporated herein in their entirety by reference.
  • In one embodiment, a nucleic acid array or a microarray, preferably composed of a large number of unique, single-stranded nucleic acid sequences, usually either synthetic antisense oligonucleotides or fragments of cDNAs, fixed to a solid support. The oligonucleotides are preferably about 6-60 nucleotides in length, more preferably 15-30 nucleotides in length, and most preferably about 20-25 nucleotides in length.
  • In order to produce oligonucleotides to a known sequence for an array, the gene(s) of interest (or an ORF identified from the contigs of the present invention) is typically examined using a computer algorithm which starts at the 5′ or at the 3′ end of the nucleotide sequence. Typical algorithms will then identify oligomers of defined length that are unique to the gene, have a GC content within a range suitable for hybridization, and lack predicted secondary structure that may interfere with hybridization. In certain situations it may be appropriate to use pairs of oligonucleotides on an array. The “pairs” will be identical, except for one nucleotide that preferably is located in the center of the sequence. The second oligonucleotide in the pair (mismatched by one) serves as a control. The number of oligonucleotide pairs may range from two to one million. The oligomers are synthesized at designated areas on a substrate using a light-directed chemical process, wherein the substrate may be paper, nylon or other type of membrane, filter, chip, glass slide or any other suitable solid support as described above.
  • In another aspect, an oligonucleotide may be synthesized on the surface of the substrate by using a chemical coupling procedure and an ink jet application apparatus, as described in PCT application WO95/251116 (Baldeschweiler et al.) which is incorporated herein in its entirety by reference.
  • A gene expression profile comprises the expression of a plurality of transcripts as measured by after hybridization with a sample. The transcripts of the invention may be used as elements on an array to produce a gene expression profile. In one embodiment, the array is used to diagnose or monitor the progression of disease. Researchers can assess and catalog the differences in gene expression between healthy and diseased tissues or cells.
  • For example, the transcript or probe may be labeled by standard methods and added to a biological sample from a patient under conditions for the formation of hybridization complexes. After an incubation period, the sample is washed and the amount of label (or signal) associated with hybridization complexes, is quantified and compared with a standard value. If complex formation in the patient sample is significantly altered (higher or lower) in comparison to either a normal or disease standard, then differential expression indicates the presence of a disorder.
  • In order to provide standards for establishing differential expression, normal and disease expression profiles are established. This is accomplished by combining a sample taken from normal subjects, either animal or human or nonmammal, with a transcript under conditions for hybridization to occur. Standard hybridization complexes may be quantified by comparing the values obtained using normal subjects with values from an experiment in which a known amount of a purified sequence is used. Standard values obtained in this manner may be compared with values obtained from samples from patients who were diagnosed with a particular condition, disease, or disorder. Deviation from standard values toward those associated with a particular disorder is used to diagnose that disorder.
  • By analyzing changes in patterns of gene expression, disease can be diagnosed at earlier stages before the patient is symptomatic. The invention can be used to formulate a prognosis and to design a treatment regimen. The invention can also be used to monitor the efficacy of treatment. For treatments with known side effects, the array is employed to improve the treatment regimen. A dosage is established that causes a change in genetic expression patterns indicative of successful treatment. Expression patterns associated with the onset of undesirable side effects are avoided.
  • In another embodiment, animal models which mimic a human disease can be used to characterize expression profiles associated with a particular condition, disease, or disorder; or treatment of the condition, disease, or disorder. Novel treatment regimens may be tested in these animal models using arrays to establish and then follow expression profiles over time. In addition, arrays may be used with cell cultures or tissues removed from animal models to rapidly screen large numbers of candidate drug molecules, looking for ones that produce an expression profile similar to those of known therapeutic drugs, with the expectation that molecules with the same expression profile will likely have similar therapeutic effects. Thus, the invention provides the means to rapidly determine the molecular mode of action of a drug.
  • Such assays may also be used to evaluate the efficacy of a particular therapeutic treatment regimen in animal studies or in clinical trials or to monitor the treatment of an individual patient. Once the presence of a condition is established and a treatment protocol is initiated, diagnostic assays may be repeated on a regular basis to determine if the level of expression in the patient begins to approximate that which is observed in a normal subject. The results obtained from successive assays may be used to show the efficacy of treatment over a period ranging from several days to years.
  • Treatment
  • The following terms, as used in the present specification and claims, are intended to have the meaning as defined below, unless indicated otherwise.
  • “Treat,” “treating” or “treatment” of a disease includes: (1) inhibiting the disease, i.e., arresting or reducing the development of the disease or its clinical symptoms, or (2) relieving the disease, i.e., causing regression of the disease or its clinical symptoms.
  • A “therapeutically effective amount” means the amount of an agent that, when administered to a subject for treating a disease, is sufficient to effect such treatment for the disease. The “therapeutically effective amount” will vary depending on the agent, the disease and its severity and the age, weight, etc., of the subject to be treated.
  • A “lung disease” includes lung cancer, lung tumor (exocrine or endocrine), lung cysts as well as lung trauma; preferably lung cancer.
  • A “cancer” is epithelial-cell related cancers. For example, pancreatic, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian, breast as well as bladder and renal cancer.
  • The present invention provides an application of treatment by using antibody, immunogenic peptides as well as other LCAT agonists or antagonists.
  • LCATs are proteins differentially expressed in the lung diseases cell lines or tissues. The proteins are either cell surface proteins, cytosolic proteins, or secreted proteins (see the list in Table 2). These proteins are associated with the diseases especially lung diseases, particularly lung cancer; thus, they serve as candidate targets for the treatment of the diseases.
  • In one embodiment, when decreased expression or activity of the protein is desired, an inhibitor, antagonist, antibody and the like or a pharmaceutical agent containing one or more of these molecules may be delivered. Such delivery may be effected by methods well known in the art and may include delivery by an antibody specifically targeted to the protein. Neutralizing antibodies, which inhibit dimer formation, are generally preferred for therapeutic use.
  • In another embodiment, when increased expression or activity of the protein is desired, the protein, an agonist, an enhancer and the like or a pharmaceutical agent containing one or more of these molecules may be delivered. Such delivery may be effected by methods well known in the art and may include delivery of a pharmaceutical agent by an antibody specifically targeted to the protein.
  • Any of the transcripts, complementary molecules, or fragments thereof, proteins or portions thereof, vectors delivering these nucleic acid molecules or expressing the proteins, and their ligands may be administered in combination with other therapeutic agents. Selection of the agents for use in combination therapy may be made by one of ordinary skill in the art according to conventional pharmaceutical principles. A combination of therapeutic agents may act synergistically to affect treatment of a particular disorder at a lower dosage of each agent.
  • Antibody Therapy
  • The antibody of the present invention can be used for therapeutic reason. It is contemplated that the antibody of the present invention may be used to treat a mammal, preferably human with lung diseases.
  • In general, the antibodies are also useful for inhibiting protein function, for example, blocking the binding of the LCAT protein or peptide to a binding partner such as a substrate. These uses can also be applied in a therapeutic context in which treatment involves inhibiting the protein's function. An antibody can be used, for example, to block binding, thus modulating (agonizing or antagonizing) the peptides activity. Antibodies can be prepared against specific fragments containing sites required for function or against intact protein that is associated within a cell or cell membrane. The function blocking assays are provided in detail in the Examples.
  • The antibodies of present invention can also be used as means of enhancing the immune response. The antibodies can be administered in amounts similar to those used for other therapeutic administrations of antibody. For example, pooled gamma globulin is administered at a range of about 1 mg to about 100 mg per patient. Thus, antibodies reactive with the protein or peptides of LCAT can be passively administered alone or in conjunction with other anti-cancer therapies to a mammal afflicted-with lung diseases or cancer. Examples of anti-cancer therapies include, but are not limited to, chemotherapy, radiation therapy, adoptive immunotherapy therapy with TIL (Tumor Infiltration Lymphocytes).
  • The selection of an antibody subclass for therapy will depend upon the nature of the disease tumor antigen. For example, an IgM may be preferred in situations where the antigen is highly specific for the diseased target and rarely occurs on normal cells. However, where the disease-associated antigen is also expressed in normal tissues, although at much lower levels, the IgG subclass may be preferred for the following reason: since the binding of at least two IgG molecules in close proximity is required to activate complement, less complement mediated damage may occur in the normal tissues which express smaller amounts of the antigen and, therefore, bind fewer IgG antibody molecules. Furthermore, IgG molecules by being smaller may be more able than IgM molecules to localize to the diseased tissue.
  • The mechanism for antibody therapy is that the therapeutic antibody recognizes a cell surface protein, cytosolic protein, or a secreted protein that is overexpressed in diseased cells. By NK cell or complement activation, conjugation of the antibody with an immunotoxin or radiolabel, the interaction can abrogate ligand/receptor interaction or activation of apoptosis.
  • The potential mechanisms of antibody-mediated cytotoxicity of diseased cells are phagocyte (antibody dependent cellular cytotoxicity (ADCC)) (see Example), complement (Complement-mediated cytotoxicity (CMC)) (see Example), naked antibody (receptor cross-linking apoptosis and growth factor inhibition), or targeted payload labeled with radionuclide or immunotoxins or immunochemotherapeutics.
  • In one embodiment, the antibody is administered to a nonhuman mammal for the purposes of obtaining preclinical data, for example. Exemplary nonhuman mammals to be treated include nonhuman primates, dogs, cats, rodents and other mammals in which preclinical studies are performed. Such mammals may be established animal models for a disease to be treated with the antibody or may be used to study toxicity of the antibody of interest. In each of these embodiments, dose escalation studies may be performed on the mammal.
  • The antibody is administered by any suitable means, including parenteral, subcutaneous, intraperitoneal, intrapulmonary, and intranasal, and, if desired for local immunosuppressive treatment, intralesional administration. Parenteral infusions include intramuscular, intravenous, intraarterial, intraperitoneal, or subcutaneous administration. In addition, the antibody variant is suitably administered by pulse infusion, particularly with declining doses of the antibody variant. Preferably the dosing is given by injections, most preferably intravenous or subcutaneous injections, depending in part on whether the administration is brief or chronic.
  • For the prevention or treatment of a disease, the appropriate dosage of the antibody will depend on the type of disease to be treated, the severity and the course of the disease, whether the antibody is administered for preventive or therapeutic purposes, previous therapy, the patient's clinical history and response to the antibody, and the discretion of the attending physician.
  • Depending on the type and severity of the disease, about 1 .mu.g/kg to 150 mg/kg (e.g., 0.1-20 mg/kg) of antibody is an initial candidate dosage for administration to the patient, whether, for example, by one or more separate administrations, or by continuous infusion. A typical daily dosage might range from about 1 .mu.g/kg to 100 mg/kg or more, depending on the factors mentioned above. For repeated administrations over several days or longer, depending on the condition, the treatment is sustained until a desired suppression of disease symptoms occurs. However, other dosage regimens may be useful. The progress of this therapy is easily monitored by conventional techniques and assays.
  • The antibody composition will be formulated, dosed and administered in a manner consistent with good medical practice. Factors for consideration in this context include the particular disorder being treated, the particular mammal being treated, the clinical condition of the individual patient, the cause of the disorder, the site of delivery of the agent, the method of administration, the scheduling of administration, and other factors known to medical practitioners.
  • The therapeutically effective amount of the antibody to be administered will be governed by such considerations, and is the minimum amount necessary to prevent, ameliorate, or treat a disease or disorder. The antibody need not be, but is optionally formulated with one or more agents currently used to prevent or treat the disorder in question.
  • Antibodies of the present invention may also be used as therapeutic reagents, to diminish or eliminate cancer or tumors. For example, the antibodies may be used on their own (for instance, to inhibit metastases) or coupled to one or more therapeutic agents. Suitable agents in this regard include radionuclides, differentiation inducers, drugs, toxins, and derivatives thereof. Preferred radionuclides include 90Y, 123I, 125I, 131I, 186Re, 188Re, 212Bi. Preferred drugs include methotrexate, and pyrimidine and purine analogs. Preferred differentiation inducers include phorbol esters and butyric acid. Preferred toxins include ricin, abrin, diptheria toxin, cholera toxin, gelonin, Pseudomonas exotoxin, Shigella toxin, and pokeweed antiviral protein
  • A therapeutic agent may be coupled (e.g., covalently bonded) to a suitable monoclonal antibody either directly or indirectly (e.g., via a linker group). A direct reaction between an agent and an antibody is possible when each possesses a substituent capable of reacting with the other. For example, a nucleophilic group, such as an amino or sulfhydryl group, on one may be capable of reacting with a carbonyl-containing group, such as an anhydride or an acid halide, or with an alkyl group containing a good leaving group (e.g., a halide) on the other.
  • Alternatively, it may be desirable to couple a therapeutic agent and an antibody via a linker group. A linker group can function as a spacer to distance an antibody from an agent in order to avoid interference with binding capabilities. A linker group can also serve to increase the chemical reactivity of a substituent on an agent or an antibody, and thus increase the coupling efficiency. An increase in chemical reactivity may also facilitate the use of agents, or functional groups on agents, which otherwise would not be possible.
  • It will be evident to those skilled in the art that a variety of bifunctional or polyfunctional reagents, both homo- and hetero-functional (such as those described in the catalog of the Pierce Chemical Co., Rockford, Ill.), may be employed as the linker group. Coupling may be affected, for example, through amino groups, carboxyl groups, sulfhydryl groups or oxidized carbohydrate residues. There are numerous references describing such methodology, e.g. U.S. Pat. No. 4,671,958, to Rodwell et al.
  • Where a therapeutic agent is more potent when free from the antibody portion of the immunoconjugates of the present invention, it may be desirable to use a linker group which is cleavable during or upon internalization into a cell. A number of different cleavable linker groups have been described. The mechanisms for the intracellular release of an agent from these linker groups include cleavage by reduction of a disulfide bond (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,489,710, to Spitler), by irradiation of a photolabile bond (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,625,014, to Senter et al.), by hydrolysis of derivatized amino acid side chains (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,638,045, to Kohn et al.), by serum complement-mediated hydrolysis (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,671,958, to Rodwell et al.), and acid-catalyzed hydrolysis (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,569,789, to Blattler et al.).
  • It may be desirable to couple more than one agent to an antibody. In one embodiment, multiple molecules of an agent are coupled to one antibody molecule. In another embodiment, more than one type of agent may be coupled to one antibody. Regardless of the particular embodiment, immunoconjugates with more than one agent may be prepared in a variety of ways as described above.
  • While it is possible for the immunogen to be administered in a pure or substantially pure form, it is preferable to present it as a pharmaceutical composition, formulation or preparation with a carrier.
  • The formulations of the present invention, both for veterinary and for human use, comprise an immunogen as described above, together with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and, optionally, other therapeutic ingredients. The carrier(s) must be “acceptable” in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not deleterious to the recipient thereof. The formulations may conveniently be presented in unit dosage form and may be prepared by any method well-known in the pharmaceutical art.
  • Suitable pharmaceutical carriers include proteins such as albumins (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,507,234, to Kato et al.), peptides and polysaccharides such as aminodextran (e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,699,784, to Shih et al.), or water. A carrier may also bear an agent by noncovalent bonding or by encapsulation, such as within a liposome vesicle (e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,429,008 and 4,873,088). Carriers specific for radionuclide agents include radiohalogenated small molecules and chelating compounds. For example, U.S. Pat. No. 4,735,792 discloses representative radiohalogenated small molecules and their synthesis. A radionuclide chelate may be formed from chelating compounds that include those containing nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the donor atoms for binding the metal, metal oxide, radionuclide. For example, U.S. Pat. No. 4,673,562, to Davison et al. discloses representative chelating compounds and their synthesis.
  • All methods include the step of bringing into association the active ingredient with the carrier, which constitutes one or more accessory ingredients. In general, the formulations are prepared by uniformly and intimately bringing into association the active ingredient with liquid carriers or finely divided solid carriers or both, and then, if necessary, shaping the product into the desired formulation.
  • Formulations suitable for intravenous intramuscular, subcutaneous, or intraperitoneal administration conveniently comprise sterile aqueous solutions of the active ingredient with solutions, which are preferably isotonic with the blood of the recipient. Such formulations may be conveniently prepared by dissolving solid active ingredient in water containing physiologically compatible substances such as sodium chloride (e.g. 0.1-2.0M), glycine, and the like, and having a buffered pH compatible with physiological conditions to produce an aqueous solution, and rendering said solution sterile. These may be present in unit or multi-dose containers, for example, sealed ampoules or vials.
  • The formulations of the present invention may incorporate a stabilizer. Illustrative stabilizers are polyethylene glycol, proteins, saccharides, amino acids, inorganic acids, and organic acids, which may be used either on their own or as admixtures. These stabilizers are preferably incorporated in an amount of 0.11-10,000 parts by weight per part by weight of immunogen. If two or more stabilizers are to be used, their total amount is preferably within the range specified above. These stabilizers are used in aqueous solutions at the appropriate concentration and pH. The specific osmotic pressure of such aqueous solutions is generally in the range of 0.1-3.0 osmoles, preferably in the range of 0.8-1.2. The pH of the aqueous solution is adjusted to be within the range of 5.0-9.0, preferably within the range of 6-8. In formulating the antibody of the present invention, anti-adsorption agent may be used.
  • Additional pharmaceutical methods may be employed to control the duration of action. Controlled release preparations may be achieved through the use of polymer to complex or absorb the proteins or their derivatives. The controlled delivery may be exercised by selecting appropriate macromolecules (for example polyester, polyamino acids, polyvinyl, pyrrolidone, ethylenevinylacetate, methylcellulose, carboxymethylcellulose, or protamine sulfate) and the concentration of macromolecules as well as the methods of incorporation in order to control release. Another possible method to control the duration of action by controlled-release preparations is to incorporate the LCAT antibody into particles of a polymeric material such as polyesters, polyamino acids, hydrogels, poly(lactic acid) or ethylene vinylacetate copolymers. Alternatively, instead of incorporating these agents into polymeric particles, it is possible to entrap these materials in microcapsules prepared, for example, by coacervation techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example, hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and poly(methylmethacylate) microcapsules, respectively, or in colloidal drug delivery systems, for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nanoparticles, and nanocapsules or in macroemulsions.
  • When oral preparations are desired, the compositions may be combined with typical carriers, such as lactose, sucrose, starch, talc magnesium stearate, crystalline cellulose, methyl cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose, glycerin, sodium alginate or gum arabic among others.
  • The therapeutic antibody may be supplied in the form of a kit, alone, or in the form of a pharmaceutical composition as described above.
  • Other Immunotherapy
  • The LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof of this invention are also intended for use in producing antiserum designed for pre- or post-disease prophylaxis. Here the protein, peptides or fragment thereof, is formulated with a suitable adjuvant and administered by injection to human volunteers, according to known methods for producing human antisera. Antibody response to the injected proteins is monitored, during a several-week period following immunization, by periodic serum sampling to detect the presence of antiserum antibodies, using an immunoassay as described herein.
  • The antiserum from immunized individuals may be administered as a prophylactic measure for individuals who are at risk of developing lung diseases or cancer. The antiserum is also useful in treating an individual afflicted with lung diseases or cancer for post-disease prophylaxis.
  • Alternatively, peptides derived form the LCAT protein sequence may be modified to increase their immunogenicity by enhancing binding of the peptide to the MHC molecules in which the peptide is presented. The peptide or modified peptide may be conjugated to a carrier molecule to enhance the antigenicity of the peptide. Examples of carrier molecules, include, but are not limited to, human albumin, bovine albumin, lipoprotein and keyhole limpet hemo-cyanin (“Basic and Clinical Immunology” (1991) Stites, D. P. and Terr A. I. (eds) Appleton and Lange, Norwalk Conn., San Mateo, Calif.).
  • An “immunogenic peptide” is a peptide, which comprises an allele-specific motif such that the peptide will bind the MHC allele (HLA in human) and be capable of inducing a CTL (cytoxic T-lymphocytes) response. Thus, immunogenic peptides are capable of binding to an appropriate class I or II MHC molecule and inducing a cytotoxic T cell or T helper cell response against the antigen from which the immunogenic peptide is derived.
  • Alternatively, amino acid sequence variants of the peptide can be prepared by mutations in the DNA, which encodes the peptide, or by peptide synthesis.
  • At the genetic level, these variants ordinarily are prepared by site-directed mutagenesis of nucleotides in the DNA encoding the peptide molecule, thereby producing DNA encoding the variant, and thereafter expressing the DNA in recombinant cell culture. The variants typically exhibit the same qualitative biological activity as the nonvariant peptide.
  • T-lymphocytes recognize antigen in association with Class I or Class II MHC molecules in the form of a peptide fragment bound to an MHC molecule. The degree of peptide binding to a given MHC allele is based on amino acids at particular positions within the peptide (Parker et al. (1992) Journal of Immunology 149:3580; Kubo, et al. (1994) Journal of Immunology 52:3913-3924; Ruppert J. et al. (1993) Cell 74:929-937; Falk et al. (1991) Nature 351:290-296). The peptides of the present invention are useful as an epitope for immunogenic response (see more detailed description below).
  • In human, MHC is called HLA, wherein class I molecules are encoded by the HLA-A, B, and C loci. HLA-A and B antigens are expressed at the cell surface at approximately equal densities, whereas the expression of HLA-C is significantly lower (about 10-fold lower). Each of these loci has a number of alleles. MHC class II molecules are encoded by three pairs of MHC II alpha- and beta-chain genes, called HLA DR, -DP, and -DQ in human. In many haplotypes the HLA-DR cluster contains an extra beta-chain gene whose product can pair with the DR alpha chain. Each MHC class I and II molecule binds a different rage of peptides. The present of several loci means that any one individual is equipped to present a much broader ranger of different peptides than if only one MHC protein of each class were expressed at the cell surface. The peptide binding motifs of the present invention are designed to be specific for each allelic subtype.
  • The peptides of the present invention are used for treatment of the lung diseases. Treatment involves administration of the protective composition after the appearance of the disease.
  • The present invention is also applied to prevent and suppress the disease. It is not always possible to distinguish between “preventing” and “suppressing” since the ultimate inductive event or events may be unknown, latent, or the patient is not ascertained until well after the occurrence of the event or events. Therefore, it is common to use the term “prophylaxis” as distinct from “treatment” to encompass both “preventing” and “suppressing” as defined herein. The term “protection,” as used herein, is meant to include “prophylaxis.”
  • The peptides are used for treating T cell-mediated pathology. The term “T cell-mediated pathology” refers to any condition in which an inappropriate T cell response is a component of the pathology. The term is intended to encompass both T cell mediated lung diseases and diseases resulting from unregulated clonal T cell replication.
  • Therefore, the present invention relates to peptides or modified peptides derived from the protein sequences of the LCAT proteins that differentially expressed in the lung diseases. By way of example, modification may include substitution, deletion or addition of an amino acid in the given immunogenic peptide sequence or mutation of existing amino acids within the given immunogenic peptide sequence, or derivatization of existing amino acids within the given immunogenic peptide sequence. Any amino acid comprising the immunogenic peptide sequence may be modified in accordance with this invention. In one aspect, at least one amino acid is substituted or replaced within the given immunogenic peptide sequence. Any amino acid may be used to substitute or replace a given amino acid within the immunogenic peptide sequence. Modified peptides are intended to include any immunogenic peptide obtained from differentially expressed proteins, which has been modified and exhibits enhanced binding to the MHC molecule with which it associates when presented to the T-cell. These modified peptides may be synthetically or recombinantly produced by conventional methods.
  • In another embodiment, the peptides of the present invention comprise, or consisting sequences of about 5-8, 8-10, 10-15 or 15-30 amino acids which are immunogenic, that is, capable of inducing an immune response when injected into a subject.
  • The recombinant or natural protein, peptides, or fragment thereof of LCAT, or modified peptides, may be used as a vaccine either prophylactically or therapeutically. When provided prophylactically the vaccine is provided in advance of any evidence of lung diseases, particularly, cancer. The prophylactic administration of the lung diseases vaccine should serve to prevent or attenuate lung diseases, preferably cancer, in a mammal.
  • Preparation of vaccine is using recombinant protein or peptide expression vectors comprising all or part of nucleic acid sequence of LCAT proteins encoding peptides. Examples of vectors that may be used in the aforementioned vaccines include, but are not limited to, defective retroviral vectors, adenoviral vectors vaccinia viral vectors, fowl pox viral vectors, or other viral vectors (Mulligan, R. C., (1993) Science 260:926-932). The viral vectors carrying all or part of nucleic sequence of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 can be introduced into a mammal either prior to any evidence of lung diseases or to mediate regression of the disease in a mammal afflicted with lung diseases. Examples of methods for administering the viral vector into the mammals include, but are not limited to, exposure of cells to the virus ex vivo, or injection of the retrovirus or a producer cell line of the virus into the affected tissue or intravenous administration of the virus. Alternatively the viral vector carrying all or part of the LCAT nucleic acid sequence that encode peptides may be administered locally by direct injection into the cancer lesion or topical application in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The quantity of viral vector, carrying all or part of the LCAT nucleic acid sequence, to be administered is based on the titer of virus particles. A preferred range of the immunogen to be administered may be about 106 to about 1011 virus particles per mammal, preferably a human. After immunization the efficacy of the vaccine can be assessed by production of antibodies or immune cells that recognize the antigen, as assessed by specific lytic activity or specific cytokine production or by tumor regression. One skilled in the art would know the conventional methods to assess the aforementioned parameters. If the mammal to be immunized is already afflicted with cancer, the vaccine can be administered in conjunction with other therapeutic treatments. Examples of other therapeutic treatments includes, but are not limited to, adoptive T cell immunotherapy, coadministration of cytokines or other therapeutic drugs for cancer.
  • Alternatively all or parts thereof of a substantially or partially purified the LCAT protein or their peptides may be administered as a vaccine in a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Ranges of the protein that may be administered are about 0.001 to about 100 mg per patient, preferred doses are about 0.01 to about 100 mg per patient. In a preferred embodiment, the peptides or modified peptides thereof is administered therapeutically or prophylactically to a mammal in need of such treatment. The peptide may be synthetically or recombinantly produced. Immunization is repeated as necessary, until a sufficient titer of anti-immunogen antibody or immune cells has been obtained.
  • In yet another alternative embodiment a viral vector, such as a retroviral vector, can be introduced into mammalian cells. Examples of mammalian cells into which the retroviral vector can be introduced include, but are not limited to, primary mammalian cultures or continuous mammalian cultures, COS cells, NIH3T3, or 293 cells (ATTC #CRL 1573), dendritic cells. The means by which the vector carrying the gene may be introduced into a cell includes, but is not limited to, microinjection, electroporation, transfection or transfection using DEAE dextran, lipofection, calcium phosphate or other procedures known to one skilled in the art (Sambrook et al. (EDS) (2001) in “Molecular Cloning. A laboratory manual”, Cold Spring Harbor Press Plainview, N.Y.).
  • The vaccine formulation of the present invention comprises an immunogen that induces an immune response directed against the cancer associated antigens such as the LCATs, and in nonhuman primates and finally in humans. The safety of the immunization procedures is determined by looking for the effect of immunization on the general health of the immunized animal (weight change, fever, appetite behavior etc.) and looking for pathological changes on autopsies. After initial testing in animals, cancer patients can be tested. Conventional methods would be used to evaluate the immune response of the patient to determine the efficiency of the vaccine.
  • Measurement of candidate disease tumor antigen or vaccine expression in patients is the first step of the present invention. Subsequent steps will focus on measuring immune responses to these candidate antigens or vaccine. Sera from disease patients, particularly cancer patients, and healthy donors will be screened for antibodies to the candidate antigens as well as for levels of circulating tumor derived antigens. antigen. The vaccine formulations may be evaluated first in animal models, initially rodents
  • In one embodiment mammals, preferably human, at high risk for lung diseases, particularly cancer, are prophylactically treated with the vaccines of this invention. Examples of such mammals include, but are not limited to, humans with a family history of lung diseases, humans with a history of lung diseases, particular cancer, or humans afflicted with lung cancer previously resected and therefore at risk for reoccurrence. When provided therapeutically, the vaccine is provided to enhance the patient's own immune response to the diseased antigen present on the lung diseases or advanced stage of lung diseases. The vaccine, which acts as an immunogen, may be a cell, cell lysate from cells transfected with a recombinant expression vector, cell lysates from cells transfected with a recombinant expression vector, or a culture supernatant containing the expressed protein. Alternatively, the immunogen is a partially or substantially purified recombinant protein, peptide or analog thereof or modified peptides or analogs thereof. The proteins or peptides may be conjugated with lipoprotein or administered in liposomal form or with adjuvant.
  • While it is possible for the immunogen to be administered in a pure or substantially pure form, it is preferable to present it as a pharmaceutical composition, formulation or preparation. The formulations of the present invention are described in the previous section.
  • Vaccination can be conducted by conventional methods. For example, the immunogen can be used in a suitable diluent such as saline or water, or complete or incomplete adjuvants. Further, the immunogen may or may not be bound to a carrier to make the protein immunogenic. Examples of such carrier molecules include but are not limited to bovine serum albumin (BSA), keyhole limpet hemocyanin (KLH), tetanus toxoid, and the like. The immunogen also may be coupled with lipoproteins or administered in liposomal form or with adjuvants. The immunogen can be administered by any route-appropriate for antibody production such as intravenous, intraperitoneal, intramuscular, subcutaneous, and the like. The immunogen may be administered once or at periodic intervals until a significant titer of anti-LCAT immune cells or anti-LCAT antibody is produced. The presence of anti-LCAT immune cells may be assessed by measuring the frequency of precursor CTL (cytoxic T-lymphocytes) against LCAT antigen prior to and after immunization by a CTL precursor analysis assay (Coulie, P. et al., (1992) International Journal Of Cancer 50:289-297). The antibody may be detected in the serum using the immunoassay described above.
  • The safety of the immunization procedures is determined by looking for the effect of immunization on the general health of the immunized animal (weight change, fever, appetite behavior etc.) and looking for pathological changes on autopsies. After initial testing in animals, lung diseases patients can be tested. Conventional methods would be used to evaluate the immune response of the patient to determine the efficiency of the vaccine.
  • In yet another embodiment of this invention all, part, or parts of the LCAT proteins or peptides or fragments thereof, or modified peptides, may be exposed to dendritic cells cultured in vitro. The cultured dendritic cells provide a means of producing T-cell dependent antigens comprised of dendritic cell modified antigen or dendritic cells pulsed with antigen, in which the antigen is processed and expressed on the antigen activated dendritic cell. The LCAT antigen activated dendritic cells or processed dendritic cell antigens may be used as immunogens for vaccines or for the treatment of lung diseases, particularly lung cancer. The dendritic cells should be exposed to antigen for sufficient time to allow the antigens to be internalized and presented on the dendritic cells surface. The resulting dendritic cells or the dendritic cell process antigens can than be administered to an individual in need of therapy. Such methods are described in Steinman et al. (WO93/208185) and in Banchereau et al. (EPO Application 0563485A1).
  • In yet another aspect of this invention T-cells isolated from individuals can be exposed to the LCAT proteins, peptides or fragment thereof, or modified peptides in vitro and then administered to a patient in need of such treatment in a therapeutically effective amount. Examples of where T-lymphocytes can be isolated include but are not limited to, peripheral blood cells lymphocytes (PBL), lymph nodes, or tumor infiltrating lymphocytes (TIL). Such lymphocytes can be isolated from the individual to be treated or from a donor by methods known in the art and cultured in vitro (Kawakami, Y. et al. (1989) J. Immunol. 142: 2453-3461). Lymphocytes are cultured in media such as RPMI or RPMI 1640 or AIM V for 1-10 weeks. Viability is assessed by trypan blue dye exclusion assay. Examples of how these sensitized T-cells can be administered to the mammal include but are not limited to, intravenously, intraperitoneally or intralesionally. Parameters that may be assessed to determine the efficacy of these sensitized T-lymphocytes include, but are not limited to, production of immune cells in the mammal being treated or tumor regression. Conventional methods are used to assess these parameters. Such treatment can be given in conjunction with cytokines or gene modified cells (Rosenberg, S. A. et al. (1992) Human Gene Therapy, 3: 75-90; Rosenberg, S. A. et al. (1992) Human Gene Therapy, 3: 57-73).
  • The present invention is further described by the following example. The example is provided solely to illustrate the invention by reference to specific embodiments. This exemplification, while illustrating certain aspects of the invention, does not offer the limitations or circumscribe the scope of the disclosed invention.
  • All examples outlined here were carried out using standard techniques, which are well known and routine to those of skill in the art. Routine molecular biology techniques of the following example can be carried out as described in standard laboratory manuals, such as Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A laboratory Manual, 3rd. ed., Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., (2001).
  • Working Examples 1. Lung Cancer Cell Line Model System; Tissue Processing
  • The model system employed here involves the use of Beas2B as a “normal” reference (i.e., control) to which cell surface expression in tumor derived cell lines is compared. These differentials or candidates are then validated in tissues, lung cancer and normal lung, to confirm that they are differentially expressed between these tissues as well as within the cell line model system.
  • Lung Cancer Cell Line Culture
  • Cell lines were grown in a culturing medium that is supplemented as necessary with growth factors and serum, in accordance with the American Type Culture Collection (ATCC) (Mannassas, Va.) guidelines for each particular cell line (the ATCC catalog number for each cell line is indicated in Table 1). Cultures were established from frozen stocks in which the cells were suspended in a freezing medium (cell culture medium with 10% DMSO [v/v]) and flash frozen in liquid nitrogen. Frozen stocks prepared in this way were stored in the liquid nitrogen vapour. Cell cultures were established by rapidly thawing frozen stocks at 37° C. Thawed stock cultures were slowly transferred to a culture vessel containing a large volume of culture medium that was supplemented. For maintenance of culture, cells were seeded at 1×105 cells/per ml in medium and incubated at 37° C. until confluence of cells in the culture vessel exceeds 50% by area. At this time, cells were harvested from the culture vessel using enzymes or EDTA where necessary. The density of harvested, viable cells was estimated by hemocytometry and the culture reseeded as above. A passage of this nature was repeated no more than 25 times at which point the culture was destroyed and reestablished from frozen stocks as described above.
  • For the analyses of cell surface protein expression in cultured cell lines, cells were grown as described above. At a period 24 h prior to the experiment, the cell line was passaged as described above. This yielded cell densities that were <50% confluent and growing exponentially. Typically, triplicate analyses of differential expression were performed for each line relative to Beas2B for the purpose of identifying statistically significant reproducible differentially expressed proteins.
  • Tissue Processing
  • Lung tumor and distal normal tissue is collected. Tissue specimens may be transported from surgery in Lung Transport Buffer (transportation time may be, e.g., about 12-16 hours). Lung Transport Buffer is composed of LHC-9 media supplemented with 1× penicillin-streptomycin-glutamine, 1× fungizone (BioFluids) and Protease Inhibitor Cocktail (Sigma). Upon arrival, tissues are imaged, weighed, and dimensions measured (L×W×H). Tumor tissue is dissected when necessary for removal of necrotic regions. Tissue is re-weighed post-dissection.
  • Tissue is crudely minced and incubated for 20-30 minutes with periodic agitation at 37° C. in Enzyme Combination #1 (200 units Collagenase, cat# C5894 Sigma; 126 ug DNAse I, cat#D4513 Sigma (in 10 mM Tris/HCl pH7.5); 50 mM NaCl; 10 mM MgCl2; 0.05% Elastase, cat# E7885 Sigma). D-PBS is added at 3 times the volume of the enzyme combination, the tissue finely minced, and disassociated cells passed through a 200 um filter. The cells are washed twice with D-PBS. Red blood cells are lysed with PharMLyse (BD Biosciences) when necessary. Cell number and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA). Cells at a total cell number greater than 20×106 are sorted using a high-speed sorter (MoFlo Cytomation) for epithelial cells (EpCAM positive).
  • The remaining undigested tissue is incubated for 20-30 minutes with periodic agitation at 37° C. in Enzyme Combination #2 (1× Liberase Blendzyme 1 cat# 988-417 Roche, 1× Liberase Blendzyme 3 cat#814-184 Roche, 0.05% Elastase cat# E7885 Sigma). D-PBS is added at 3 times the volume of the enzyme combination, and the tissue finely minced until tissue is completely disassociated. The cells are passed through a 200 um filter, washed twice with D-PBS, and pooled with cells from Enzyme Combination #1 digestion.
  • Cells are passed through a 70 um filter for single cell suspension and cell number and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA). When needed, red blood cells are lysed with PharMLyse (BD Biosciences). Cells are incubated in 20 ml of 1× PharMLyse in D-PBS for 30 seconds with gentle agitation and cells pelleted at 300×g for 5 minutes at 4° C. Cells are washed once in D-PBS and cell number and viability are recalculated by PI exclusion using the GUAVA. Cells at a total cell number greater than 20×106 are sorted using a high-speed sorter (MoFlo Cytomation) for epithelial cells (EpCAM positive).
  • 2. Cloning and Expression of Target Proteins
  • cDNA Retrieval
  • Peptide sequences were searched by BlastP against the Celera Discovery System (CDS) and public database to identify the corresponding full-length open reading frames (ORFs). Each ORF sequence was then searched by BlastN against the Celera in-house human cDNA clone collection. For each sequence of interest, up to three clones are pulled and streaked onto LB/Ampicillin (100 ug/ml) plates. Plasmid DNA is isolated using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and verified by restriction digest. Subsequently, the isolated plasmid DNA is sequence verified against the ORF reference sequence. Sequencing reactions are carried out using Applied Biosystems BigDye Terminator kit followed by ethanol precipitation. Sequence data is collected using the Applied Biosystems 3100 Genetic Analyzer and analyzed by alignment to the reference sequence using the Clone Manager alignment tool.
  • PCR
  • PCR primers are designed to amplify the full-length ORF as well as any regions of the ORF that are interest for expression (antigenic or hydrophilic regions as determined by the Clone Manager sequence analysis tool). Primers also contain 5′ and 3′ overhangs to facilitate cloning (see below). PCR reactions contain 2.5 units Platinum Taq DNA Polymerase High Fidelity (Invitrogen), 50 ng cDNA plasmid template, 1 uM forward and reverse primers, 800 uM dNTP cocktail (Applied Biosystems) and 2 mM MgSO4. After 20-30 cycles (94° C. for 30 seconds, 55° C. for 1 minutes and 73° C. for 2 minutes), product is verified and quantitated by agarose gel electrophoresis.
  • Construction of Entry Clones
  • PCR products are cloned into an entry vector for use with the Gateway recombination based cloning system (Invitrogen). These vectors include pDonr221, pDonr201, pEntr/D-TOPO or pEntr/SD/D-TOPO and are used as described in the cloning methods below.
  • TOPO Cloning into pEntr/D-TOPO or pEntr/SD/D-TOPO
  • For cloning using this method, the forward PCR primer contained a 5′ overhang containing the sequence “CACC”. PCR products are generated as described above and cloned into the entry vector using the Invitrogen TOPO cloning kit. Reactions are typically carried out at room temperature for 10 minutes and subsequently transformed into TOP10 chemically competent cells (Invitrogen, CA). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest. Inserts are subsequently sequence verified as described above.
  • Gateway Cloning into pDonr201 or pDonr221
  • For cloning using this method,
  • PCR primers contained the following overhangs:
  • Forward 5′ overhang:
    (SEQ ID NO: 2526)
    5′GGGGACAAGTTTGTACAAAAAAGCAGGCTTC-3′
    Reverse 5′ overhang:
    (SEQ ID NO: 2527)
    5′-GGGGACCACTTTGTACAAGAAAGCTGGGT-3′
  • PCR products are generated as described above. ORFs are recombined into the entry vector using the Invitrogen Gateway BP Clonase enzyme mix. Reactions are typically carried out at 25° C. for 1 hour, treated with Proteinase K at 37° C. for 10 minutes and transformed into Library Efficiency DH5α chemically competent cells (Invitrogen, CA). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest. Inserts are subsequently sequence verified as described above.
  • Construction of Expression Clones
  • ORFs are transferred from the entry construct into a series of expression vectors using the Gateway LR Clonase enzyme mix. Reactions are typically carried out for 1 hour at 25° C., treated with Proteinase K at 37° C. for 10 minutes and subsequently transformed into Library Efficiency DH5a chemically competent cells (Invitrogen). Candidate clones are picked, plasmid DNA is prepared using Qiagen spin mini-prep kit and screened using restriction digest. Expression vectors include but are not limited to pDest14, pDest15, pDest17, pDest8, pDest10 and pDest20. These vectors allow expression in systems such as E. coli and recombinant baculovirus. Other vectors not listed here allow expression in yeast, mammalian cells, or in vitro.
  • Expression of Recombinant Proteins in E. coli
  • Constructs are transformed into one or more of the following host strains: BL21 SI, BL21 AI, (Invitrogen); Origami B (DE3), Origami B (DE3) pLysS, Rosetta (DE3), Rosetta (DE3) pLysS, Rosetta-Gami (DE3), Rosetta-Gami (DE3) pLysS, or Rosetta-Gami B (DE3) pLysS (Novagen). The transformants are grown in LB with or without NaCl and with appropriate antibiotics, at temperatures in the range of 20-37° C., with aeration. Expression is induced with the addition of IPTG (0.03-0.3 mM) or NaCl (75-300 mM) when the cells are in mid-log growth. Growth is continued for one to 24 hours post-induction. Cells are harvested by centrifugation in a Sorvall RC-3C centrifuge in a H6000A rotor for 10 minutes at 3000 rpm, at 4° C. Cell pellets are stored at −80° C.
  • Expression of Recombinant Proteins Using Baculovirus
  • Recombinant proteins are expressed using baculovirus in Sf21 fall army worm ovarian cells. Recombinant baculoviruses are prepared using the Bac-to-Bac system (Invitrogen) per the manufacturer's instructions. Proteins are expressed on the large scale in Sf900II serum-free medium (Invitrogen) in a 10 L bioreactor tank (27° C., 130 rpm, 50% dissolved oxygen for 48 hours).
  • 3. Recombinant Protein Purification
  • Recombinant proteins are purified from E. coli and/or insect cells using a variety of standard chromatography methods. Briefly, cells are lysed using sonication or detergents. The insoluble material is pelleted by centrifugation at 10,000×g for 15 minutes. The supernatant is applied to an appropriate affinity column, e.g. His-tagged proteins are separated using a pre-packed chelating sepharose column (Pharmacia) or GST-tagged proteins are separated using a glutathione sepharose column (Pharmacia). After using the affinity column, proteins are further separated using various techniques, such as ion exchange chromatography (columns from Pharmacia) to separate on the basis of electrical charge or size exclusion chromatography (columns from Tosohaas) to separate on the basis of molecular weight, size and shape.
  • Expression and purification of the protein are also achieved using either a mammalian cell expression system or an insect cell expression system. The pUB6/V5-His vector system (Invitrogen, CA) is used to express GSCC in CHO cells. The vector contains the selectable bsd gene, multiple cloning sites, the promoter/enhancer sequence from the human ubiquitin C gene, a C-terminal V5 epitope for antibody detection with anti-V5 antibodies, and a C-terminal polyhistidine (6.times.His) sequence for rapid purification on PROBOND resin (Invitrogen, CA). Transformed cells are selected on media containing blasticidin.
  • Spodoptera frugiperda (Sf9) insect cells are infected with recombinant Autographica californica nuclear polyhedrosis virus (baculovirus). The polyhedrin gene is replaced with the cDNA by homologous recombination and the polyhedrin promoter drives cDNA transcription. The protein is synthesized as a fusion protein with 6×his which enables purification as described above. Purified protein is used in the following activity and to make antibodies
  • 4. Chemical Synthesis of Peptides
  • Proteins or portions thereof may be produced not only by recombinant methods, but also by using chemical methods well known in the art. Solid phase peptide synthesis may be carried out in a batchwise or continuous flow process which sequentially adds .alpha.-amino- and side chain-protected amino acid residues to an insoluble polymeric support via a linker group. A linker group such as methylamine-derivatized polyethylene glycol is attached to poly(styrene-co-divinylbenzene) to form the support resin. The amino acid residues are N-a-protected by acid labile Boc (t-butyloxycarbonyl) or base-labile Fmoc (9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl). The carboxyl group of the protected amino acid is coupled to the amine of the linker group to anchor the residue to the solid phase support resin. Trifluoroacetic acid or piperidine are used to remove the protecting group in the case of Boc or Fmoc, respectively. Each additional amino acid is added to the anchored residue using a coupling agent or pre-activated amino acid derivative, and the resin is washed. The full length peptide is synthesized by sequential deprotection, coupling of derivitized amino acids, and washing with dichloromethane and/or N,N-dimethylformamide. The peptide is cleaved between the peptide carboxy terminus and the linker group to yield a peptide acid or amide. (Novabiochem 1997/98 Catalog and Peptide Synthesis Handbook, San Diego Calif. pp. S1-S20). Automated synthesis may also be carried out on machines such as the 431A peptide synthesizer (ABI). A protein or portion thereof may be purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography and its composition confirmed by amino acid analysis or by sequencing (Creighton (1984) Proteins, Structures and Molecular Properties, W H Freeman, New York N.Y.).
  • 5. Antibody Development Polyclonal Antibody Preparations:
  • Polyclonal antibodies against recombinant proteins are raised in rabbits (Green Mountain Antibodies, Burlington, Vt.). Briefly, two New Zealand rabbits are immunized with 0.1 mg of antigen in complete Freund's adjuvant. Subsequent immunizations are carried out using 0.05 mg of antigen in incomplete Freund's adjuvant at days 14, 21 and 49. Bleeds are collected and screened for recognition of the antigen by solid phase ELISA and western blot analysis. The IgG fraction is separated by centrifugation at 20,000×g for 20 minutes followed by a 50% ammonium sulfate cut. The pelleted protein is resuspended in 5 mM Tris and separated by ion exchange chromatography. Fractions are pooled based on IgG content. Antigen-specific antibody is affinity purified using Pierce AminoLink resin coupled to the appropriate antigen.
  • Isolation of Antibody Fragments Directed Against LCATs from A Library of scFvs
  • Naturally occurring V-genes isolated from human PBLs are constructed into a library of antibody fragments which contain reactivities against LCAT to which the donor may or may not have been exposed (see e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,885,793 incorporated herein by reference in its entirety).
  • Rescue of the Library: A library of scFvs is constructed from the RNA of human PBLs as described in PCT publication WO 92/01047. To rescue phage displaying antibody fragments, approximately 109 E. coli harboring the phagemid are used to inoculate 50 ml of 2× TY containing 1% glucose and 100 .mu.g/ml of ampicillin (2.times.TY-AMP-GLU) and grown to an O.D. of 0.8 with shaking. Five ml of this culture is used to innoculate 50 ml of 2.times.TY-AMP-GLU, 2× 108 TU of delta gene 3 helper (M13 delta gene III, see PCT publication WO 92/01047) are added and the culture incubated at 37° C. for 45 minutes without shaking and then at 37° C. for 45 minutes with shaking. The culture is centrifuged at 4000 r.p.m. for 10 min. and the pellet resuspended in 2 liters of 2× TY containing 100 .mu.g/ml ampicillin and 50 ug/ml kanamycin and grown overnight. Phage are prepared as described in PCT publication WO 92/01047.
  • M13 delta gene III is prepared as follows: M13 delta gene III helper phage does not encode gene III protein, hence the phage(mid) displaying antibody fragments have a greater avidity of binding to antigen. Infectious M13 delta gene III particles are made by growing the helper phage in cells harboring a pUC19 derivative supplying the wild type gene III protein during phage morphogenesis. The culture is incubated for 1 hour at 37° C. without shaking and then for a further hour at 37° C. with shaking. Cells are spun down (IEC-Centra 8,400 r.p.m. for 10 min), resuspended in 300 ml 2× TY broth containing 100 .mu.g ampicillin/ml and 25.mu.g kanamycin/ml (2× TY-AMP-KAN) and grown overnight, shaking at 37° C. Phagre particles are purified and concentrated from the culture medium by two PEG-precipitations (Sambrook et al., 2001), resuspended in 2 ml PBS and passed through a 0.45 .mu.m filter (Minisart NML; Sartorius) to give a final concentration of approximately 1013 transducing units/ml (ampicillin-resistant clones).
  • Panning of the Library: Immunotubes (Nunc) are coated overnight in PBS with 4 ml of either 100 .mu.g/ml or 10 .mu.g/ml of a polypeptide of the present invention. Tubes are blocked with 2% Marvel-PBS for 2 hours at 37° C. and then washed 3 times in PBS. Approximately 1013 TU of phage is applied to the tube and incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature tumbling on an over and under turntable and then left to stand for another 1.5 hours. Tubes are washed 10 times with PBS 0.1% Tween-20 and 10 times with PBS. Phage are eluted by adding 1 ml of 100 mM triethylamine and rotating 15 minutes on an under and over turntable after which the solution is immediately neutralized with 0.5 ml of 1.0M Tris-HCl, pH 7.4. Phages are then used to infect 10 ml of mid-log E. coli TG1 by incubating eluted phage with bacteria for 30 minutes at 37° C. The E. coli are then plated on TYE plates containing 1% glucose and 100 .mu.g/ml ampicillin. The resulting bacterial library is then rescued with delta gene 3 helper phage as described above to prepare phage for a subsequent round of selection. This process is then repeated for a total of 4 rounds of affinity purification with tube-washing increased to 20 times with PBS, 0.1% Tween-20 and 20 times with PBS for rounds 3 and 4.
  • Characterization of Binders: Eluted phage from the 3rd and 4th rounds of selection are used to infect E. coli HB 2151 and soluble scFv is produced (Marks, et al., 1991) from single colonies for assay. ELISAs are performed with microtitre plates coated with either 10 .mu.g/ml of the polypeptide of the present invention in 50 mM bicarbonate pH 9.6. Clones positive in ELISA are further characterized by PCR fingerprinting (see, e.g., PCT publication WO 92/01047) and then by sequencing.
  • Monoclonal Antibody Generation
  • i) Materials:
  • 1) Complete Media No Sera (CMNS) for washing of the myeloma and spleen cells; Hybridoma medium CM-HAT {Cell Mab (BD), 10% FBS (or HS); 5% Origen HCF (hybridoma cloning factor) containing 4 mM L-glutamine and antibiotics} to be used for plating hybridomas after the fusion.
  • 2) Hybridoma medium CM-HT (NO AMINOPTERIN) (Cell Mab (BD), 10% FBS 5% Origen HCF containing 4 mM L-glutamine and antibiotics) to be used for fusion maintenance are stored in the refrigerator at 4-6° C. The fusions are fed on days 4, 8, and 12, and subsequent passages. Inactivated and pre-filtered commercial Fetal Bovine serum (FBS) or Horse Serum (HS) are thawed and stored in the refrigerator at 4° C. and must be pretested for myeloma growth from single cells.
  • 3) The L-glutamine (200 mM, 100× solution), which is stored at −20° C. freezer, is thawed and warmed until completely in solution. The L-glntamin is dispensed into media to supplement growth. L-glntamin is added to 2 mM for myelomas, and 4 mM for hybridoma media. Further the Penicillin, Streptomycin, Amphotericin (antibacterial-antifungal stored at −20° C.) is thawed and added to Cell Mab Media to 1%.
  • 4) Myeloma growth media is Cell Mab Media (Cell Mab Media, Quantum Yield from BD is stored in the refrigerator at 4° C. in the dark) which are added L-glutamine to 2 mM and antibiotic/antimycotic solution to 1% and is called CMNS.
  • 5) 1 bottle of PEG 1500 in Hepes (Roche, N.J.)
  • 6) 8-Azaguanine is stored as the dried powder supplied by SIGMA at −700° C. until needed. Reconstitute 1 vial/500 ml of media and add entire contents to 500 ml media (eg. 2 vials/litre).
  • 7) Myeloma Media is CM which has 10% FBS (or HS) and 8-Aza (1×) stored in the refrigerator at 4° C.
  • 8) Clonal cell medium D (Stemcell, Vancouver) contains HAT and methyl cellulose for semi-solid direct cloning from the fusion. This comes in 90 ml bottles with a CoA and must be “melted at 37° C. in a waterbath in the morning of the day of the fusion. Loosen the cap and leave in CO2 incubator to sufficiently gas the medium D and bring the pH down.
  • 9) Hybridoma supplements HT [hypoxanthine, thymidine] are to be used in medium for the section of hybridomas and maintenance of hybridomas through the cloning stages respectively.
  • 10) Origen HCF can be obtained directly from Igen and is a cell supernatant produced from a macrophage-like cell-line. It can be thawed and aliquoted to 15 ml tubes at 5 ml per tube and stored frozen at −20° C. Positive Hybridomas are fed HCF through the first subcloning and are gradually weaned. It is not necessary to continue to supplement unless you have a particularly difficult hybridoma clone. This and other additives have been shown to be more effective in promoting new hybridoma growth than conventional feeder layers.
  • ii) Procedure
  • To generate monoclonal antibodies, mice are immunized with 5-50 ug of antigen either intra-peritoneally (i.p.) or by intravenous injection in the tail vein (i.v.). Typically, the antigen used is a recombinant protein that is generated as described above. The primary immunization takes place 2 months prior to the harvesting of splenocytes from the mouse and the immunization is typically boosted by i.v. injection of 5-50 ug of antigen every two weeks. At least one week prior to expected fusion date, a fresh vial of myeloma cells is thawed and cultured. Several flasks at different densities are maintained in order that a culture at the optimum density is ensured at the time of fusion. The optimum density is determined to be 3-6×105 cells/ml. Two to five days before the scheduled fusion, a final immunization is administered of ˜5 ug of antigen in PBS i.p. or i.v.
  • Myeloma cells are washed with 30 ml serum free media by centrifugation at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes. Viable cell density is determined in resuspended cells using hemocytometry and vital stains. Cells resuspended in complete growth medium are stored at 37° C. during the preparation of splenocytes. Meanwhile, to test aminopterin sensitivity, 1×106 myeloma cells are transferred to a 15 ml conical tube and centrifuged at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes. The resulting pellet is resuspended in 15 ml of HAT media and cells plated at 2 drops/well on a 96 well plate.
  • To prepare splenocytes from immunized mice, the animals are euthanised and submerged in 70% ETOH. Under sterile conditions, the spleen is surgically removed and placed in 10 ml of RPMI medium supplemented with 20% fetal calf serum in a Petri dish. Cells are extricated from the spleen by infusing the organ with medium >50 times using a 21 g syringe.
  • Cells are harvested and washed by centrifugation (at 500 g at 4° C. for 5 minutes) with 30 ml of medium. Cells are resuspended in 10 ml of medium and the density of viable cells determined by hemocytometry using vital stains. The splenocytes are mixed with myeloma cells at a ratio of 5:1 (spleen cells: myeloma cells). Both the myeloma and spleen cells are washed 2 more times with 30 ml of RPMI-CMNS. Spin at 800 rpm for 12 minutes.
  • Supernatant is removed and cells are resuspended in 5 ml of RPMI-CMNS and are pooled to fill volume to 30 ml and spin down as before. Then, the pellet is broken up by gently tapping on the flow hood surface and resuspended in 1 ml of BMB REG1500 (prewarmed to 37° C.) dropwise with 1 cc needle over 1 minute.
  • RPMI-CMNS to the PEG cells and RPMI-CMNS are added to slowly dilute out the PEG. Cells are centrifuged and diluted in 5 ml of Complete media and 95 ml of Clonacell Medium D (HAT) media (with 5 ml of HCF). The cells are plated out 10 ml per small petri plate.
  • Myeloma/HAT control. P is prepared as follows: dilute about 1000 P3X63 Ag8.653 myeloma cells into 1 ml of medium D and transfer into a single well of a 24 well plate. Plates are placed in incubator, with two plates inside of a large petri plate, with an additional petri plate full of distilled water, for 10-18 days under 5% CO2 overlay at 37° C. Clones are picked from semisolid agarose into 96 well plates containing 150-200 ul of CM-HT. Supernatants are screened 4 days later in ELISA, and positive clones are moved up to 24 well plates. Heavy growth will require changing of the media at day 8 (+/−150 ml). One should further decrease the HCF to 0.5% (gradually—2%, then 1%, then 0.5%) in the cloning plates.
  • For further references see Kohler G, and C. Milstein Continuous cultures of fused cells secreting antibody of predefined specificity. 1975. Nature 256: 495-497; Lane, R. D. A short duration polyethylene glycol fusion technique for increasing production of monoclonal antibody-secreting hybridomas. 1985. J. Immunol. Meth. 81:223-228;
  • Harlow, E. and D. Lane. Antibodies: A laboratory manual. Cold Spring Harbour Laboratory Press. 1988; Kubitz, D. The Scripps Research Institute. La Jolla. Personal Communication; Zhong, G., Berry, J. D., and Choukri, S. (1996) Mapping epitopes of Chlamydia trachomatis neutralizing monoclonal antibodies using phage random peptide libraries. J. Indust. Microbiol. Biotech. 19, 71-76; Berry, J. D., Licea, A., Popkov, M., Cortez, X., Fuller, R., Elia, M., Kerwin, L., and C. F. Barbas III. (2003) Rapid monoclonal antibody generation via dendritic cell targeting in vivo. Hybridoma and Hybridomics 22 (1), 23-31.
  • 6. mRNA Expression Validation in Tissues by Taqman
  • Expression of mRNA is quantitated by RT-PCR using TaqMan® technology. The Taqman system couples a 5′ fluorogenic nuclease assay with PCR for real time quantitation. A probe is used to monitor the formation of the amplification product.
  • Total RNA is isolated from cancer model cell lines using the RNEasy Kit® (Qiagen) per manufacturer's instructions and included DNase treatment. Normal human tissue RNAs are acquired from commercial vendors (Ambion, Austin, Tex.; Stratagene, La Jolla, Calif., BioChain Institute, Newington, N.H.) as were RNAs from matched disease/normal tissues.
  • Target transcript sequences are identified for the differentially expressed peptides by searching the BlastP database. TaqMan assays (PCR primer/probe set) specific for those transcripts are identified by searching the Celera Discovery System™ (CDS) database. The assays are designed to span exon-exon borders and do not amplify genomic DNA.
  • The TaqMan primers and probe sequences are as designed by Applied Biosystems (AB) as part of the Assays on Demand™ product line or by custom design through the AB Assays by DesignSM service.
  • RT-PCR is accomplished using AmpliTaqGold and MultiScribe reverse transcriptase in the One Step RT-PCR Master Mix reagent kit (AB) according to the manufacturer's instructions. Probe and primer concentrations are 250 nM and 900 nM, respectively, in a 15 μl reaction. For each experiment, a master mix of the above components is made and aliquoted into each optical reaction well. Eight nanograms of total RNA is the template. Each sample is assayed in triplicate. Quantitative RT-PCR is performed using the ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System (SDS). Cycling parameters follow: 48° C. for 30 min. for one cycle; 95° C. for 10 min for one cycle; 95° C. for 15 sec, 60° C. for 1 min. for 40 cycles.
  • The SDS software calculates the threshold cycle (CT) for each reaction, and CT values are used to quantitate the relative amount of starting template in the reaction. The CT values for each set of three reactions are averaged for all subsequent calculations
  • Data are analyzed for fold difference in expression using an endogenous control for normalization and is expressed relative to a normal tissue or normal cell line reference. The choice of endogenous control is determined empirically by testing various candidates against the cell line and tissue RNA panels and selecting the one with the least variation in expression. Relative changes in expression are quantitated using the 2−ΔΔCT Method. Livak, K. J. and Schmittgen, T. D. (2001) Methods 25: 402-408; User bulletin #2: ABI Prism 7700 Sequence Detection System.
  • Validation by Tissue Flow Cytometry Analysis
  • Post tissue processing, cells are sorted by flow cytometry known in the art to enrich for epithelial cells. Alternatively, cells isolated from lung tissue are stained directly with EpCAM (for epithelial cells) and the specific antibody to LCAT. Cell numbers and viability are determined by PI exclusion (GUAVA) for cells isolated from both normal and tumor lung tissue. A minimum of 0.5×106 cells are used for each analysis. Cells are washed once with Flow Staining Buffer (0.5% BSA, 0.05% NaN3 in D-PBS). To the cells, 20 ul of each antibody for LCAT are added. An additional 5 ul of EpCAM antibody conjugated to APC were added when unsorted cells are used in the experiment. Cells are incubated with antibodies for 30 minutes at 4° C. Cells are washed once with Flow Staining Buffer and either analyzed immediately on the LSR flow cytometry apparatus or fixed in 1% formaldehyde and store at 4° C. until LSR analysis. The antibodies used to detect LCAT targets are all purchased by BD Biosciences and PE-conjugated. The isotype control antibody used for these experiments is PE-conjugated mouse IgG1k.
  • 7. Detection and Diagnosis of LCAT by Liquid Chromatography and Mass Spectrometry (LC/MS)
  • The proteins from cells can be prepared by reduction, alkylation and cysteine-containing peptide enrichment of concentrated conditioned media.
  • The differential expression of proteins in disease and healthy samples are quantitated using Liquid Chromatography Mass Spectrometry. The LC/MS spectra from disease and healthy (control) samples are collected and processed using the following steps:
  • The raw scans from the LC/MS instrument are subjected to peak detection and noise reduction software. Filtered peak lists are then used to detect ‘features’ corresponding to specific peptides from the original sample(s). Features are characterized by their mass/charge, charge, retention time, isotope pattern and intensity.
  • Similar experiments are repeated in order to increase the confidence in detection of a peptide. These multiple acquisitions are computationally aggregated into one experiment. The intensity of a peptide present in both healthy and disease samples is used to calculate the differential expression, or relative abundance, of the peptide. The intensity of a peptide found exclusively in one sample is used to calculate a theoretical expression ratio for that peptide (singleton). Expression ratios are calculated for each peptide of each replicate of the experiment
  • Statistical tests are performed to assess the robustness of the data and select statistically significant differentials. To assess general quality of the data, a) ensured that similar features are detected in all replicates of the experiment; b) number of matched ions between replicates; c) calculated the overall pair wise intensity correlations between LC/MS maps of process replicates to ensure that the expression ratios for peptides are reproducible across the multiple replicates; d) aggregated multiple experiments in order to compare the expression ratio of a peptide in multiple diseases or disease samples.
  • 8. Expression Validation by IHC in Tissue Sections Tissue Sections
  • Paraffin embedded, fixed tissue sections are obtained from a panel of normal tissues (Adrenal, Bladder, Lymphocytes, Bone Marrow, Breast, Cerebellum, Cerebral cortex, Colon, Endothelium, Eye, Fallopian tube, Small Intestine, Heart, Kidney [glomerulus, tubule], Liver, Lung, Testes and Thyroid) as well as 30 tumor samples with matched normal adjacent tissues from pancreas, lung, colon, prostate, ovarian and breast. In addition, other tissues are selected for testing such as bladder renal, hepatocellular, pharyngeal and gastric tumor tissues. Replicate sections are also obtained from numerous tumor types (Bladder Cancer, Lung Cancer, Breast Cancer, Melanoma, Colon Cancer, Non-Hodgkins Lymphoma, Endometrial Cancer, Ovarian Cancer, Head and Neck Cancer, Prostate Cancer, Leukemia [ALL and CML] and Rectal Cancer). Sections are stained with hemotoxylin and eosin and histologically examined to ensure adequate representation of cell types in each tissue section.
  • An identical set of tissues will be obtained from frozen sections and are used in those instances where it is not possible to generate antibodies that are suitable for fixed sections. Frozen tissues do not require an antigen retrieval step.
  • Paraffin Fixed Tissue Sections
  • Hemotoxylin and Eosin staining of paraffin embedded, fixed tissue sections.
  • Sections are deparaffinized in 3 changes of xylene or xylene substitute for 2-5 minutes each. Sections are rinsed in 2 changes of absolute alcohol for 1-2 minutes each, in 95% alcohol for 1 minute, followed by 80% alcohol for 1 minute. Slides are washed well in running water and stained in Gill solution 3 hemotoxylin for 3 to 5 minutes. Following a vigorous wash in running water for 1 minute, sections are stained in Scott's solution for 2 minutes. Sections are washed for 1 min in running water then counterstained in Eosin solution for 2-3 minutes depending upon development of desired staining intensity. Following a brief wash in 95% alcohol, sections are dehydrated in three changes of absolute alcohol for 1 minute each and three changes of xylene or xylene substitute for 1-2 minutes each. Slides are coverslipped and stored for analysis.
  • Optimisation of Antibody Staining
  • For each antibody, a positive and negative control sample are generated using data from the ICAT analysis of the lung cancer cell lines/tissues. Cells are selected that are known to express low levels of a particular target as determined from the ICAT data. This cell line is the reference normal control. Similarly, a lung tumor line is selected that is determined to overexpress the target is selected.
  • Antigen Retrieval
  • Sections are deparaffinized and rehydrated by washing 3 times for 5 minutes in xylene; two times for 5 minutes in 100% ethanol; two times for 5 minutes in 95% ethanol; and once for 5 minutes in 80% ethanol. Sections are then placed in endogenous blocking solution (methanol+2% hydrogen peroxide) and incubated for 20 minutes at room temperature. Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes each in deionized water and twice for 5 minutes in phosphate buffered saline (PBS), pH 7.4. Alternatively, where necessary sections are deparrafinized by High Energy Antigen Retrieval as follows: sections are washed three times for 5 minutes in xylene; two times for 5 minutes in 100% ethanol; two times for 5 minutes in 95% ethanol; and once for 5 minutes in 80% ethanol. Sections are placed in a Coplin jar with dilute antigen retrieval solution (10 mM citrate acid, pH 6). The Coplin jar containing slides is placed in a vessel filled with water and microwaved on high for 2-3 minutes (700 watt oven). Following cooling for 2-3 minutes, steps 3 and 4 are repeated four times (depending on tissue), followed by cooling for 20 minutes at room temperature. Sections are then rinsed in deionized water, two times for 5 minutes, placed in modified endogenous oxidation blocking solution (PBS+2% hydrogen peroxide).and rinsed for 5 minutes in PBS.
  • Blocking and Staining
  • Sections are blocked with PBS/1% bovine serum albumin (PBA) for 1 hour at room temperature followed by incubation in normal serum diluted in PBA (2%) for 30 minutes at room temperature to reduce non-specific binding of antibody. Incubations are performed in a sealed humidity chamber to prevent air-drying of the tissue sections. (The choice of blocking serum is the same as the species of the biotinylated secondary antibody). Excess antibody is gently removed by shaking and sections covered with primary antibody diluted in PBA and incubated either at room temperature for 1 hour or overnight at 4° C. (Care is taken that the sections do not touch during incubation).Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently. Excess PBS is removed by gently shaking. The sections are covered with diluted biotinylated secondary antibody in PBA and incubated for 30 minutes to 1 hour at room temperature in the humidity chamber. If using a monoclonal primary antibody, addition of 2% rat serum is used to decrease the background on rat tissue sections. Following incubation, sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently. Excess PBS is removed and sections incubated for 1 hour at room temperature in Vectastain ABC reagent (as per kit instructions). The lid of the humidity chamber is secured during all incunations to ensure a moist environment. Sections are rinsed twice for 5 minutes in PBS, shaking gently.
  • Develop and Counterstain
  • Sections are incubated for 2 minutes in peroxidase substrate solution that is made up immediately prior to use as follows:
      • 10 mg diaminobenzidine (DAB) dissolved in 10 ml 50 mM sodium phosphate buffer, pH 7.4.
      • 12.5 microliters 3% CoCl2/NiCl2 in deionized water
      • 1.25 microliters hydrogen peroxide
  • Slides are rinsed well three times for 10 min in deionized water and counterstained with 0.01% Light Green acidified with 0.01% acetic acid for 1-2 minutes depending on intensity of counterstain desired.
  • Slides are rinsed three times for 5 minutes with deionized water and dehydrated two times for 2 minutes in 95% ethanol; two times for 2 minutes in 100% ethanol; and two times for 2 minutes in xylene. Stained slides are mounted for visualization by microscopy.
  • 9. IHC Staining of Frozen Tissue Sections
  • Fresh tissues are embedded carefully in OCT in plastic mold, without trapping air bubbles surrounding the tissue. Tissues are frozen by setting the mold on top of liquid nitrogen until 70-80% of the block turns white at which point the mold is placed on dry ice. The frozen blocks were stored at −80° C. Blocks are sectioned with a cryostat with care taken to avoid warming to greater than −10° C. Initially, the block is equilibrated in the cryostat for about 5 minutes and 6-10 mm sections are cut sequentially. Sections are allowed to dry for at least 30 minutes at room temperature. Following drying, tissues are stored at 4° C. for short term and −80° C. for long term storage.)
  • Sections are fixed by immersing in acetone jar for 1-2 minutes at room temperature, followed by drying at room temp. Primary antibody is added (diluted in 0.05 M Tris-saline [0.05 M Tris, 0.15 M NaCl, pH 7.4], 2.5% serum) directly to the sections by covering the section dropwise to cover the tissue entirely. Binding is carried out by incubation a chamber for 1 hour at room temperature. Without letting the sections dry out, the secondary antibody (diluted in Tris-saline/2.5% serum) is added in a similar manner to the primary and incubated as before (at least 45 minutes).
  • Following incubation, the sections are washed gently in Tris-saline for 3-5 minutes and then in Tris-saline/2.5% serum for another 3-5 minutes. If a biotinylated primary antibody is used, in place of the secondary antibody incubation, slides are covered with 100 ul of diluted alkaline phosphatase conjugated streptavidin, incubated for 30 minutes at room temperature and washed as above. Sections are incubated with alkaline phosphatase substrate (1 mg/ml Fast Violet; 0.2 mg/ml Napthol AS-MX phosphate in Tris-Saline pH 8.5) for 10-20 minutes until the desired positive staining is achieved at which point the reaction is stopped by washing twice with Tris-saline. Slides are counter-stained with Mayer's hematoxylin for 30 seconds and washed with tap water for 2-5 minutes. Sections are mounted with Mount coverslips and mounting media.
  • 10. Assay for Antibody Dependent Cellular Cytotoxicity
  • Cultured tumor cells are labeled with 100 μCi 51Cr for 1 hour; Livingston, P. O., Zhang, S., Adluri, S., Yao, T.-J., Graeber, L., Ragupathi, G., Helling, F., & Fleischer, M. (1997). Cancer Immunol. Immunother. 43, 324-330. After being washed three times with culture medium, cells are resuspended at 105/ml, and 100 μl/well are plated onto 96-well round-bottom plates. A range of antibody concentrations are applied to the wells, including an isotype control together with donor peripheral blood mononuclear cells that are plated at a 100:1 and 50:1 ratio. After an 18-h incubation at 37° C., supernatant (30 μl/well) is harvested and transferred onto Lumaplate 96 (Packard), dried, and read in a Packard Top-Count NXT γ counter. Each measurement is carried out in triplicate. Spontaneous release is determined by cpm of tumor cells incubated with medium and maximum release by cpm of tumor cells plus 1% Triton X-100 (Sigma). Specific lysis is defined as: % specific lysis=[(experimental release−spontaneous release)/(maximum release−spontaneous release)]×100. The percent ADCC is expressed as peak specific lysis postimmune subtracted by preimmune percent specific lysis. A doubling of the ADCC to >20% is considered significant.
  • 11. Assay for Complement Dependent Cytotoxicity
  • Chromium release assays to assess complement-mediated cytotoxicity are performed for each patient at various time points; Dickler, M. N., Ragupathi, G., Liu, N. X., Musselli, C., Martino, D. J., Miller, V. A., Kris, M. G., Brezicka, F. T., Livingston, P. O. & Grant, S.C. (1999) Clin. Cancer Res. 5, 2773-2779. Cultured tumor cells are washed in FCS-free media two times, resuspended in 500 μl of media, and incubated with 100 μCi 51Cr per 10 million cells for 2 h at 37° C. The cells are then shaken every 15 min for 2 h, washed 3 times in media to achieve a concentration of approximately 20,000 cells/well, and then plated in round-bottom plates. The plates contain either 50 μl cells plus 50 μl monoclonal antibody, 50 μl cells plus serum (pre- and posttherapy), or 50 μl cells plus mouse serum as a control. The plates are incubated in a cold room on a shaker for 45 min. Human complement of a 1:5 dilution (resuspended in 1 ml of ice-cold water and diluted with 3% human serum albumin) is added to each well at a volume of 100 μl. Control wells include those for maximum release of isotope in 10% Triton X-100 (Sigma) and for spontaneous release in the absence of complement with medium alone. The plates are incubated for 2 h at 37° C., centrifuged for 3 min, and then 100 μl of supernatant is removed for radioactivity counting. The percentage of specific lysis is calculated as follows: % cytotoxicity=[(experimental release−spontaneous release)/(maximum release−spontaneous release)]×100 A doubling of the CDC to >20% is considered significant.
  • 12. In Vitro Assays In Cell Lines; RNAi
  • Lipofectamine is purchased from Invitrogen (Carlsbad, Calif.) and GeneSilencer from Gene Therapy Systems (San Diego, Calif.). Synthetic siRNA oligonucleotides are from Dharmacon (Lafayette, Colo.), Qiagen (Valencia, Califoria) or Ambion (Austin, Tex.) RNeasy 96 Kit is purchased from Qiagen (Valencia, Calif.). Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay are both purchased from Promega (Madison, Wis.). Alamar Blue proliferation assay can be purchased from Biosource (Camarillo, Calif.). Function blocking antibodies are purchased from Chemicon (Temecula, Calif.), Biotrend (Cologne, Germany) or Alexis Corporation (San Diego, Calif.). Cell invasion assay kits from purchased from Chemicon (Temecula, Calif.). RiboGreen RNA Quantitation Kit is purchased from Molecular probes (Eugene, Oreg.).
  • RNAi
  • RNAi is performed by using Smartpools (Dharmacon), 4—for Silencing siRNA duplexes (Qiagen) or scrambled negative control siRNA (Ambion). Transient transfections are carried out in triplicate by using either Lipofectamine 2000 from Invitrogen (Carlsbad, Calif.) or by using GeneSilencer from Gene Therapy Systems (San Diego, Calif.) in methods described below. 1 to 4 days after transfections, total RNA is isolated by using the RNeasy 96 Kit (Qiagen) according to manufacturer's instructions and expression of mRNA is quantitated by using TaqMan technology. Protein expression levels are examined by flow cytometry and apoptosis and proliferation assays are performed daily using Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay (see protocols below).
  • i) RNAi Transfections—Lipofectamine 2000
  • Transient transfections are carried out on sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines as previously described. Elbashir, S. M. et al. (2001) Nature 411: 494-498; Caplen, N. J. et al. (2001) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 98: 9742-9747; Sharp, P. A. (2001) Genes and Development 15: 485-490. Synthetic RNA to gene of interest or scrambled negative control siRNA is transfected using lipofectamine according to manufacturer's instructions. Cells are plated in 96 well plates in antibiotics free medium. The next day, the transfection reagent and siRNA are prepared for transfections as follows: Each 0.1-1 ul of lipofectamine 2000 and 10-150 mM siRNA are resuspended 25 ul serum-free media and incubated at room temperature for 5 minutes. After incubation, the diluted siRNA and the lipofectamine 2000 are combined and incubated for 20 minutes at room temperature. The cells are then washed and the combined siRNA-Lipofectamine 2000 reagent added. After further 4 hours incubation, 50 ul serum containing medium added to each well. 1 and 4 days after transfection, expression of mRNA is quantitated by RT-PCR using TaqMan technology and protein expression levels are examined by flow cytometry. Apoptosis and proliferation assays are performed daily using Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit and CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay (see protocols below).
  • ii) RNAi Transfections—GeneSilencer
  • Transient transfections are carried out on sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines as previously described. Elbashir, S. M. et al. (2001) Nature 411: 494-498; Caplen, N. J. et al. (2001) Proc Natl Acad Sci USA 98: 9742-9747; Sharp, P. A. (2001) Genes and Development 15: 485-490. Synthetic RNA to gene of interest or scrambled negative control siRNA is transfected using GeneSilencer according to manufacturer's instructions. Cells are plated in 96 well plates in antibiotics free medium. The next day, the transfection reagent and the synthetic siRNA are prepared for transfections as follows: predetermined amount of Gene Silencer is diluted in serum-free media to a final volume of 20 ul per well. After resuspending 10-150 mM siRNA in 20 ul serum-free media, the reagents are combined and incubated at room temperature for 5-20 minutes. After incubation, the siRNA-Gene Silencer reagent is added to each well and incubated in a 37° C. incubator for 4 hours before an equal volume of serum containing media is added back to the cultured cells. The cells are then incubated for 1 to 4 days before mRNA, protein expression and effects on apoptosis and proliferation are examined.
  • Testing of Function Blocking Antibodies
  • Sub-confluent lung cancer cell lines are serum-staved overnight. The next day, serum-containing media is added back to the cells in the presence of 5-50 ng/ml of function blocking antibodies. After 2 or 5 days incubation at 37° C. 5% CO2, antibody binding is examined by flow cytometry and apoptosis and proliferation are examined by using protocols described below.
  • Apoptosis
  • Apoptosis assay is performed by using the Apop-one homogeneous caspase-3/7 kit from Promega. Briefly, the caspase-3/7 substrate is thawed to room temperature and diluted 1:100 with buffer. The diluted substrate is then added 1:1 to cells, control or blank. The plates are then placed on a plate shaker for 30 minutes to 18 hours at 300-500 rpm. The fluorescence of each well is then measured at using an excitation wavelength of 485+/−20 nm and an emission wavelength of 530+/−25 nm.
  • Proliferation—MTS
  • Proliferation assay is performed by using the CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution Cell Proliferation Assay kit from Promega. 20 ul of CellTiter 96 AQueous One Solution is added to 100 ul of culture medium. The plates are then incubated for 1-4 hours at 37° C. in a humidified 5% CO2 incubator. After incubation, the change in absorbance is read at 490 nm.
  • Proliferation—Alamar Blue
  • Proliferation assay is performed by using the Alamar Blue assay from Biosource. 10 ul of Alamar Blue reagent is added to 100 ul of cells in culture medium. The plates are then incubated for 1-4 hours at 37° C. in a humidified 5% CO2 incubator. After incubation, the change in fluorescence is measured at using an excitation wavelength of 530 nm and an emission wavelength of 595 nm.
  • Cell Invasion
  • Cell invasion assay is performed by using the 96 well cell invasion assay kit available from Chemicon. After the cell invasion chamber plates are adjusted to room temperature, 100 ul serum-free media is added to the interior of the inserts. 1-2 hours later, cell suspensions of 1×106 cells/ml are prepared. Media is then carefully removed from the inserts and 100 ul of prepared cells are added into the insert +/−0 to 50 ng function blocking antibodies. The cells are pre-incubated for 15 minutes at 37° C. before 150 ul of media containing 10% FBS is added to the lower chamber. The cells are then incubated for 48 hours at 37° C. After incubation, the cells from the top side of the insert are discarded and the invasion chamber plates are then placed on a new 96-well feeder tray containing 150 ul of pre-warmed cell detachment solution in the wells. The plates are incubated for 30 minutes at 37° C. and are periodically shaken. Lysis buffer/dye solution (4 ul CyQuant Dye/300 ul 4× X lysis buffer) is prepared and added to each well of dissociation buffer/cells on feeder tray. The plates are incubated for 15 minutes at room temperature before 150 ul is transferred to a new 96-well plate. Fluorescence of invading cells is then read at 480 excitation and 520 emission.
  • Receptor Internalization
  • For quantification of receptor internalization, ELISA assays are performed essentially as described by Daunt et al. Daunt, D. A., Hurtz, C., Hein, L., Kallio, J., Feng, F., and Kobilka, B. K. (1997) Mol. Pharmacol. 51, 711-720. The cell lines are plated at 6×105 cells per in a 24-well tissue culture dishes that have previously been coated with 0.1 mg/ml poly-L-lysine. The next day, the cells are washed once with PBS and incubated in DMEM at 37° C. for several minutes. Agonist to the cell surface target of interest is then added at a pre-determined concentration in prewarmed DMEM to the wells. The cells are then incubated for various times at 37° C. and reactions are stopped by removing the media and fixing the cells in 3.7% formaldehyde/TBS for 5 min at room temperature. The cells are then washed three times with TBS and nonspecific binding blocked with TBS containing 1% BSA for 45 min at room temperature. The first antibody is added at a pre-determined dilution in TBS/BSA for 1 h at room temperature. Three washes with TBS followed, and cells are briefly reblocked for 15 min at room temperature. Incubation with goat anti-mouse conjugated alkaline phosphatase (Bio-Rad) diluted 1:1000 in TBS/BSA is carried out for 1 h at room temperature. The cells are washed three times with TBS and a colorimetric alkaline phosphatase substrate is added. When the adequate color change is reached, 100-ul samples are taken for colorimetric readings.
  • mRNA Expression
  • Expression of mRNA is quantitated by RT-PCR using TaqMan® technology. Total RNA is isolated from cancer model cell lines using the RNEasy 96 kit (Qiagen) per manufacturer's instructions and included DNase treatment. Target transcript sequences are identified for the differentially expressed peptides by searching the BlastP database. TaqMan assays (PCR primer/probe set) specific for those transcripts are identified by searching the Celera Discovery System™ (CDS) database. The assays are designed to span exon-exon borders and do not amplify genomic DNA. The TaqMan primers and probe sequences are as designed by Applied Biosystems (AB) as part of the Assays on Demand™ product line or by custom design through the AB Assays by DesignSM service. RT-PCR is accomplished using AmpliTaqGold and MultiScribe reverse transcriptase in the One Step RT-PCR Master Mix reagent kit (AB) according to the manufacturers instructions. Probe and primer concentrations are 900 nM and 250 nM, respectively, in a 250 μl reaction. For each experiment, a master mix of the above components is made and aliquoted into each optical reaction well. 5 ul of total RNA is the template. Each sample is assayed in triplicate. Quantitative RT-PCR is performed using the ABI Prism® 7900HT Sequence Detection System (SDS). Cycling parameters follow: 48° C. for 30 min. for one cycle; 95° C. for 10 min for one cycle; 95° C. for 15 sec, 60° C. for 1 min. for 40 cycles.
  • The SDS software calculates the threshold cycle (CT) for each reaction, and CT values are used to quantitate the relative amount of starting template in the reaction. The CT values for each set of three reactions are averaged for all subsequent calculations.
  • Total RNA is quantitated by using RiboGreen RNA Quantitation Kit according to manufacturer's instructions and the % mRNA expression is calculated using total RNA for normalization. % knockdown is then calculated relative to the no addition control.
  • 13. In Vivo Studies By Using Antibodies
  • Treatment of Lung Cancer Cells with Monoclonal Antibodies.
  • Lung cancer cells are seeded at a density of 4×104 cells per well in 96-well microtiter plates and allowed to adhere for 2 hours. The cells are then treated with different concentrations of anti-LCAT monoclonal antibody (Mab) or irrelevant isotype matched (anti-rHuIFN-. gamma. Mab) at 0.05, 0.5 or 5.0 mug/ml. After a 72 hour incubation, the cell monolayers are stained with crystal violet dye for determination of relative percent viability (RPV) compared to control (untreated) cells. Each treatment group consists of replicates. Cell growth inhibition is monitored.
  • Treatment of NIH 3T3 Cells Overexpression LCAT Protein with Monoclonal Antibodies.
  • NIH 3T3 expressing LCAT protein are treated with different concentrations of anti-LCAT MAbs. Cell growth inhibition is monitored.
  • In Vivo Treatment of NIH 3T3 Cells Overexpressing LCAT with Anti-LCAT Monoclonal Antibodies.
  • NIH 3T3 cells transfected with either a LCAT expression plasmidor the neo-DHFR vector are injected into nu/nu (athymic) mice subcutaneously at a dose of 106 cells in 0.1 ml of phosphate-buffered saline. On days 0, 1, 5 and every 4 days thereafter, 100 mug (0.1 ml in PBS) of either an irrelevant or anti-LCAT monoclonal antibody of the IG2A subclass is injected intraperitoneally. Tumor occurrence and size are monitored for 1 month period of treatment.
  • All publications and patents mentioned in the above specification are herein incorporated by reference. Various modifications and variations of the described method and system of the invention will be apparent to those skilled in the art without departing from the scope and spirit of the invention. Although the invention has been described in connection with specific preferred embodiments, it should be understood that the invention as claimed should not be unduly limited to such specific embodiments. Indeed, various modifications of the above-described modes for carrying out the invention, which are obvious to those skilled in the field of molecular biology or related fields, are intended to be within the scope of the following claims.
  • Protein Peptide Sample Ratio
    SEQ ID NO: 250 gi|136204swissprot_id| SEQ ID NO: 2182 SCHAGFGSPAGWDVPVGALIQR 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue Singleton
    TRFM_HUMANP08582
    SEQ ID NO: 2283 LKPEIQCVSAK 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue 4.2
    SEQ ID NO: 2283 LKPEIQCVSAK TTB00273182 Fresh Tissue 8.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2307 CLAEGAGDVAFVK 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue 4.8
    SEQ ID NO: 2386 TLPSWGQALLSQDFELLCR 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue Singleton
    SEQ ID NO: 251 hCP51030 SEQ ID NO: 2182 SCHAGFGSPAGWDVPVGALIQR 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue Singleton
    SEQ ID NO: 2283 LKPEIQCVSAK 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue 4.2
    SEQ ID NO: 2283 LKPEIQCVSAK TTB00273182 Fresh Tissue 8.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2307 CLAEGAGDVAFVK 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue 4.8
    SEQ ID NO: 2386 TLPSWGQALLSQDFELLCR 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue Singleton
    SEQ ID NO: 715 hCP1882999 SEQ ID NO: 2307 CLAEGAGDVAFVK 11539 A1 Fresh Tissue 4.8
    SEQ ID NO: 776 hCP1882038 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 777 hCP1882041 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 778 hCP1882040 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 779 hCP1907105 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 780 hCP1882039 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 781 NP_065826.2 SEQ ID NO: 2330 IHSLCYNDCTFSR UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue 4.4
    SEQ ID NO: 2430 YFHHFTLSLCGNQGR UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue 3.3
    SEQ ID NO: 914 gi|55731364swissprot_id| SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
    CXAR_HUMANP78310
    SEQ ID NO: 915 hCP1813428 SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
    SEQ ID NO: 916 hCP1813431 SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
    SEQ ID NO: 917 XP_496028.1 SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
    SEQ ID NO: 918 hCP1813429 SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
    SEQ ID NO: 919 hCP1813430 SEQ ID NO: 2393 AKGETAYLPCK H520 Cell Line 7.4
  • Protein Number: 250
    Public Protein Accession: gi|136204swissprot_id|TRFM_HUMANP08582
    Protein Name: Melanotransferrin precursor (Melanoma-associated
    antigen p97) (CD228 antigen)
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 250)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2182) (SEQ ID NO: 250, 474-495)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2283) (SEQ ID NO: 250, 390-400)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2307) (SEQ ID NO: 250, 215-227)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2386) (SEQ ID NO: 250, 239-257)
    Protein Number: 251
    Celera Protein: hCP51030
    Protein Name: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal
    antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MAP97, MGC4856, MTF1
    Celera Transcript: hCT32460.2
    Celera Gene: hCG41190
    Gene Symbol: MFI2
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VSN2(601018 . . . 627938)
    Chromosome: Chr3
    OMIM Information: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal
    antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MFI2
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 251)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1376)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2182) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 474-495)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2283) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 390-400)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2307) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 215-227)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2386) (SEQ ID NO: 251, 239-257)
    Protein Number: 715
    Celera Protein: hCP1882999
    Protein Name: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal
    antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MAP97, MGC4856, MTF1
    Celera Transcript: hCT2287953
    Celera Gene: hCG41190
    Gene Symbol: MFI2
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VSN2(601018 . . . 627938)
    Chromosome: Chr3
    OMIM Information: antigen p97 (melanoma associated) identified by monoclonal
    antibodies 133.2 and 96.5; MFI2
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 715)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1736)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2307) (SEQ ID NO: 715, 215-227)
    Protein Number: 776
    Celera Protein: hCP1882038
    Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein
    Celera Transcript: hCT2279247.1
    Celera Gene: hCG1997600
    Gene Symbol: KIAA1324
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . . 736971)
    Chromosome: Chr1
    OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein;KIAA1324
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 776)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1792)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 776, 649-661)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 776, 694-708)
    Protein Number: 777
    Celera Protein: hCP1882041
    Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein
    Celera Transcript: hCT2279248.1
    Celera Gene: hCG1997600
    Gene Symbol: KIAA1324
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . . 736971)
    Chromosome: Chr1
    OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein;KIAA1324
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 777)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1793)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 777, 299-311)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 777, 344-358)
    Protein Number: 778
    Celera Protein: hCP1882040
    Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein
    Celera Transcript: hCT2279250.1
    Celera Gene: hCG1997600
    Gene Symbol: KIAA1324
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . . 736971)
    Chromosome: Chr1
    OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein; KIAA1324
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 778)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1794)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 778, 339-351)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 778, 384-398)
    Protein Number: 779
    Celera Protein: hCP1907105
    Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein
    Celera Transcript: hCT2340521
    Celera Gene: hCG1997600
    Gene Symbol: KIAA1324
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . . 736971)
    Chromosome: Chr1
    OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein; KIAA1324
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 779)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1795)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 779, 649-661)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 779, 694-708)
    Protein Number: 780
    Celera Protein: hCP1882039
    Protein Name: KIAA1324 protein
    Celera Transcript: hCT2279248.1
    Celera Gene: hCG1997600
    Gene Symbol: KIAA1324
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32VTKB(644145 . . . 736971)
    Chromosome: Chr1
    OMIM Information: KIAA1324 protein; KIAA1324
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 780)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1796)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 780, 649-661)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 780, 694-708)
    Protein Number: 781
    Public Protein Accession: NP_065826.2
    Protein Name: maba1 [Homo sapiens]
    Public Transcript Accession: NM_020775
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 781)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1797)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2330) (SEQ ID NO: 781, 649-661)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2430) (SEQ ID NO: 781, 694-708)
    Protein Number: 914
    Public Protein Accession: gi|55731364swissprot_id|CXAR_HUMANP78310
    Protein Name: Coxsackievirus and adenovirus receptor precursor (Coxsackievirus
    B-adenovirus receptor) (hCAR) (CVB3 binding protein)
    Public Transcript Accession: CR860254
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 914)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1915)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 914, 31-41)
    Protein Number: 915
    Celera Protein: hCP1813428
    Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR,HCAR
    Celera Transcript: hCT2296273
    Celera Gene: hCG2008096
    Gene Symbol: CXADR
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . . 29156521)
    Chromosome: Chr21
    OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 915)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1916)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 915, 31-41)
    Protein Number: 916
    Celera Protein: hCP1813431
    Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR,HCAR
    Celera Transcript: hCT2296276
    Celera Gene: hCG2008096
    Gene Symbol: CXADR
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . . 29156521)
    Chromosome: Chr21
    OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 916)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1917)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 916, 31-41)
    Protein Number: 917
    Public Protein Accession: XP_496028.1
    Protein Name: PREDICTED: similar to coxsackie-adenovirus-receptor
    isoform CAR4/7 [Homo sapiens]
    Public Transcript Accession: XM_496028
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 917)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1918)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 917, 4-14)
    Protein Number: 918
    Celera Protein: hCP1813429
    Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR,HCAR
    Celera Transcript: hCT2296275
    Celera Gene: hCG2008096
    Gene Symbol: CXADR
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . . 29156521)
    Chromosome: Chr21
    OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 918)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1919)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 918, 31-41)
    Protein Number: 919
    Celera Protein: hCP1813430
    Protein Name: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CAR, HCAR
    Celera Transcript: hCT2296274
    Celera Gene: hCG2008096
    Gene Symbol: CXADR
    Celera Genomic Axis: GA_x5YUV32W8NG(29102042 . . . 29156521)
    Chromosome: Chr21
    OMIM Information: coxsackie virus and adenovirus receptor; CXADR
    Protein Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 919)
    Transcript Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 1920)
    Peptide Sequence (SEQ ID NO: 2393) (SEQ ID NO: 919, 31-41)
  • Sample ID Lymph Distant Extent of AJCC
    Number Sample Type Nodes Metastasis Invasion Stage
    UMDLT0022 Fresh Tissue Squamous cell carcinoma N2 M1 T2 IV
    CLR-LCA-61T Fresh Tissue Large cell carcinoma with mucin N0 M0 T2 IB
    CLR-LCA-21T Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed acinar solid N0 MX T2 IB
    CLR-LCA-44T Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed N2 MX T4 IIIB
    UMDLT0018 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma N0 M0 T1 IA
    UMDLT0028 Fresh Tissue Squamous cell carcinoma N0 M0 T2 IB
    TTB00273182 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed acinar squamous N0 MX T2 IB
    CLR-LCA-48T Fresh Tissue Carcinoid pleomorphic N0 M1 T2 IV
    UMDLT0027 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma papillary N0 M0 T2 IB
    TTB00271982 Fresh Tissue No evidence of primary tumor N0 M0 TX Occult Carcinoma
    CLR-LCA-40T Fresh Tissue Large cell carcinoma N2 MX T2 IIIA
    CLR-LCA-15T Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed acinar bronchioalveolar N0 MX T1 IA
    UMDLS20031 Fresh Tissue Small cell carcinoma N1 M0 T2 IIB
    CLR-LCA-53T Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed N0 M0 T2 IB
    UMDLT0025 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma mixed acinar squamous N1 M0 T3 IIIA
    9450A1 Fresh Tissue Small cell carcinoma NX M1 TX IV
    11539 A1 Fresh Tissue Squamous cell carcinoma N0 MX T2 IB
    14309 A1 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma acinar N1 MX T2 IIB
    29812A1 Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma N1 MX T2 IIB
    CLR-LCA-63T Fresh Tissue Squamous cell carcinoma N0 M0 T3 IIB
    GW-004T Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma bronchioloalveolar N2 MX T2 IIIA
    GW-012-LT Fresh Tissue Adenocarcinoma N0 M0 T1 IA

Claims (20)

1. An isolated protein comprising an amino acid sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 and 2121-2525.
2. A composition comprising the protein of claim 1 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
3. An isolated nucleic acid molecule comprising a nucleotide sequence selected from the group consisting of:
a) SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120;
b) nucleotide sequences that encode a protein comprising an amino acid sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 and 2121-2525; and
c) nucleotide sequences that are completely complementary to the nucleotide sequences of a) or b).
4. An isolated RNAi or antisense nucleic acid molecule that selectively binds to the nucleic acid molecule of claim 3.
5. An isolated antibody that selectively binds to the protein of claim 1.
6. The antibody of claim 5, wherein the antibody is at least one of a monoclonal, polyclonal, fully human, humanized, chimeric, single-chain, or anti-idiotypic antibody.
7. A cell line, hybridoma, phage, or transgenic organism that produces the antibody of claim 5.
8. The antibody of claim 5, wherein the antibody is coupled to a composition selected from the group consisting of detectable substances and therapeutic agents.
9. A composition comprising the antibody of claim 5 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
10. An isolated antibody fragment of the antibody of claim 5, wherein the antibody fragment comprises a fragment selected from the group consisting of:
a) an Fab fragment;
b) an F(ab′)2 fragment; and
c) an Fv fragment.
11. A method of modulating cell proliferation or apoptosis, the method comprising contacting a cell with the antibody of claim 5.
12. The method of claim 11, wherein the method comprises either inhibiting proliferation of lung cancer cells or stimulating apoptosis of lung cancer cells.
13. A method of modulating cell proliferation or apoptosis, the method comprising contacting a cell with the RNAi or antisense nucleic acid molecule of claim 4.
14. A method of detecting the protein of claim 1 in a sample, the method comprising contacting the sample with an isolated antibody that selectively binds to the protein and determining whether the antibody binds to the protein.
15. A method of detecting the nucleic acid molecule of claim 3 in a sample, the method comprising contacting the sample with an oligonucleotide that specifically hybridizes to the nucleic acid molecule and determining whether the oligonucleotide binds to the nucleic acid molecule.
16. A method of diagnosing, prognosing, or determining risk of lung cancer in a subject, the method comprising detecting at least one molecule in a sample, wherein the presence or abundance of the molecule is indicative of lung cancer, and wherein the molecule is selected from the group consisting of:
a) proteins comprising an amino acid sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1-1154 and 2121-2525;
b) antibodies that selectively bind to the protein of a);
c) nucleic acid molecules comprising a nucleotide sequence selected from the group consisting of SEQ ID NOS:1155-2120 and nucleotide sequences that encode the protein of a); and
d) nucleic acid molecules comprising a nucleotide sequence that is completely complementary to the nucleic acid molecule of c).
17. A method of treating lung cancer, the method comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of the antibody of claim 5 to a subject.
18. A method of screening agents, the method comprising contacting the protein of claim 1 or a cell that expresses the protein with an agent, and assaying for whether the agent binds to the protein or modulates the function, activity, or expression of the protein.
19. A composition comprising the agent identified by the method of claim 18 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
20. A method of determining or predicting the effectiveness of a treatment or selecting a treatment for administration to a subject having lung cancer, the method comprising detecting the presence, abundance, or activity of the protein of claim 1 in a sample and determining or predicting the effectiveness of the treatment or selecting the treatment for administration based on the presence, abundance, or activity of the protein.
US12/859,440 2005-07-21 2010-08-19 Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof Abandoned US20110212085A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/859,440 US20110212085A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2010-08-19 Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof

Applications Claiming Priority (9)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US70105405P 2005-07-21 2005-07-21
US71725205P 2005-09-16 2005-09-16
US74287205P 2005-12-07 2005-12-07
US76337406P 2006-01-31 2006-01-31
US78131006P 2006-03-13 2006-03-13
US81207506P 2006-06-09 2006-06-09
US11/490,329 US7521195B1 (en) 2005-07-21 2006-07-21 Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US12/400,212 US20090232822A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2009-03-09 Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US12/859,440 US20110212085A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2010-08-19 Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/400,212 Division US20090232822A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2009-03-09 Lung disease targets and uses thereof

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20110212085A1 true US20110212085A1 (en) 2011-09-01

Family

ID=40550362

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/490,329 Expired - Fee Related US7521195B1 (en) 2005-07-21 2006-07-21 Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US12/400,212 Abandoned US20090232822A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2009-03-09 Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US12/859,440 Abandoned US20110212085A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2010-08-19 Lung cancer disease targets and uses thereof

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/490,329 Expired - Fee Related US7521195B1 (en) 2005-07-21 2006-07-21 Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US12/400,212 Abandoned US20090232822A1 (en) 2005-07-21 2009-03-09 Lung disease targets and uses thereof

Country Status (1)

Country Link
US (3) US7521195B1 (en)

Cited By (12)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO2013035208A1 (en) * 2011-09-09 2013-03-14 株式会社トランスジェニック ANTIBODY AGAINST MUTANT α-ACTININ-4
WO2013131001A1 (en) * 2012-03-02 2013-09-06 Academia Sinica ANTI-EPITHELIAL CELL ADHESION MOLECULE (EpCAM) ANTIBODIES AND METHODS OF USE THEREOF
JPWO2013035208A1 (en) * 2011-09-09 2015-03-23 株式会社トランスジェニック Antibody to mutant α-actinin-4
EP2886126A1 (en) * 2013-12-23 2015-06-24 Endosignals Medizintechnik GmbH CD44 binding peptides
JP2016199554A (en) * 2016-06-01 2016-12-01 株式会社トランスジェニック ANTIBODY AGAINST MUTANT α-ACTININ-4
US9541480B2 (en) 2011-06-29 2017-01-10 Academia Sinica Capture, purification, and release of biological substances using a surface coating
WO2017089768A1 (en) * 2015-11-23 2017-06-01 Immunocore Limited Peptides
US10107726B2 (en) 2016-03-16 2018-10-23 Cellmax, Ltd. Collection of suspended cells using a transferable membrane
US10112198B2 (en) 2014-08-26 2018-10-30 Academia Sinica Collector architecture layout design
US10495644B2 (en) 2014-04-01 2019-12-03 Academia Sinica Methods and systems for cancer diagnosis and prognosis
US10792333B2 (en) 2015-11-23 2020-10-06 Immunocore Limited Peptides derived from actin-like protein 8 (ACTL8)
US10980893B2 (en) 2015-11-23 2021-04-20 Immunocore Limited Peptides derived from transient receptor potential cation channel subfamily M member 1 (TRPM1), complexes comprising such peptides bound to MHC molecules

Families Citing this family (36)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
PT2082225E (en) * 2006-09-20 2014-04-10 Univ Belfast Method to determine whether a tumour cell has invasive and/or metastatic potential and modulating agents of malignant transformation
AU2008295292A1 (en) * 2007-09-03 2009-03-12 Protagen Ag Marker sequences for rheumatoid arthritis and use thereof
JP2012511894A (en) * 2008-09-04 2012-05-31 オックスフォード ビオトヘラペウトイクス エルティーディー. PTA072 protein
US10359425B2 (en) * 2008-09-09 2019-07-23 Somalogic, Inc. Lung cancer biomarkers and uses thereof
US20100221752A2 (en) * 2008-10-06 2010-09-02 Somalogic, Inc. Ovarian Cancer Biomarkers and Uses Thereof
EP2684957A2 (en) 2009-01-08 2014-01-15 International Institute of Cancer Immunology, Inc. Double-stranded siRNA targeting cancer antigen eEF2
US20120329666A1 (en) * 2009-10-05 2012-12-27 Duke University Peripheral Blood Biomarkers for Idiopathic Interstitial Pneumonia and Methods of Use
MY165151A (en) 2010-02-24 2018-02-28 Immunogen Inc Folate receptor 1 antibodies and immunoconjugates and uses thereof
WO2011109446A1 (en) * 2010-03-01 2011-09-09 Astute Medical, Inc. Methods and compositions for diagnosis and prognosis of renal injury and renal failure in a non-surgical icu population
CN102971004A (en) * 2010-05-06 2013-03-13 卡罗林斯卡学院创新有限公司 Compounds, medicaments and methods of treatment for helicobacter pylori infection.
JP5905003B2 (en) 2010-07-09 2016-04-20 ソマロジック・インコーポレーテッド Lung cancer biomarkers and their use
CN103415624B (en) 2010-08-13 2017-03-01 私募蛋白质体公司 Cancer of pancreas biomarker and application thereof
FR2968767B1 (en) * 2010-12-08 2012-12-21 Biomerieux Sa METHOD AND KIT FOR IN VITRO DIAGNOSIS OF PROSTATE CANCER
WO2012135500A1 (en) 2011-03-29 2012-10-04 The General Hospital Corporation Engineered thioredoxin-like fold proteins
KR20240017965A (en) 2011-04-01 2024-02-08 이뮤노젠 아이엔씨 Methods for increasing efficacy of folr1 cancer therapy
US9175092B2 (en) 2011-06-28 2015-11-03 Oxford Biotherapeutics Ltd Antibodies to bone marrow stromal antigen 1
ES2615256T3 (en) 2011-06-28 2017-06-06 Oxford Biotherapeutics Ltd. Therapeutic and diagnostic objective
WO2013129660A1 (en) * 2012-03-02 2013-09-06 日本サプリメント株式会社 Agent that is agonistic to oxytocin receptor and/or antagonistic to vasopressin receptor
CN103387605B (en) * 2012-05-08 2018-06-12 复旦大学 A kind of RTN4B polypeptides, its monoclonal antibody, the hybridoma cell strain for generating monoclonal antibody and their preparation and application
EP2867679B1 (en) * 2012-06-28 2018-07-18 Nordic Bioscience A/S Determining pathological cartilage turnover
PT2890717T (en) 2012-08-31 2020-04-22 Immunogen Inc Diagnostic assays and kits for detection of folate receptor 1
CN102887950B (en) * 2012-10-10 2015-04-22 中国科学院动物研究所 hnRNP A2* protein, nucleic acid for coding protein and application thereof
MY176282A (en) 2013-08-30 2020-07-27 Immunogen Inc Antibodies and assays for detection of folate receptor 1
US9753036B2 (en) 2014-04-29 2017-09-05 Edp Biotech Corporation Methods and compositions for screening and detecting biomarkers
CN104062436B (en) * 2014-06-06 2016-02-10 上海良润生物医药科技有限公司 FXYD is in preparation diagnosis and indicate the application in lung cancer marker and FXYD double crush syndrome detection kit
US20170159101A1 (en) * 2014-07-09 2017-06-08 Cleave Biosciences, Inc. Drug-resistant p97 atpase mutations
TW201617368A (en) 2014-09-05 2016-05-16 史坦森特瑞斯公司 Novel anti-MFI2 antibodies and methods of use
US10451610B2 (en) * 2014-09-29 2019-10-22 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Prediction of response to PARP inhibitors and combinational therapy targeting C-MET and PARP1
WO2016131962A1 (en) * 2015-02-20 2016-08-25 Pharis Biotec Gmbh Polypeptide with activity against diphtheria toxin
GB201505305D0 (en) 2015-03-27 2015-05-13 Immatics Biotechnologies Gmbh Novel Peptides and combination of peptides for use in immunotherapy against various tumors
AU2016323968B2 (en) 2015-09-17 2023-07-06 Immunogen, Inc. Therapeutic combinations comprising anti-FOLR1 immunoconjugates
KR102107214B1 (en) * 2018-07-20 2020-05-13 경북대학교 산학협력단 Composition for treating neuroinflammatory disease comprising complement component 8 gamma or fragment thereof
JP2022508942A (en) * 2018-10-22 2022-01-19 アイセルキーレクス セラピューティクス エルエルシー Mutant vaccinia virus and its use
WO2023091954A2 (en) * 2021-11-19 2023-05-25 The Trustees Of The University Of Pennsylvania Engineered pan-leukocyte antigen cd45 to facilitate car t cell therapy
WO2023230570A2 (en) * 2022-05-25 2023-11-30 Flagship Pioneering Innovations Vii, Llc Compositions and methods for modulating genetic drivers
WO2023230578A2 (en) * 2022-05-25 2023-11-30 Flagship Pioneering Innovations Vii, Llc Compositions and methods for modulating circulating factors

Family Cites Families (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CA2399776A1 (en) 2000-02-03 2001-08-09 Hyseq, Inc. Novel nucleic acids and polypeptides
AU2002224331A1 (en) 2000-09-22 2002-04-02 Incyte Genomics, Inc. Transcription factors and zinc finger proteins
JP2003036676A (en) 2001-07-19 2003-02-07 Mitsubishi Electric Corp Semiconductor memory

Cited By (18)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US11674958B2 (en) 2011-06-29 2023-06-13 Academia Sinica Capture, purification, and release of biological substances using a surface coating
US9541480B2 (en) 2011-06-29 2017-01-10 Academia Sinica Capture, purification, and release of biological substances using a surface coating
WO2013035208A1 (en) * 2011-09-09 2013-03-14 株式会社トランスジェニック ANTIBODY AGAINST MUTANT α-ACTININ-4
JPWO2013035208A1 (en) * 2011-09-09 2015-03-23 株式会社トランスジェニック Antibody to mutant α-actinin-4
US9644026B2 (en) 2011-09-09 2017-05-09 Trans Genic Inc. Antibody against mutant α-actinin-4
CN108456249B (en) * 2011-09-09 2021-09-03 转基因股份有限公司 Antibody of variant alpha-actinin-4
CN108456249A (en) * 2011-09-09 2018-08-28 转基因股份有限公司 The antibody of anomaly α-actinine -4
WO2013131001A1 (en) * 2012-03-02 2013-09-06 Academia Sinica ANTI-EPITHELIAL CELL ADHESION MOLECULE (EpCAM) ANTIBODIES AND METHODS OF USE THEREOF
EP2886126A1 (en) * 2013-12-23 2015-06-24 Endosignals Medizintechnik GmbH CD44 binding peptides
WO2015097170A1 (en) * 2013-12-23 2015-07-02 Exchange Imaging Technologies Gmbh Cd44 binding peptides
US10495644B2 (en) 2014-04-01 2019-12-03 Academia Sinica Methods and systems for cancer diagnosis and prognosis
US10112198B2 (en) 2014-08-26 2018-10-30 Academia Sinica Collector architecture layout design
US10792333B2 (en) 2015-11-23 2020-10-06 Immunocore Limited Peptides derived from actin-like protein 8 (ACTL8)
US10980893B2 (en) 2015-11-23 2021-04-20 Immunocore Limited Peptides derived from transient receptor potential cation channel subfamily M member 1 (TRPM1), complexes comprising such peptides bound to MHC molecules
WO2017089768A1 (en) * 2015-11-23 2017-06-01 Immunocore Limited Peptides
US10107726B2 (en) 2016-03-16 2018-10-23 Cellmax, Ltd. Collection of suspended cells using a transferable membrane
US10605708B2 (en) 2016-03-16 2020-03-31 Cellmax, Ltd Collection of suspended cells using a transferable membrane
JP2016199554A (en) * 2016-06-01 2016-12-01 株式会社トランスジェニック ANTIBODY AGAINST MUTANT α-ACTININ-4

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20090232822A1 (en) 2009-09-17
US7521195B1 (en) 2009-04-21

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US20200116726A1 (en) Pancreatic cancer targets and uses thereof
US7521195B1 (en) Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US20210277073A1 (en) Kidney disease targets and uses thereof
US7842467B1 (en) Breast disease targets and uses thereof
US20210017259A1 (en) Colon disease targets and uses thereof
US7358231B1 (en) Pancreatic cancer secreted targets and uses thereof
US20200325189A1 (en) Colon disease targets and uses thereof
US7807392B1 (en) Lung disease targets and uses thereof
US20090123461A1 (en) Human podocalyxin alternative-spliced forms and uses thereof
US7611703B1 (en) Kidney disease targets and uses thereof
US20100172908A1 (en) Methods and compositions for treating diseases targeting maba1
US20060029988A1 (en) Method and compositions for treating diseases targeting E-cadherin
US7776555B1 (en) Colon disease targets and uses thereof
US20060035239A1 (en) Method and compositions for treating diseases targeting CD51
WO2006022682A2 (en) Method and compositions for treating diseases targeting cd49b
WO2006022690A1 (en) Method and compositions for treating diseases targeting cd71
WO2006022689A1 (en) Method and compositions for treating diseases targeting cd51

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION